T H E GARLAND OF LETTERS (VARṆ AMĀLĀ) STUDIES IN THE MANTRA-ŚĀSTRA BY SIR JOHN WOODROFFE Celephaïs Press Ulthar - Sarkomand - Inquanok – Leeds 2008 First published Madras: Ganesh & co, and London: Luzac & co., 1922. Third edition, Madras: Ganesh & co., 1955, This elec- tronic text produced by Celephaïs Press, somewhere beyond the Tanarian Hills, and mani(n)fested in the waking world in the year 2008 of the common error. This work is in the public domain. Release 1.0.: March 2008. May require further proof reading. Please report errors to dancingstar93@gmail.com citing revision number or release date. PREFACE THIS book is an attempt, now made for the first time, to explain to an English-knowing reader an undoubtedly difficult subject. I am therefore forcibly reminded of the saying, “Veda fears the man of little knowledge, since injury may be received from him” (Bibhetyalpaśrutād- Vedo mām-ayam ̣ praharisyate). It is natural, given this difficulty and the mystery which surrounds the subject, that strangers to India should have failed to understand Mantra. They need not, however, have then (as some have done) jumped to the conclusion that it was “meaningless superstition.” This is the familiar argument of the lower mind which says “what I cannot understand can have no sense at all.” Mantra is, it is true, meaningless to those who do not kmow its meaning. But there are others who do, and to them it is not “superstition.” It is because some English-educated Indians are as uninstructed in the matter as that rather common type of Western to whose mental outlook and opinions they mould their own, that it was possible to find a distinguished member of this class describing Mantra as “meaningless jabber.” Indian doc- trines and practice have been so long and so greatly mis- understood and misrepresented by foreigners, that it has always seemed to me a pity that those who are of this Puṇ yabhūmi should, through misapprehension, malign without reason anything which is their own. This does not mean that they must accept what is in fact without worth THE GARLAND OF LETTERS vi because it is Indian, but they should at least first under- stand what they condemn as worthless. When I first entered on a study of this Śāstra I did so in the belief that India did not contain more fools than exist amongst other peoples, but had on the contrary produced intelligences which (to say the least) were the equal of any elsewhere found. Behind the unintelligent practice, which doubtless to some extent exists amongst the multitude of every faith, I felt sure there must be a rational principle, since men on the whole do not continue through- out the ages to do that which is in itself meaningless and is therefore without result. I was not disappointed. The Mantra-Śāstra, so far from being rightly described as “meaningless superstition” or “jabber,” is worthy of a close study which when undertaken, will disclose elements of value to minds free from superstition, of metaphysical bent and subtle-seeing (Sūkṣ madaśin). A profound doctrine, ingeniously though guardedly set forth, is con- tained in the Tantras of the Mantra- Śāstra or Āgama. This is an auspicious time in which to open out the secrets of this Adhyātmika science. For here in this country there has been a turn in the tide. The class of Indian who was wont to unite with the European critic of his Motherland in misunderstanding and misrepresenting Her thoughts and institutions, is, to Her good fortune, gradual- ly disappearing. Those who are recovering from the dazzle produced on its first entrance by an alien civilization are able to judge aright both its merits and defects as also to perceive the truth of the saying of Schiller, “Hold to your dear and precious native land; there are the strong roots of your strength (Ans Vaterland ans teure schliess dich an. Da sind die starken Wurxeln deiner Kraft.)” Again in the West there is a movement away from the Materialism which regarded that alone as “real” which PREFACE vii is gross sensible matter; and towards that standpoint whence it is seen that thought itself is a thing which is every whit as real as any external object. Each is but an aspect of the one conscious Self whence both Mind and Matter proceed. This Self or Cit is the Soul of the Uni- verse, and the universe is Cit which has become its own object. Every being therein is Consciousness, that is, Cit manifesting as the multiple forms of Mind and Matter which constitute the universe. This Western movement is called by its adherents “New Thought,” but its basal principles are as old as the Upaniṣ ads which proclaimed that all was Feeling-Consciousness (Cit), and therefore what a man thought, that he became. In fact thought counts for more than any material means whatever. I am not however here entering upon a general defence of so im- mense a subject, for this cannot be compassed in a work such as this. In any case—and this is what I am concerned to show—the Mantra Śāstra is not the mere senseless rubbish it has been supposed to be. This book is, as the sub-title states, a Collection of Studies in, or Essays upon, particular subjects in the Mantra- Śāstra, a term which is commonly applied to the Tantra- Śāstra. It is practically composed of two parts. After Chapter I, which deals with the “Word,” Chapters II-IX treat of the Principles of the general doctrine of Śabda. I am much indebted in the preparation of these Chapters to my friend, Professor Pramathanātha-Mukhopādhyāya. Chapters X-XXI are elucidations of Borne subjects in the Tantra-Śāstra which adopts the Mimām ̣ gsā doctrine of Śhabda with some modifications to meet its doctrine of Śakti. Chapters XXII, XXVIII and XXIX deal with the Mantras “Om ̣ ” and the Gayatri. An understanding of such terms as Śakti, Nāda, Bindu, the Causal Śaktis of the Praṇ ava, Bīja-mantras and so forth, is essential for those who would THE GARLAND OF LETTERS viii understand the Śāstra in which they appear. Hitherto knowledge of these matters has been confined (where it exists at all) to the Gurus and Sādhakas. This does not mean that my information has been gathered from oral sources only. On the contrary the substance of it may be found in the Tantras. These are however generally un- known. The definitions must be sought for in many Śāstras. When found they must be explained by the aid of general Śāstric knowledge and of Upāsakas who possess the tradition. As regards technical terms I refer my readers to other books which I have published, in parti- cular to “Śakti and Śakta,” “Serpent Power,” and the volumes of the series called “The World as Power” describing the chief concepts of Indian Philosophy and Religion. Chapters X-XXI and XXIV are reprinted from the Jour- nal the Vedānta-Kesarī. Chapters XXII-XXIII on “Om ̣ ” and the “Necklace of Kālī” appeared in East and West, and Chapters XXVIII-XXIX on Mamtrasādhana and the “Gāyatrī” in the Introduction to my edition of the Mahā- nirvāna Tantra, which is now superseded, as regards the Introduction, by the fuller account of the Tantras and Tāntrik ritual given in my volume, “Śakti and Śākta”, and as regards the Text, by another and more correct edition which I have in preparation. Chapter XXX on the “Gāyatrī as an Exercise of Reasoning” is a reprint of a paper read by me before the Indian Rationalistic Society at Calcutta, and has been previously published in its Bulletin. Ten of the papers dealing with general principles were delivered by me in 1919 as Extension Lectures at the instance of the National Council of Education, Bengal. As I write the concluding lines of this preface hard by the ancient and desolate Temple to the Sun-Lord at Konāraka in Northern Orissa, a continuous rolling sound PREFACE ix like that of the Mahsmantra is borne to me from afar. I heard the same sound many years ago at the Pemiong- chi monastery when some hundred Buddhist monks rolled out from the depth of their bodies the mantra Om ̣ . Their chant then suggested the sea, as the sea now suggests the Mantra. Here where the sound is heard are green woods, bushes of jasmine, cactus in bloom and the rose and yellow of the Karavīra and Kalikā flowers. Travelling however whence it comes some two miles seaward, the eye surveys a wide wild waste of land, with here and there sparse clumps of Ketaki, stretching from the world-famous Temple of the “Lord of the Universe” in the south to the Golra jungle on the North. On the Eastern edge the surf of the Bengal Ocean in great waves, marbled with foam with creaming crests, whipped into filmy vapour by the wind, ceaselessly beats upon a lonely shore. The waves as all else are Mantra, for Mantra in its most basal sense is the World viewed as—and in its aspect of—sound. But as I have explained in the Text we must distinguish between Natural Name in its pure sense as the sound of the constituent forces of a thing and the sounds made by the thing when so produced. All sounds and therefore movements form the “Garland of Letters,” which is worn by the Divine Mother, from whose aspects as Om ̣ or the General Sound (Sāmānya-spanda) of the first creative movement all parti- cular sounds and things come. For all things may be rendered in terms of sound. The Universe is movement. The Letters are the sound of particular movements. These are audibIe as the gross letters which Kālī, the Source of movement, wears as a garland round Her neck. I record this note on a scene which I have known and enjoyed for many years, since I may now be seeing it for the last, time. If (as I hope not) this be so, then I bid farewell to my old friend the Sādhu Jagannātha-Dāsa and to this THE GARLAND OF LETTERS x place set in an air of magic of which the Kapila-Sam ̣ hitā (Ch. VI) says: Maitreyākhye vame puṇ ye rathayātrāmahotsave Ye paśyānti narā bhaktyā te paśyanti tanu raveh. J.W. KONĀRAKA 22nd April, 1922 CONTENTS CHAPTER PAGE Preface . . . . . . v I. Vāk or the Word . . . . . 1 II. Artha, Pratyaya and Śabda . . . 12 III. Aśabda and Paraśabda. . . . . 21 IV. Paraśabda, Causal Śabda . . . . 31 V. Śakti as Stress . . . . . 40 VI. Eternality of Śabda . . . . 48 VII. Śabda as language . . . . 56 VIII. Natural Name . . . . . 66 IX. Vaidika-Śabda . . . . . 77 X. The Tattvas . . . . . 89 XI. Śakti—Potency to Create . . . . 99 XII. Nāda—the First Produced Movement . . 108 XIII. Bindu or Śakti—Ready to Create . . . 122 XIV. Māyā-Tattva . . . . . 135 XV. The Kañcukas . . . . . 146 XVI. Ham ̣ sa . . . . . . 156 XVII. Kāmakalā . . . . . 166 XVIII. The Gross Tattvas and their Lords . . 176 XIX. Causal Śaktis of the Pra ṇ ava . . . 186 XX. The Kalās . . . . . 194 XXI. The Garland of Letters or Var ṇ amālā . . 202 XXII. “Om ̣ ” . . . . . 216 XXIII. The Necklace of Kālī . . . . 221 XXIV. Dhvani . . . . . . 228 XXV. Sun, Moon and Fire . . . . 237 XXVI. Bīja-Mantra . . . . . 241 XXVII. Ṣ adadhvās . . . . . 250 XXVIII. Mantra-Sādhana . . . . . 258 XXIX. Gāyatrī-Mantra . . . . . 265 XXX. The Gāyatrī-Mantra as an Exercise of Reasoning . 268 XXXI Ātma- Sādhana . . . . . 290 BY THE SAME AUTHOR Introduction to Tantra Shastra (Key to Tantrik literature) Principles of Tantra (Tantra Tattva) The Serpent Power (Kundalini Śakti) Shakti and Shakta (Essays on the Śakta Tantra) The World as Power (Mahā Śakti in various aspects) The Great Liberation (Mahānirvāṇ a Tantra) Wave of Bliss (Ānandalaharī) Greatness of Shiva (Mahimnastava) Hymns to the Goddess (Stotras of Śamkaracharya etc.) Hymn to Kali (Karpūrādistotra) Kamakalavilasa (An important work in Sri-vidya) Tantraraja Tantra (A Short Analysis) THE GARLAND OF LETTERS (VARṆ AMĀLĀ) CHAPTER I VĀK OR THE WORD THE word Vāk (in Latin Vox) comes from the root Vach which means “to speak”. The feminine noun Vāk therefore means literally both voice and the word it utters, as also the sound of inanimate objects. It has the same sense therefore as Śabda. Artha is meaning or object. Pratyaya is mental apprehension. All things have a threefold sense, supreme (Parā), subtle (Sūkṣ ma), gross (Sthūla). Parā- Vāk is the Causal Stress which, in terms of Pratyaya, is the Cosmic Ideation (Sṛ ṣ ti-kalpanā) of Īśvara. This is the Divine “Word.” But Vāk is also an effect, either subtle or gross. Paśyantī-Vāk is Vāk actually going forth as Īkṣ aṇ a (Seeing), producing or manifesting, as Sūkṣ mā Madhyamā-Vāk, or Hiraṇ yagarbha Śabda which is the Mātṛ kā state of Śabda as it exists in man prior to its gross manifestation as the Varṇ as in spoken speech (Vaikharī-vāk). In the Ṛ gveda, Sarasvatī (V. 43-11) is called Pāviravī or daughter of the Lightning, that is, of the great Vajra which sustains the worlds, which according to Sāyaṇ a is Mādhyamīkivāk. (See Muir O. S. T.—V. 337 ff.) Spoken speech (Vaikharī) is manifested to the ear THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 2 by the gross physical sound or Dhvani produced by the contact of the vocal organs on the surrounding air by the effort (Prayatna) to speak. In the transcendental quiescent Brahman (Paramātmā) or Pammaśiva there is neither Śabda (Aślabda), Artha (Nirviṣ aya) nor Pratyaya. There is therefore neither name (Nāma) nor form (Rūpa). In this Infinite Calm there arises a metaphysical Point of Stress or Bindu or Ghanībhata-Śakti, which stirs forth (Prasareti) as the multiple forces of the universe. This energising is the cause of, and as Jīvātmā is, the World- experience with its duality of subject and object. This play of Śakti takes play in the Ether of Consciousness (Cidākāśa) in such a way that the latter is neither effaced nor affected when the second condition appears, which last is that of both Transcendence and Immanence. This is creation (Sṛ ṣ ti) or, more properly, seeming develop- ment (Pariṇ āma), since the English word “creation” does not truly express the process. Creation, in the Christ- ian sense, excludes the notion that God is a material cause, creation being neither out of pre-existing matter nor out of God’s own substance. Creation also involves an absolutely first appearance. With this reservation the term “creation” is used. More accurately the Brahman Itself, in the form of Its Power (Śakti), goes forth (Pra- sarati). This Sṛ ṣ ti endures a while (Sthiti) that is for a day of Brahmā, upon which there is, according to some, a complete dissolution (Mahāpralaya). Others say that there is no such Mahāpralaya, but that there is always existing some universe, though one or another may disappear. In Mahāpralaya the second state is potentially contained in the undifferentiated unmanifest Māyā-Śakti. Śabda- brahman as an Ullāsa of Śiva sinks as it were into the eternally existing Calm, just as the rising wave breaks itself and sinks upon the ocean, or as the spray of a fountain VĀK OR THE WORD 3 falls again into the waters which feed it. This notion of the “Word” is very ancient. God “speaks” the word and the Thing appears. Thus the Hebrew word for Light is “Aur.” Genesis says, “God said: let there be Light (Aur) and there was Light (Aur).” The Divine word is conceived of in the Hebrew Scriptures as having creative power. A further stage of thought presents to us the concept of an aspect of the Supreme or Person who creates. Thus we have the Supreme and the Logos, Brahman and Śabda- brahman. In Greek, Logos means (as does Aparaśabda) thought, and the word which denotes the object of thought. To Heraclitus, Logos was the principle underlying the universe. (See J. N. Heinze, Die Lehre vom Logos in der Griech. Philosophie). To the Stoics it was the “World- soul” the uniting principle of all rational forces working in the world. According to Plato, the Logoi were super- sensual primal images or patterns (Jāti) of visible things. The Alexandrian Philo, influenced by Platonism and other philosophies of Hellenism, combined the two conceptions and read into the Old Testament and Jewish Theology a, Being intermediate between It (that is ho on) and the manifold universe. This intermediate Being was the Logos. According to Philo, Ideas moulded Matter. God first produced the intelligible world of Ideas which are types (Aparajāti) of the physical world. Though in Itself nothing but the Logos, the latter is the author of the ideal world. Just as an architect projects in his mind a plan of a town (Polis) and thus produces the real town according to the ideal, so God acted when He created the world, this Megalopolis (Brahmānda). The Author of the Fourth Gospel took up these ideas but gave them expression in such a way as to serve Christian theological needs. (See J. Réville, La Doctrine du Logos dans la quatriéme Evangile et dans les Æuvres de Philon). It has thus been THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 4 said that John’s adoption of the notion was not a mere copy, but a free adaptation of the Philonian Logos and a Christianising of it. According to the Evangelist the Logos is a Person who was before creation and Himself God. It is the Potency of the Eternal Wisdom proceeding from the unmanifest Godhead for the purpose of world-activity, and in the world It is the Logos Endiathetos or immanent divine wisdom (See Moeller, Hist. Ch. Church I, 92:222). The Logos through whom the world was created became flesh (Avatāra), that it was manifested in man (Verbum caro factum est). He is the Son who is Jesus Christ, He who in the heavenly pre-existence is called the Logos and after His incarnation the man Jesus who is the Christ, who is neither prophet nor superman but Pūrnāvatāra of God. The Logos is the perfect self-presentation of God in the Son. In Jesus there was identity of being with God. The fourth Gospel opens grandly, “In the beginning was the Word and the Word was with God and the Word was God.” These are the very words of Veda. Prajāpatir vai ida m ̣ āsīt: In the beginning was Brahman. Tasya vāg dvitīyā āsīt; with whom was Vāk or the Word; (She is spoken of as second to Him because She is first potentially in, and then as Śakti issues from Him); Vāg vai paramam ̣ Brahma; and the word is Brahman. Vāk is thus a Śakti or Power of the Brahman which is one with the Possessor of Power (Śaktimān). This Śakti which was in Him is at the creation with Him, and evolves into the form of the Universe whilst still remaining what It is—the Supreme Śakti. It is always possible that human thought may develop similarly and yet independently. It is not im- probable also, seeing the influence of India on the west, that the Philonic and Neo-platonic and Johannean, conceptions were, in part at least, indebted for their VĀK OR THE WORD 5 origin to India. Nevertheless there are, with general points of similarity, others of difference, for which accuracy demands attention. Thus the Brahman is the material cause of the World which the Christian Logos is not. For Christianity is dualism. Vāk is no Person in a Trinity. Vāk is Herself the Mother of the Trimūrthi who are Brahmā, Viṣ nu and Rudra. For She is the Supreme Śakti, one with Brahman. The full incarnation is a concept of Hindu- ism, yet, in the form of Jīva, Vāk is incarnated not in one historic person only but in all men, beings, and things. The Word as Vāk became flesh, not on one partioular date in one particular place and in one particular historic person. It appeared and now appears in the flesh and other forms of matter of all limited beings or Jīvas, each of whom may through Veda directly realise the Brahman whose Śakti is the word of Vāk. Jesus alone was God in human form. Others were not, are not and never can become God. Vāk manifests Herself in every man and is knowable and known as She is in Herself—that is Brahman, in that spiritual experience which is Veda. The universe is the outcome of the Divine Desire (Kāma) or Will (Icchā). Kāma on the physical plane de- notes among other things, sexual desire. In the highest sense it is the first creative impulse of the One to be many, whereby It begets Itself as all creatures. Earthly desire and self-reproduction are but limited manifestations of that first impulse. The Divine Will is continually and present- ly working through the individual sexual desire for the continued creation of the universe. This Divine Kāma is eternal and the origin of all things, And so Parmenides speaking of Eros or Love, said Prōtisto mén érota theōn nētīsato pantōn. (“He devised Eros the first of all the Gods”). This is the Divine Eros through whom things are (See Plato Symp. 5-6). The Daughter of Kāma is Vāk. The THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 6 latter as the Divine Will speaks the Divine Word upon which the Thing is. In the Atharvaveda (IX-2) Kāma is celebrated as a great Power superior to all the Devas. The Daughter of Kāma is named “The Cow which sages call Vāk-virāt,” that is Vāk in the form of the universe. In the “beginning” there was Brahman and with It was Vāk. In the Veda (Śatapatha-Brāhmaṇ a VI. 1-1.8) it is said, “this Being (Puruṣ a) Prajāpati willed ‘May I be many’ ‘May I be propagated.’ He energised (So’śrāmyat sa tapo’tapyata). Vāk was His. She was produced from Him (Vāg evā sya sā sṛ jyata) and pervaded all which exists.” Then on the issue of Vāk, “By his mind he united with Vāk (Śa. P. Br. X. 6-5-4 ; Brih. Br. Up. Roer p. 50) and thus (Śa. P. Br. VI. 1-2 ff) became pregnant (Garbhī abhavat).” In the Kāṭ haka it is said (XII-5 and XXVII-1) “Prajāpati only was then this (Prajāpatir vai idam āsīt). Vāk was a second to Him (Tasya vāg dvitīyā āsīt). He united with Her (Tām ̣ mithtma m ̣ samabhavat) and She became pregnant (Sā garbha m ̣ ādhatta). She went out from Him and produced these creatures (Sā asmād apākrāmat sā imāh prajāh ādhata) and again re-entered Him (Sā Prajāpatim eva punah prāviśat).” Again in the Pañcavim ̣ śa Br. (XX-14-2) it is similarly said: “Prajāpati alone was this universe. He had Vāk too as His own, as a Second to Him. He thought, ‘let me now put forth this Vāk. She will traverse and pervade all this. That is the Brahman or Śiva first willed to be many and His Śakti, which was one with Him, issued as His Word.” The Union of Will and Word was the potency of creation, all things being held in undifferentiated mass in the Great Womb (Mahāyoni) of the Mother of all (Am ̣ bikā). This Potency became actual as the manifested universe, and at its dissolution Śakti, as such universe, re-entered Brahman and remained one with It (Cit) as Cidrūpiṇ ī. Meanwhile VĀK OR THE WORD 7 She pervades, as immanent Spirit, both Mind and Matter which are Its temporal forms. For as the Bṛ hadāraṇ yaka- Upaniṣ ad says (pp. 50-53, Ed. Roer): “By that Vāk and that Ātmā He created all things whatsoever, the Vedas, Metres, Sacrifices and all Creatures” (Sā tayā vācā tena ātmanā ida m ̣ sarvam ̣ asṛ jata yad idam ̣ kim ̣ ca ṛ co yajūmṣ i sāmānśi chanām ̣ si yajñān prajāh paśūn). “First was produced the sacred Vaidik science” (Ś. P. Br. VI. 1-1-8). In the Mahābhārata, Sarasvatī as Vāk is called the “Mother of the Vedas” (Śāntiparva, V. 12, 920) and the same is said of Vāk in the Taittirīya-Brāhmaṇ a (II. 8-8- 5) where (and in the preceding par. 4) She is also said to contain within Herself all worlds and to have been sought with Tapas by the Ṛ ṣ is who put forth the Vedic Hymns (Ṛ ṣ ayo mantrakṛ tah). In the Bhī ṣ maparva of the Mahābhārata (v. 3019) Acyuta (Kṛ ṣ ṇ a) is said to have produced Sarasvatī and the Vedas from His mind; and in the Vanaparva (v. 13,432) the Gāyatrī is called the Mother of the Vedas, for Gāyatrī Devi is a form of Vāk. Vāk is the Mother of the Vedas and of all things which their words denote. Vāk in the form of Veda is Vedātmikā Vāk (See Sāyaṇ a and other citations given in Muir O.S.T. 1-325ff where, as in other volumes, some of the Texts concerning Vāk are collected). The substance of the whole world is Vāk (Jagat Vāṇ maya), for as previously stated the world (Jagat) is Śabdaprabhava. The Ṛ gveda (X. 125-5) says: “I (Vāk) make him whom I love formidable, him a Brahmana, him a Ṛ ṣ i, him a Sage.” It is this Vāk which entered the Ṛ ṣ is and has thus made Herself known to men. “By sacrifice they follow- ed the path of Vāk and found Her entered into the Ṛ ṣ is” (Ṛ gveda, X. 71-3). The Ṛ ṣ is called their Hymns by various names, amongst others Vāk, for they are mani- festations of Vak. Vāk is one with Brahman for Śiva and THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 8 Śakti are one. In the Bṛ hadāraṇ yaka-Upaniṣ ad it is said (Ed. Roer, 688). “By Vāk, O Monarch, the Brahman is known. Vāk is the Supreme Brahman” (Vāchaiva sam ̣ rād Brahma jñāyate vāg vai sam ̣ rāt pararnam Brahma). The Mahābhārata (Śāntiparva v. 12,920), says: “Behold Sarasvatī Mother of the Vedas abiding in me (Vedānām ̣ mātram ̣ paśya matsthām ̣ devīm ̣ Sarasvatīm ̣ ). She, this great Śakti, is one with Maheśvara. And so in the Man ̣ galācarana prefixed to the Commentaries on the Ṛ k Sam ̣ hitā and Taittiriya-Sam ̣ hitā by both Sāyaṇ a and Mādhava it is said: “I reverence Maheśvara the hallowed abode of sacred knowledge, of whom the Vedas are the breathings and who from the Vedas formed the whole universe” (Yasya niśvasitam ̣ vedāh yo vedebhyo ’khilam ̣ jagat, Nirmame tam aham ̣ vande vidyātīrtha m ̣ Maheś– varam ̣ ). The Taittirīya-Brāhmaṇ a (III-39-1) says that Vāk is imperishable, the first born of Ṛ ta, Mother of the Vedas and centre-point of immortality (Vāg akṣ arām prathamā– jā ṛ tasya vedānām ̣ mātā amṛ itasya nābhih). The Śata- patha- Brāhmaṇ a says (VII. 5-2-21): “Vāk is the unborn.” It was from Vāk that the Maker of the Universe (Viśva- karmā) produced oreatures (Vāg vai ajo vāco vai prajāh viśvakarmā jajāna.) Various texts associate the Lord of creatures (Prajāpati), called Paśupati in the Śaiva- Śāstra, with His Śakti Vāk, as to which see Weber Indische Studien, IX, 477 ff. and Muir’s Original Sanskrit Texts, V. 391. Śam ̣ karācārya (Sūtra 1-3, 28) quoting ‘By His mind He united with Vāk,’ says that by this and other Texts the Veda in various places declares that creation was preceded by the Word from which the whole uni- verse of Devas and organic and inorganic earth-life are produced. But it is said that the world was pro- duced from Brahman. How then was it produced from VĀK OR THE WORD 9 the Word? Creation was preceded by the Word. He says that when any man is occupied with any end which he wishes to accomplish, he first calls to mind the word which expresses it and then proceeds to effect his purpose. Using this as analogy he says that before creation the words of Veda were manifested in His mind and afterwards he creat- ed the objects which resulted from them. Thus the Vaidik text which says “Uttering Bhūh (earth) he created the earth (Bhūmi) " and so forth, means that the different worlds and the beings therein were manifested or created from the word “Bhūh” and so forth manifested in His mind. These distinctions of “before” and afterwards and so forth are Vyāvahārika. Human analogies are necessarily imperfect. In Īśvara as causal body what (as manifested) is called Pratyaya, Śabda, Artha are one and identical (and therefore, as manifested, co-ordinate) though for the purposes of exposition we may say that His Sṛ ṣ ti-kalpanā is a fraction of the Pratyaya which He has of his own Ānandamaya causal body, and included therein the subtle and gross bodies. His Paraśabda involves as effects all Aparaśabdas, and His Artha is the first stressing mass of Prakṛ tiśakti in which are experienced all elements (Vikṛ ti) and things which are compounded of them. For Īśvara has direct and immediate apprehension of the three bodies, Hiraṇ yagarbha of the second and third, and Virāt of the third. Parā-Vāk is therefore what has been previously spoken of as Paraśabda, and Vāk (simply) as Śabda in its subtle form as Mātṛ kā (Madhyamā-Vāk) and gross form (Vaikharī-Vāk). The latter is that of the spoken letters (Varṇ a) of which the Mantras are made. There is but one Cause of speech, as also of all the things in the universe which it denotes and also, of the mental apprehen- sion (Pratyaya) or “going towards” the object of the mind. That cause is the Supreme Devi Sarasvatī, Mother of THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 10 Vedas and of the Worlds, manifesting as the name (Nāma) and form (Rūpa) which is the Universe. She is thus the Supreme Śakti to whom a title is given, taken from one of Her productions, the manifested word or speech. The musical instrument (Vīṇ ā), which Sarasvati holds, denotes all sounds (Śabda) of which She is the Mother. White are Her garments and transparent whiteness is the colour of both Ākāśa and Buddhi. Her name denotes “flow” or “motion” (Saras). She is such, in the Supreme sense, as being the activity (Śakti) of the unmoving Śiva or Brahman. She is again such as the play in the manifested World of the dynamic Śaktis in and around the rigid Ether, which appeared at creation with the roaring sound “Ham ̣ ” and then stood still as the steady framework on, and in, which the whole universe flows or moves. Accord- ing to Science, Ether has no such imperfections as we associate with matter. It is the property of the latter to grow old, to decay, to wear out. But such energy as exists in the Ether remains unchanged. It is this rigid, unwast- ing, enduring Ether which is Vajra, the hard, stable, lasting unwasting Vajra, the static manifestation of the static Brahman, in which the Dynamic Brahman as Sarasvatī flows or moves. The former is Śūnya, the void of space, in which all movement takes place. Just as in Brāhmanism Ākāśa is transferred to the Brahman-idea as Cidākāśa: so this Ethereal Śanya in Northern Buddhist Monism as sTongpa-nyid (Śūnyatā) stands for the Ultimate beyond all categories (See the Demchog-Tantra published as the seventh Volume of my “Tāntrik Texts.”) Sarasvatī, the Dynamic Brahman with Her “consort” the statio Brahman as Brahmā, is borne upon the Hangsa which is no material “bird” but the natural name of the vital function manifest- ing as the expiring (Ham ̣ ) and inspiring (Sah) breath or Prāṇ abīja in all breathing creatures (Prāṇ ī). She again is VĀK OR THE WORD 11 the Divine in the aspect as Wisdom and Learning, for She is the Mother of Veda, that is of all knowledge touching Brahman and the Universe. She is the Word of which it was born and She exists in that which is the issue of Her great womb (Mahāyoni). Not therefore idly have men worshipped Vāk or Sarasvatī as the Supreme Power. CHAPTER II ARTHA, PRATYAYA AND ŚABDA THE one supreme Consciousness (Cit) which is the Change- less Principle of all experience evolves by, and from out of, its Power (Śakti), which is both Cit-Śakti and Māyā- śakti—the duality of subject and object, mind and matter. In Parasamvit or Saccidānanda the experience is unitary and devoid of every species of duality. I have dealt in my book “Śakti and Śakta” with the various possible English renderings of the untranslatable word Cit which, subject to the reservations there made, may be called Feeling-Con- sciousness or with less liability to misunderstanding the Changeless Principle of all changing experience. Through the operation of Śakti the homogeneous Unity becomes the Many or universe of subject and object, mind and matter. The Perfect Experience, without ceasing to be such, involves Itself in mind and matter and thus becomes the imperfect or limited experience. As all is the one Self, this apparent dichotomy means that the Self which mani- fests as a limited subject sees (though it is unaware of it) itself as object. Cit is without motion (Niṣ panda), without action (Niṣ kriya), without mind (Amanah) and without Śabda (Aśabda). It is neither subject nor knows any object other than Itself as Cidrūpiṇ i-Śakti. Creation commences by an initial movement or vibration (Spandana) in the Cosmic Stuff, as some Western writers call it, and which ARTHA, PRATYAYA AND ŚABDA 13 in Indian parlance is Saspanda Prakṛ ti-Śakti. Just as the nature of Cit or the Śiva aspect of Brahman is rest, quiescence, so that of Prakṛ ti is movement. Prior however to manifestation, that is during dissolution (Pralaya) of the universe, Prakṛ ti exists in a state of equili- brated energy (Sāmyāvasthā) in which there is Sarūpapa- riṇ āma. It then moves (Virūpapariṇ āma). This is the first cosmic vibration (Spandana) in which the equilibrated energy is released. The approximate sound of this movement is the Mantra Om ̣ . Dualism with all its varieties is thus produc- ed. There is thus a bifurcation of Consciousness into Mind and Matter which therefore constitute a parallelism of common origin. The mind as subject has apprehension (Pratyaya) of objects (Artha), and names those objects by word (Śabda) or language. In man Śabda, Artha, and Pratyaya are connected but distinct. Like everything else they are three effectual manifestations of the movement (Spanda) which is the common Causal Stress. At the stage of Causal Śakti however the three are one; so that then Śabda = Artha = Pratyaya = Spanda, the latter being not, as in manifestation, a common denominator but the equivalent of Śabda, Artha, Pratyaya. The state is one of logical unity. Īśvara’s Spanda is His Śabda, is His Artha, is His Pratyaya. Doubtless in projecting our stand- point as existence into Divine Being we cannot help using the analogy of aspects. And so we speak of Cit and the Causal Stress (Śakti), of Śiva and Śakti as two aspects and so on. Nevertheless we must not understand that there is any distinctness in the midst of relationship or even of unity which expresses our idea of aspects. Ulti- mately the relation of Śabda, Artha, and Pratyaya is an identica1 equation and not a ratio, that is fraction with a numerator and denominator, Whilst on the absolute plane THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 14 which is the Cosmic Causal body the three are one, there is, on and with the manifestation of the subtle body, a divergent descent of the three, retaining as they always do their mutual connection. The causal aspect is Śabdabrah- man, the Stress or Creative Śakti giving rise to motion and bodies produced by it which are forms of the subtle and gross Śakti. What was a simple stress in quiescent and unaffected consciousness with unitary experience becomes bifurcated as mind and matter. It is here most important to remember (for it is the key to that which follows) that the nature of a process in which the One becomes Many involves this:—the essential substance (Spirit) of both Mind and Matter remains the same, and the Śakti elements and the motion of both are similar. Hence they are mutually connected with a natural relation. Feeling and object of feeling are correlated. Thus sensa- tion through the eye and Manas, and colour as an object which is perceived, are at base the one Ātmā thus dually manifested. The sensation of sight and the colour are both again products of Tejas-Tanmātra. The Indriya is Sāttvikām ̣ śa of the Apañcīkṛ ta-Tanmātra, and the object seen is the Tāmasikāmśa of the same. In Sām ̣ khya, and commonly in the Śākta-Tantras, both are products of the same Aham ̣ kāra. Sensation and its object are two aspects of one and the same thing. The vibration of the objeat (Artha) and of the Vṛ tti or modification of mind by which apprehension (Pratyaya) is had of it are the same, and the natural name (Śabda) of an object (Artha) is the sound produced by the forces which constitute it. There exists all this parallelism because our postulate is that mind and matter are but twin aspects of the one undivided Self. So when an object (Viṣ aya, Artha) affects the senses (Indriya), being attended to by that function of mind which is called Manas, there arises in the mind a ARTHA, PRATYAYA AND ŚABDA 15 modification (Vṛ tti) of its substance which is an exact counterpart of the external object. In passing I may observe that this is a fundamental principle on which all Tāntrik-Sādhana by way of Upāsanā rests. By worship and meditation or Japa of Mantras the mind is actually Shaped into the form of the object of worship and is made pure for the time being through the purity of the object (namely Iṣ tadevatā), which is its content. By continual practice (Abhyāsa) the mind becomes full of the object to the exclusion of all else, steady in its purity, and does not stray into impurity. So long as mind exists it must have an object and the object of Sādhana is to present it with a pure one. Before proceeding further it is necessary to have clear notions as to the meaning of Mind, Matter, Pratyaya, Śabda and Artha. Everything is “material” according to the Vedānta which is not Pure Transcendent Spirit (Anupahita-Cit). Immanent or Upahita-Cit is that which is associated with mind and matter. This Cit with Upādhi is either Para = Śuddha-sattva-pradhāna = Utkṛ ṣ topādhi = Sama ṣ ti, or Apara = Malina-sattva-pradhāna = Nikṛ ṣ topādhi = Vyaṣ ti. In each of these there are the three bodies causal (Kāraṇ a), subtle (Sūkṣ ma) and gross (Sthūla). This Upādhi is Śakti as Māyā or Prakṛ ti- Śakti as that term is used in Advaitavāda. As Prakṛ ti- Śakti is “material” not as being scientific “matter” but as the subtle material cause of all things, all its effects (Vikṛ ti) are necessarily of the same character as their cause and are material. These Vikṛ tis may be divided into the two parallel groups of Mind (Antahkaraṇ a) and its outer instruments or senses (Indriya), and Matter or Pañca- bhūta derived from the more rudimentary forms of infra- sensible “matter” which are the Pañca-Tanmātras. These are beyond the threshold of sensation of the ordinary Jīva. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 16 What then is Mind? It follows from the above that it is a manifestation of Śakti or Power in the form of force, which is Power translated to the material plane, and is as much a material (Bhautika) substance as is matter (Bhūta) itself. Thought (for except in Samādhi mind is never free of thought) is from the creative standpoint a passing thought and matter a lasting thought. Matter is a dense and gross form of the more subtle and tenuous form of the common Prakṛ ti-Śakti. Mind is Bhautika because it is according to Vedānta composed of the Sāttvik part (Sāttvikām ̣ śa) of the Tanmātra. According to Sām ̣ khya it is Aham ̣ kāri. According to Vedānta Mind is not Vibhu that is all-spreading, unlimited and indivisible into parts: nor is it Anu or atomic that is limited and indivisible into parts. It is Madhyama-Parimāṇ a, that is limited and divisible into parts and thus takes the form of its objects. Mind has parts in the sense that it is divisible into parts, that is one part of the mind can attend to one thing and to another at one and the same time. As it also takes the shape of the object perceived, it spreads or shrinks with it. It pervades the whole body whether in the waking (Jāgrat) or dreaming state (Svapna), but in deep sleep (Suṣ upti) it is withdrawn as all else into the causal body and according to one account is then absorbed in the Nādī. What then is the nature of knowing by the mind? According to the Naiyāyikas who hold that the mind is atomic (Aṇ u), it does not go forth, or transform itself into the shape of the object. Jñāna is a Guṇ a of Ātmā which is produced by the association of Mind (Manas) and Ātmā. According to Vedānta, Jñāna is a transforma- tion (Pariṇ āsma) of the Antahkaraṇ a or Mind which is a Tattva of Madhyama-Pariṇ āma. Jñāna is of two kinds, viz., Jñāna Svarūpa and Jñāna Vṛ tti. The former ARTHA, PRATYAYA AND ŚABDA 17 is Brahmasvarūpa or Perfect Experience or Cit. The latter is knowledge of objects or the ordinary worldly imperfect experience. Opinion varies ss to the mode of operation in the case of the Mind and Jñānavṛ tti. According to some, light from the eye goes forth. Hence the eye is called Tejas. Mind going forth with the light of the eye impinges upon and takes the shape of the object. Mind is called “transparent” (Svaccha) because it can take the shape of any object presented to it. Ātmā is ever illuminat- ing the mind and when there is a particular Vṛ tti, Ātmā illuminates it so that it is present to the limited con- sciousness. Knowledge is true or false (Mithyā). Right knowledge or Pramā is defined as Tadvati tat-prakārakajñānam ̣ which means apprehension of an object according to ite true nature, that is, in its own class or Jāti. The mind not only perceives a particular thing (Vyakti) but also the genus or class (Jāti) to which it belongs; for this Jāti is not merely a subjective thing but is inherent in the Vyakti as its nature (Prakāra) and both are perceived in right knowing, as when in the case of Ghata (jar) its Jāti or Ghatatva (jar-ness) is perceived. Where however a rope is mistaken for a snake there is Mithya-Jñāna. The particular rope excites knowledge, but it is false knowledge, because through a defect (Doṣ a in the percipient subject, the rope is not perceived under its Jāti but under that of a serpent. In short in right perception there is true conformity of thought with its object. To perceive on the other hand a rope where there is Ghatatva is false perception. What then is Artha or object (Viṣ aya)? This is the object which constitutes the mind's content. Object is manifold as the various forms (Rūpa) which make the universe. It is the “other” which the Self as mind perceives. These forms are constituted of the five Bhūtas— THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 18 Ākāṣ a, Vayu, Tejas, Ap, Pṛ thivi representing various densities or Prākṛ tic substance. Just as the mind is a form of motion (Spandana) of that substance, so the five Bhūtas are five forms of motion of the same Prakṛ ti which in the Tantras are symbolised by figures denoting the forms of the vibration namely a circle with openings (Chidra) shown as points on it denoting the interstitial character of Ākāṣ a; a circle denoting Vāyu; and a triangle, crescent and cube square denoting Tejas, Ap, and Pṛ thivi respectively. The direction of the vibration also varies as being in all directions, at an acute angle to the line of the wave (Tiryag-gamanaśīla) upwards, downwards and “in the middle” where the forces are equilibrated and matter becomes stationary. These again are space-giving, general movement (Calanapara), expansion, contraction, cohesion, stimulating the sense of hearing, touch and feel, (not all forms of contact), sight or colour and form, taste, and smell respectively, the centres of which in the Pindānda are the Cakras from Viśuddha to Mulādhāra. The Bīja Mantras of these are Ham ̣ , Yam ̣ , Ram ̣ , Vam ̣ , Lam ̣ , the meaning of which is later explained when dealing with natural name. They seem like gibberish to the uninitiated. Hence even the common Bengali expression “What Hayaralava is this?” These Bhūtas derive from the Tanmātra com- mencing with Śabda-Tanmātra or infra-sensible sound, which by addition of mass becomes Ākāṣ a, the Guṇ a of which is sensible sound, which generates Vāyu-Tanmātra from which comes Vāyu Bhūta and so on with the rest, though the mode of derivation is not always given in the same terms. The substance of it is that Bhūta or gross sensible matter is derived from a subtle form of the same which is not sensible by the gross ear but mentally appre- hensible by the Yogī. Hence it is said Tāni vastūni tan- mātrādīni pratyakṣ a-viṣ ayāṇ i (that is to Yogīs). Object ARTHA, PRATYAYA AND ŚABDA 19 (Viṣ aya) is thus not limited to the gross objects seen by the senses of ordinary men. There are also subtle objects which may be perceived through the senses or the mind by the possessor of “Powers” (Siddhi) which are merely ex- tensions of natural faculty. These are hidden from ordinary men whose powers vary. Some can perceive more than others. By scientific instruments we oan see (microscope) and hear (microphone) things beyond the capacity of the highest natural power of the senses. Is that the end? No, because as we perfect these auxiliaries of natural instru- ments we see and hear more. Once the microscope gave only a magnification of a few diameters. Now it is of thou- sands. At each stage more is known. A point however is reached at which “seeing” takes place not through the gross senses but.by the mind. Everything may be an object which is not the Asan ̣ gabrahman or Brahmasvarūpa that is the Supreme Self or Spirit as It is in Itself. This is not known by either sense or mind or by any Pramāṇ a or in- strument of knowledge. Even Śabda-Pramāṇ a or Veda here fails. Because Brahman as It is in Itself (Svarūpa) is never an object, being the true nature of the cognising Self. As such it is beyond mind and speech. The latter can only give an indication (Lakṣ aṇ a) of it. Higher objects beyond the reach of the senses (Atīndriya) are only perceived by the heightened powers of the mind of Yogīs. Mind, for instance, is Atindriya for it cannot be sensed. Yet Yogīs can “see,” that is, mentally apprehend the mind of another which becomes an object for their apprehension. In such cases his mind takes the form of that other, when every- thing which was in the latter mind namely its modification (Vṛ ittis) or thoughts are known to him. And so the experience of objects becomes more and more subtle and inclusive until the state of Supreme Experience Itself is attained when there is neither subject nor object. This is THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 20 Brahma-svarūpa. This apprehension or image which one has of an object (Artha) evoked by a word (Śabda) is called Pratyaya. The third form of divergent descent of the Śabda-brahman, namely Śabda, will be the subject of a following chapter. CHAPTER III AŚABDA AND PARAŚABDA INDIAN doctrine revolves round the two concepts of Change- lessness and Change. As these propositions, cannot be logically predicated of the same substance, recourse is had to the doctrine of aspects. According to this, Braham as It is in Itself (Brahasvarūpa) or Śiva does not change, but Brahman as the Power (Śakti) from which the world evolves does, as Māyā, change. It is perhaps more simple to say that Brahman produces and exists as the world without derogation to Its own unchanging unity. How this can be is like other ultimates inconceivable. But its truth is said to rest on two established facts, namely the daily experience of the world of the many on the one hand, and the ecstatic (Samādhi) experience of the One on the other. Both are facts of experience though how they can be so is a mystery. When we come to deal with the Mantra-Śastra the same doctrines are expressed in the language of the subject with which it is occupied, namely Śabda, of which Mantras are forms. Śabda or sound exists only where there is motion or Spanda. If there is no Spanda there is no Śabda. If there is Śabda there is Spanda. But the transcendent Brahman or Cit (Brahmasvarūpa) is quiescent and changeless. Therefore it is said to be without motion (Niṣ panda) and without Śabda (Aśabda). From out of this Cit (for there is but one) but without affecting its own THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 22 changelessness, there arises a creative stir or Stress which evolves into the universe. This is the work of the active Brahman or Īśvara. Just as the Parabrahman is Aśabda, Īśvara is Śabdabrahman or Paraśabda. As the former is Niśabda, the latter, as Māyā Śakti, is with motion (Saspanda). Paraśabda, Parā Vāk or Śabdabrahman are each names for the Brahman as the cause of the manifested Śabda. Paraśabda is the causal body of sound. Śabda– tanmātra is the subtle body of sound, and Ākāśa is the gross body of sound which (though a Guṇ a of it) is only apprehended through the medium of air, the sound waves in which strike the ear. Through the latter and mind the sensation of sound is experienced. Śabdatanmātra is pure natural sound as apprehended by Hiraṇ yagarbha or Yogis who share his experience. Gross sound is of two kinds, namely Vaidik sound (Śrauta śabda) or approximate natural sound either primary or secondary, and Lankika Śabda, the speech of the ordinary average mortals other than Vaidika Śabda. Taking “cognizance” to mean “direct apprehension,” Īśvara has cognizance of all kinds of Śabda, (Paraśabda, Śabda Tanmātra, Śrauta Śabda, Laukika Śabda), Hiraṇ yagarbha or Sūtrātmā of the last three, Ṛ ṣ is of the last two and ordinary men of the last only. From Paraśabda or Parā-Vāk therefore proceed in their order Śabda-tanmātra, Śrauta Śabda, and Laukika Śabda. Dealing nextly with Pratyaya, Artha and Śabda in their cosmic and individual aspects,—in the Īśvara stage (i.e. in so far as there is the cosmic causal body) Pratyaya is the Īśvara consciousness of His own body of Bliss (Ānandamaya) and the cosmic ideation (Sṛ ṣ ti-kalpanā) whereby He projects the world. This Sṛ ṣ ti-kalpanā again is the stressing mass of Prakṛ ti or Māyā and Avidyā śakti, and this is the Paraśabda or Parā-Vāk, involving ARTHA, PRATYAYA AND ŚABDA 23 (as the cause involves its effects) the various kinds of Apara-Śabda including the Mātṛ kās, Varṇ as and Mantras. The approximate representation of the causal (Para) Śabda as a whole to the Ṛ ṣ i-ear is “Om ̣ .” It is however to be noted that Īśvara’s whole Pratyaya is not Sṛ ṣ ti-kalpanā. His Artha is the stressing mass of Prakṛ ti. It is further to be noted that, in Īśvara, Pratyaya, Śabda, and Artha are one and not distinct though co-related, as in Hiraṇ yagarbha, Virāt and the individual Jīva. What we may call the elements of the universe namely the Apañchīkṛ ta Bhūtas or Tanmātras, the Indriyas, Prāṇ as, Antahkaraṇ a and Sthūla Bhūtas are evolved directly by Īśvara as Īśvara. This is Bhūtasṛ ṣ ti. He then, as Hiraṇ yagarbha, evolves Bhautika-Sṛ ṣ ti. The elements themselves must be traced directly to the causal body, but as Hiraṇ yagarbha he compounds them. Hence Hiraṇ yagarbha’s Sṛ ṣ ti-kalpanā refers to Bhautikā Sṛ ṣ ti, that is the compounding of the elements which have been already provided by Īśvara as Īśvara. Śabda in the Hiraṇ yagarbha aspect is Śabda-tanmātra involving the lower or derivative forms. His Artha is everything except the Samaṣ ti causal body. Bhautika-Sṛ ṣ ti may relate either to Sūkṣ ma or Sthūla elements, the former being everything except the latter; so that theoretically the creative operation may be divid- ed between Sūtrātma and Virāt. But the Śāstra does not in fact contemplate such a division. Virāt is Cit associated with the created whole—a natura naturata as it were, to borrow Spinoza’s term. Causal activity does not appear to be extended to this. However, if we provision- ally leave the compounding of the Stūla elements to Virāt, then its Pratyaya too may be called Sṛ ṣ ti-kalpanā. His Śabda is various grades of sound, gross and subtle, extending to, but not including, Śabda-tanmātra. His THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 24 Artha is everything except the Samaṣ ti causal and subtle body. Sūkṣ ma and Sthūla are relative terms and admit of grades; hence between the limits of Śabda-tanmātra and average gross sounds there will be more and more subtle sounds—all apprehended by Hiraṇ yagarbha; all save the Tanmātra being apprehended by Virāt as Virāt. If we define Sūkṣ ma as what is of the order of the Tanmātra, then Sthūla is a graded series with Tanmātra as the superior limit. Then Cit associated with this whole series of Sthūla is Virāt. The latter identifies Himself with Samaṣ ti Sthūla-Deha. It is however a long way from the Annamaya Kośa of average perception to the Prāṇ amaya Kośa which comes “next” in order of fineness and which is a modifica- tion (Rājasika) of the Tanmātras. What the Śāstra calls Annamaya-kośa is therefore really a graded series. The gross body is made up of visible cells: those of microscopic granules; those of still finer corpuscles; and so on. The five Kośas are therefore only five broad landmarks in a series consisting of innumerable gradations as are the seven colours of the rainbow. Hiraṇ yagarbha and Virāt are also the types corresponding cosmically to our experiences of certain distinctive forms, in a really innumerable series of forms. So that instead of three we may say that there are innumerable creative Cit-śaktis. If the numbers are given differently there is no essential discrepancy. Īśvara, Hira- ṇ yagarbha, and Virāt are three forms of creative manifestation corresponding cosmically to the Susupti, Svapna and Jāgrat. But the truth-seers, as compared with the system-makers, salute Him as the Many-formed (Namaste bahūrapāya). Īśvara has direct apprehension of all three collectively, causal, subtle, and gross. The cause involves the effects. As Hiraṇ yagarbhe, He apprehends directly the second and third (Svapna Jāgrat), and as Virāt he apprehends the third (Jāgrat). ARTHA, PRATYAYA AND ŚABDA 25 We pass now to the individual (Vyaṣ ti) aspect. Corresponding with Īśvara and with Mayā we have Prājñā with Avidya. The Pratyaya of Prājña is the Vyaṣ ti counterpart in Śuṣ upti of the Ānandamaya consciousness which Īśvara has of His own causal body. Some English writers misunderstand the statement in the Upaniṣ ad that the Jīva in dreamless sleep is Brahman to mean that the experience in slumber is that of Īśvara, or of the Supreme Brahman. Of course this is not so, for the Prājña’s experience then is associated with Avidyā whereas Īśvara’s is free of all Avidyā. The comparison is made by way of analogy. For just as in Suṣ upti the Jīva loses the sense of duality, since all objects as separate things disappear in slumber, so in Īśvara there is no sense of separateness. All things are conceived as in and as Him- self. The Śabda of Prājña is Paraśabda-Viśeṣ a. This is no sound to him but that “part” of the causal stress which is the causal body of the particular Jīva. His Artha is the Vyaṣ ti causal body, that is, the temporary equilibrium in Susupti of the Stress which makes the Jīva. As in the Samaṣ ti experience, Pratyaya, Artha and Śabda are one. Sangskāras are latent and all Vrittis are withdrawn into the Kāraṇ a-Deha. The forces of all subsequent Jīva-processes are there. Hence the experience of this fund of causal energy corresponds to Īśvara Pratyaya of His causal body. Sṛ ṣ ti- kalpanā of Īśvara is not the whole Pratyaya of Īśvara. For though in Pralaya the former is not there, Īśvara has Prat- yaya still, namely the Ānandamaya consciousness of His own causal body. The Prājña Pratyaya corresponds to this. The Śabdic counterpart of this is Para-śabdaviśeṣ a while in Īśvara it is the Para-śabda whole involving all Viśeṣ as. The Paraśabda in Jīva is no sound. Artha here is, as stated, the Vyaṣ ti causal body which is the temporary equilibrium of the Stress constituting the Jīva. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 26 Passing to Taijasa, corresponding to Hiraṇ yagarbha as Prājña does to Īśvara, his Pratyaya is experience of Sūkṣ ma-Deha or subtle body in sleep (Svapna). His Śabda is that which is not expressed by the vocal origin, being the mental image of artioulate or inarticulate sound pushing up in Yoga to the Tanmātras. His Artha is the Vyaṣ ti Sūkṣ ma-Deha. The Pratyaya of the Sūkṣ ma Deha is either pleasurable or painful. Hiraṇ yagarbha’s Pratyaya includes two parts, viz., (a) experience of cosmic (Samaṣ tirūpa) Sūkṣ ma elements as well as Sthūla ele- ments and (b) Sṛ ṣ ti-kalpanā referring to the compound- ing of these elements already evolved by Īśvara. In Taijasa there is (aa) experience of the Jāgrat-vāsanārūpa Svapna or Vyaṣ ti Sūkṣ ma-Deha but not quite of the Jāgrat or Vyaṣ ti Sthūla-Deha, (bb) Sṛ ṣ ti-kalpanā mani- festing as a compounding activity as regards various dream forms. On comparison it is found that the parallelism bet- ween Hiraṇ ya and Taijasa is not complete, a fact due to an important distinction between the two. Īśvara, Hiraṇ yagarbha and Virāt are Para or Utkṛ ṣ topādhi; the Upādhi (i.e., Māyā-śakti) is preponderatingly Sāttvika. Hence as regards the relative scope of Śabda, Artha, Pratyaya, the three aspects may be represented by three concentric circles of which Īśvara is the outermost and Virāt the innermost. Hence Īśvara’s Pratyaya, Artha, and Śabda include those of Hiraṇ yagarbha; those of Hiraṇ yagarbha include those of Virāt. It must not be thought that the Śabda, Artha, and Pratyaya of Īśvara, Hiraṇ yagarbha, and Virāt are exclusive or ejective. The Sātttvika character of their limitations implies the concentric arrangement of the three cir- cles. But Prājña, Taijasa, Viśva have Upādhis which, though Sāttvika, are impure and coarse (Malina). Hence ARTHA, PRATYAYA AND ŚABDA 27 practically as regards Śabda, Artha and Pratyaya we have Prājna Taijasa Vishva in lieu of Virat H i a r a n ya- g a r b h a Ī s h var a In other words they are practically ejective ciroles. Hence the first Pratyaya is practically confined to Śuṣ upti, his Artha to the Vyaṣ ti causal body and Śabda to Paraśabda section. Taijasa experiences Svapna and Sūkṣ madeha, but is practically ignorant of Prājña’s state and Viśva’s state. So with Viśva. But though their experiences apparently exolude one another, the causal unity between them is not in fact wanting. Taijasa’s Artha is Sūkṣ ma-deha-vyaṣ ti which con- tains the seeds of Jāgrat. His Śabda is the subtle form of the gross sound. The mental image of a sound becomes apparent or Prātibhāsika sound during the dream-state THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 28 (Svapna); higher sounds even may be heard during this. The Yogic state is a voluntary refining and deepening of this state; and hence Dhyāna is called Yoga-nidrā. With the perfecting of the Yogic state one may rise to Śabda-tanmātra; or even in Samādhi to Para-'Jabda and Aśabda. The former is the cosmic Suṣ upti and the latter the Turīya state from which, when regarded as the supreme state, there is no return. Of the individual Viśva, corresponding to the cosmic or collective Virāt, Pratyaya is the experience of Vyaṣ ti Sthūla-Deha; Śabda is the gross sound articulate (Varna) or inarticulate (Dhvani) emitted by men, animals and natural objects. The Artha is the gross body (Sthūla Deha) and its processes and the gross environment and its processes. The Jāgrat-Sṛ ṣ tikalpanā here manifests as feelings of bodily movements caused by Sam ̣ skāra and Icchā Śakti. But as Virāt is rather the created (Kārya) than the creative (Kāraṇ a) aspect of the whole, so is Viśva the Kārya aspect rather than the Kāraṇ a aspect of the section, that is the finitized centre of con- sciousness or Jīva. The Artha is the gross body and its processes together with the environment of that body and its processes. The Śabdas are the sounds emitted by the vocal organs of men and animals or otherwise produced by natural objects. This is Vaikharī sound which is a develop- ment from Paraśabda, through Paśyantī and Madhyamā sound. Paraśabda or Parāvāk is Bindu. Paśyantī is Īkṣ aṇ a or creative thought and action by that Bindu which is the causal body of Śabda. From this arises the subtle body of Śabda which is Tanmātra and Mātrikā which evolves into the gross body of sound, which is the letters (Varṇ a) uttered by the vocal organs which are made up into syllables and words (Pada) and then in senten- ces (Vākya). Mantra, so uttered, is a, form of the gross ARTHA, PRATYAYA AND ŚABDA 29 body of Śabda. And this applies both to Bījas and other Mantras. Śabda-Tanmātra or Apañci-kṛ ta Ākāśa is Apañcī-kṛ ta- Tanmātra. This is sound as such, that is, ideal sound or the cognition of sound apart from conditions such as ear, brain and other material conditions such as air, water, earth, whereby sound is transmitted. In the case of Śabda- Tanmātra, sound is known as an object of the higher mind apart from these conditions. Therefore Śabda-Tanmātra is Śabda not conditional to varying perceptive faculties. It is not sound which is heard by this individual or that, on this plane or that; but it is sound as heard by the Absolute Ear and as uttered by the Absolute Tongue. It is invariable and Apaurusheya. Similarly Rūpa Tanmātra is form unconditional, as seen by the Absolute Eye. By “Absolute Ear” is meant the power (Śakti) of apprehend- ing sound in itself or as such without subjection to the varying conditions of Time, Place, (i.e. Plane) and person. The Stress by which a thing is generated and sustained is the basis of all the five Tanmātras. It is Śabda-Tanmātra as apprehended by the Absolute Ear, Rūpa Tanmātra as apprehended by the Absolute Eye, and so on. From the gross standpoint Śabda is not the Guṇ a of Ākāś a alone. In order to be manifested to the human mind and ear sound requires not only gross Ākāśa but Vayu and the other Bhūtas. For the transmission of sound to the limited ear there must be a material medium for its transmission whether as air, water or solid body. Virāt sound in short assumes the existence of the whole material universe. To sum up—There is the unmanifest Lord (Avyakta Īśvara) and the manifest Lord (Īśvara). Both are Śiva- Śakti because there is never Śiva without Śakti nor Śakti without Śiva, whether in creation or dissolution. Only in the latter there is nothing but Consciousness THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 30 (Śakti being Cidrūpiṇ ī,) and in the former She assumes the form of the universe. For this reason the supreme state may be called Śiva-Śakti and the manifest state Śakti-Śiva to denote the preponderance of the Cit and Māyā aspects respectively. One state is motionless (Niṣ panda), the other with motion (Saspanda). One is soundless (Aśabda), the other manifests as sound (Śabda). In one is the Unmanī-Śakti, in the other the Samanī Śakti. The manifest Īśvara displays itself in three forms—causal, subtle, gross. The causal form is Paraśabda, Parāvāk, or Śabda-brahman. This is Īśvara. The rest is Aparāvāk. The subtle form is Madhyamā vāk, which is Hiraṇ yagarbha sound, which develops into Virāt Śabda or Vaikharī vāk. The sound is accompanied by move- ment. That of the causal body first projecting the manifold universe from out of itself is general movement or Sāmānya Spanda, the Śabda of which is the Praṇ ava or “Om ̣ .” From Om ̣ all other Mantras are derived. Hiraṇ yagarbha Śabda is accompanied by special motion (Viśesa Spanda) and Virst Śabda is clearly defined movement (Spaṣ tatara Spanda) manifesting in man as articulate speech, and therefore as the gross or uttered form of Mantra. CHAPTER IV PARAŚABDA, CAUSAL ŚABDA ŚABDA which comes from the root Śabd “to make sound” ordinarily means sound in general including that of the voice, word, speech and language. It is either letter- ed sound (Varnāmaka śabda) and has a meaning (Artha), that is, it either denotes a thing or connotes the attributes and relations of things; or it is unlettered sound and meaningless (at any rate to us) and is mere Dhvani (Dhvanyātmaka-Śabda) such as the sound of a rushing torrent, a clap of thunder and so forth. I say “to us” because every sound may have a meaning for Īśvara. This Dhvani arises from the contact of two things striking one another. So lettered sound is manifested through the contact of the vocal organs with the outer air. As else- where more fully explained, Śabda is, and exists as, four Saktis namely Parā, Pashyantī, Madhyamā and Vaikharī. These are referred to in connection with Vāk or Devī Sarasvatī, another synonym for Śabda. Śabda again is either immanent in its manifestation as sound, or transcendent. The first is threefold: (a) From an average point of view it means sound of either of those classes as heard by ears and sounds whose capacitiy (Śakti) is that of the normal or average plane. (b) From the Yogic point of view it means subtle sound, that is, subtle sound as apprehended by ears and minds which are supernormal and therefore whose Śaktis rise above the average plane. But these capacities can be greater or less and therefore THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 32 admit of grades, on person’s capacity being greater than that of another, just as is the case with individuals in the ordinary plane, some of whom can hear better than others. (c) From the standpoint of the “Absolute Ear” that is a capacity to apprehend sound unconditionally such as exists in the case of the perfect Yogi it means pure sound or Śabda-tanmātra. This is apprehended by the perfect Yogi in its purity. All these are effects (Kārya). Transcendent Śabda means creative movement or Causal Stress itself, that is, it is not, the effect or manifestation (i.e. sound) to either the relative ear (a and b) or the “absolute ear” (c) but the cause (Kārana) or Manifesting Fact itself. This in the Śastra is Śabda-brahman, that is, the source of all Śabda or name (Nāma) and of all form (Rūpa), the universe being “Name and form” (Nāmarūpātmaka). Thus we rise step by step starting from average experience to supreme experience; from projections and manifestations to the Thing Itself which is Causal Stress or Śabda-brah- man. The term Śabda is throughout retained, though the connotations enlarge and deepen as we proceed upwards. This is in conformity with the concrete way in which Hindu thought has developed and by which the all-pervading and all-manifesting power of the Divine Śakti is shown. In teaching, it is the Arundhatīdarśananyāya, according to which a husband shows (or rather used to show—for, is Arundhatī sought now?) his newly-wedded wife the tiny star Arundhatī, emblem of constant chastity, by drawing her attention first to some neighbouring big star. “You see this, now look to the left you see this, well next to it you see Arundhatī.” So a Guru deals with his disciple (Śiṣ ya) in a way suitable to the latter’s intelligence. He cannot learn what is the highest all at once. He must make his way upward to it. “Brahman is this; no it is that; no it is this;” and so on until the highest notion of It is PARAŚABDA, CAUSAL ŚABDA 33 capable of being given. Thus the Guru in Śruti says “Annam ̣ Brahma," that is Brahman is the food which the disciple eats as also matter generally. Then as the latter’s knowledge deepens, the Guru changes the connotation of the word Brahman but retains the term itself. The disciple then consecutively learns that Life is Brahman (Prāṇ āh Brahma). Intelligence is Brahman (Vijñānam ̣ Brahma) and finally Bliss is Brahman (Ānandam ̣ Brahma) where at last experience rests. Here there are five con- notations of “Brahman,” each more comprehensive and deeper than the foregoing, gradually evolved as the spiritual life of the Śiṣ ya unfolds and perfects itself. The con- notations of most of the important philosophical terms have been evolved in this way. Thus there are different meanings of Prāṇ a, Ākāśa, Vāyu and so forth. Śabda also has the four meanings stated which thought progres- sively evolves in the manner above stated. Some may think that from the standpoint of pure logic this state of things is unacceptable. We have however to deal with the matter practically. And what life wants is generally not that which pure logic demands. But apart from that the method and the statements are true. For Brahman is all things as Śakti, though the Brahman in itself (Brahmasvarūpa) is beyond them all. If those, before whom all connotations of Brahman are at once placed, complain of ambiguity, this is due to the fact that they have not mastered their subject. And because the subject must be gradually mastered the Guru takes his Śiṣ ya gradually upwards to the point where all aspects are seen in relation to the whole (Pūrṇ a) whose aspects they are. For the present Chapter I will start at the beginning namely Causal Śabda or Śabdabrahman. Śiva has two aspects namely Niṣ kala (without parts), Nirguṇ a (without attribute) and Sakala (with parts) Sagwa (with THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 34 attribute). The first is the unmanifested transcendent Supreme and the second the manifested and immanent creative Lord (Īśvara) or Ruling Mother (Īśvarī). The first is Niṣ panda, without movement, for it is the eternal changeless Brahman. It is Aśabda which here means the same thing, for being unmanifsst there is neither Śabda as effect nor Śabda as cause. The latter means that there is then no Causal Stress. The other aspect is called Śabdabrahman which appears at creation from out of Brahman which is the equilibrated condition of Śakti. From the Śabdabrahman all particular Śabdas as Nantras or otherwise appear. Śabdabrahman is in Itself Avyakta (unmanifest) Śabda which is the cause of manifested (Vyakta) Śabda, Artha and Pratyaya and which uprises from the form of Bindu on the differentiation of the Supreme Bindu due to the prevalence of Kriyā- Śakti in Prakṛ ti, Kriyāśakti pradhānāyah śabda śabdārtha kāranam ̣ Prakṛ terbindurūpiṇ yāh śabdabrahmābhavat param Śāradā-Tilaka 1-12. In other words the unmanifest potentiality of power which subsequently appears as Śabda and therefore as Artha and Pratyaya becomes manifest through its activity, manifesting in Prakṛ iti in the form of Bindu which is the undifferentiated Śiva Śakti. With such activity Bindu becomes threefold as Śabda, Artha, Pratyaya. Avyakta-Rava is the Principle of sound as such (Nāda Mātra) that is undifferentiated sound not speciaIised in the form of letters but which is through creative activity the cause of manifested Śabda and Artha which are Its forms. Tema śabdārtha-rūpa-vīśishtasya śabda-brahmatvam ̣ avadhāritam ̣ —(Prānatoṣ inī 18). It is the Brahman considered as well-pervading Śabda, undivided and unmanifested whose substance is Nāda and PARAŚABDA, CAUSAL ŚABDA 35 Bindu, the proximate creative impulse in Paraśiva and proximate cause of manifested Śabda and Artha. Sṛ ṣ tiyun- mukha-paramaśiva-prathamollāsamātram akhaṇ dovyakto nādabindumaya eva vyāpako b r a h m ā t m a k a śabdah (See Prānatoṣ inī 10. Rāgkava Bhatta Com. on v. 12, Ch. I, Śāradā-Tilaka). The creative Brahman is called Śabdabrahman. It may be asked why is this so, since the Saguṇ a-Śiva (which Śabdabrahman is) is the cause not only of all Śabdas but of all Artha (Rūpa) and Pratyaya. This is so but the Śāstra uses the term Śabdabrahman because it is here considering the origin of Śabda. But Śruti in explaining creation is impartial as between Śabda, Artha or Pratyaya. Now it says “creation is out of Śabda” (Śabda-prabhaya) regarding the universe as con- stituted of Śabda (Vān ̣ mava) in its causal sense. Now it says that creation is out of Pratyaya using that term in the sense of creative ideation (Sṛ ṣ tikalpanā). Now it says “Creation is out of Artha” that is the supreme Artha the cosmic “Stuff” or cosmic “Matter” which is Prakṛ ti-śakti. What is done in such a case is to take an effect (Kārya) known to us, and to refer it to the one cause of all effects, giving that cause however the name of the particular effect which is the subject of consideration. Moreover the Śabda aspect of Brahman is of the highest importance for it is in this aspect that It is Veda. But what is the sense in which Śabda is used in the term Śabda-Brahman? This has been already indicated in the quotations above cited. Śabda here does not mean either gross or subtle sound. To begin with these are both effects (Kārya) and we are dealing with their cause (Kāraṇ a). Manifested sound is a Guṇ a of Ākāśa. But in what sense? It is not merely a quality of Ether and thus not anything else; that is the term Śabda is not THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 36 limited to the Guṇ a of Ākāśa. If it were it would not be possible to explain the well-known scientific experiment (which in early days was supposed to “demolish” all Hindu theories) in which a ringing bell ceases to be heard in a closed vessel from which the Air has been pumped out, but in which Ether still remains. If Śabda vere the Guṇ a of Ākāśa only and unconnected with anything else it could not be said that sound increases and decreases, appears and disappears with Vāyu. Hence the term Śabda is not limited to sound gross or subtle. It is the Causal Stress or Spanda which inheres in the stressed condition of Cit-Śakti and Māyā-śakti which manifests first as the Śabda Tanmātra to the absolute “Ear,” as more or less subtle sound to a Yogic (though not perfect) ear according as the fundamental Ākāa'a Spanda is adapted to its relative capacity through other more or less dense media; and which finally appears as average human sound when the fundamental Spanda, is adapted to the capacity of the human ear through a medium of such den- sity as the common air. The air therefore like the ear is one of the factors of the manifestation of the fundamental Spanda which is Śabda as the original creative causal Stress or agitation in the body of Prakyti-Śabda. Śabda is the Cosmic Stress itself which takes place in the Primary Ether or Saspanda-Śakti which produces the Śabda Tanmātra which evolves into Ākāśa Bhūta and then into the Vāyu and other Tanmātras and Bhūtas. These according to Vedanta are Pancīkṛ ta that is each Tattva has four parts of its own element and one of each of the four others. Through the Bhautika-Sṛ ṣ ti or in- direct causation of Hiraṇ yagarbha there takes place the combination of the Tattvas produced by the Bhūta- sṛ ṣ ti in direct causation (Sākṣ āt-kartṛ tvam ̣ ) of Īśvara producing the gross world of the human senses which is PARAŚABDA, CAUSAL ŚABDA 37 Virāt. Thus the one initial Stress is communicated as and throughout the chain of its effects. To distinguish this Śabda it is called Para-Śabda and the manifested Śabda is Apara-Śabda or commonly Śabda simply. The latter is subtle and gross sound, the first being supersensible to the normal mind and senses and the latter sensible or what we call in its compounds discrete matter. Paraśabda is thus not sound but a state of agitation in the Cosmic Śakti when on the ripening of the Sam ̣ skāras the hitherto exist- ing equilibrium (Sāmyāvasthā of Prakṛ ti is broken. There is then a disturbance (Kṣ obha) or genera1 movement (Sāmanyaspanda) in Śakti and this Cosmic Stress which is Paraśabda or Parāvāk reveals itself in manifested Śabda (Apara). This one stress, which is the potency of all in which it reveals itself, manifests in man as Artha, Prat- yaya, Śabda, in the objects (Prameya) of which he as knower (Pramātri) has apprehension (Pratyaya) and in the names by which he thinks of them as an “after construc- tion in relation to the intuitive experiences of life” as Professor Pramathanātha Mukhopādhyāya has well put it. The primordial Śabda or Parāvāk (corresponding in some ways to the Logos) is the cosmic predisposition to and pre- condition of oreative evolution. The agitation in the primary Substance projecting itself into the sensuous plans becomes audible as Dhvani or sound but is itself only the possibility and substratum of Sound. Creation is said to be Śabda-prabhava, that is it proceeds from, and is a manifestation, of, the Stress or Cosmic Śakti. In this sense every movement or process in the universe is Paraśabda. Aśabda Jagat is a contradiction in terms. Whilst the stress or constituting force is one, It manifests Itself differently to the different sense organs. The Causal Stress when striking the ear and mind produces sound, when striking the eye and mind it produces colour and form, and THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 38 when striking other sense organs it produces other kinds of sensation. It is to be noted that of the five Bhūtas, Ākāśa and Vāyu belong to the formless (Amūrtta) division and the remaining three to the form division (Mūrtta). The first is sensed by hearing. Śabda as lettered sound is vibration for the ear as name. Tejas the head of the second division is sensed as form (Rūpa). Artha is thus vibration to the eye (mental or physical) as form. It is because the one Power rays itself forth in threefold form that Śabda, Artha and Pratyaya as such have a natural and inseparable relation to one another. It is again because the Vaidika- Śabda is assumed (a matter which I will later discuss) to constitute the natural name of, and therefore to be in com- plete correspondence with, the Arthas denoted, that it is held to be eternal. Śruti says that the world is born of Śabda (Śabda-prabhava) and that creation (Sṛ ṣ ti) is Śabda- parvaka, that is Śabda is the antecedent condition of creative process, which cannot be if Śabda be taken to be only that manifestation to the ear and mind (natural or Yogic) which is sound (gross or subtle). This manifesta- tion is a subsequent and consequent fact and is to be distinguished from the antecedent and primordial condition of creation as such. The primordial condition is Causal Stress; that is in the finite ether of consciousness, homo- geneous, quiescent, there is a moving—a stir. Paraśabda is the name for that causal stress as it arises and before it manifests as the universe. To sum up: In the creative process three stages are to be noted: (1) the transcendental quiescent condition immanent in the others, though veiled, which is Aśabdam ̣ , Asparśam ̣ , Arupam ̣ and so forth as Śruti negatively describes it, (2) the condition of cosmic stress which is Śabdabrahman. The stress is a play of Śakti in the Cidākāśa in such a way that the first condition is not PARAŚABDA, CAUSAL ŚABDA 39 effaced when the second appears. The Śabdabrahman is Veda. After manifestation and at the conclusion of the cycle it is wrapped up as potential Māyā-śakti, when according to some, in Mahāpralaya the trans- cendental condition alone is. The human parallel is Suṣ upti. (3) Śabdabraman reproduces itself gradually and partially as countless finite centres of varied finite experiences of Nāma and Rūpa. Hence forms together with sounds sights and so forth vary as do the Śabdas. The sound which represents the above mentioned primordial functioning of the Brahmaśakti is the Mahūbīja “O m ̣ ” or Praṇ ava— Omityekarang brahka tasya vāchakah pranavah. The nature of this great Bija which is the source of all other Mantras will be the subject of a future chapter after we have discussed what is meant by “natural name” which I have more fully dealt with in the Essay bearing that title. CHAPTER V ŚAKTI AS STRESS THE cosmic states of Sṛ ṣ ti, Sthiti and Laya, together with the transcendental Param-Śiva state as also Turīya and the Vyaṣ ti states of Jāgrat, Svapna, Suṣ upti, must all be ultimately expalined (so far as this can be) by the dynamical theory of Śakti as Stress giving rise to moving forms of Herself. For this purpose it is necessary to in- vestigate conditions of equilibrium and movement. What is Stress? Let us suppose that two things A and B are attracting each other. The name for the total mutual action is “stress” of which the respective actions of A and B are the elements, partials, or components. Thus there may be Stress for three or four things and so on. Ultimately we reach Universal Stress which is an infinite system of correlated forces. A particular thing may be defined as a partial experience of this infinite system. Pro- fessor Pramathanātha Mukhopādhyāya to whom I am in- debted in the preparation of this and some of the following papers has given it the appropriate name of “Fact-section.” The infinite system is however never really finitized by these partials. When the Stress between one such partial and another touches the normal of consciousness in either or both, we may have, under circumstances and within certain limits, sensation of sound in either or both. The stress is Śabda and the sound is Dhvani. There may be several stages from the one to the other. It is Stress or ŚAKTI AS STRESS 41 Śabda which constitutes a thing. Whether this Śabda is followed or accompanied by a certain Dhvani or not will depend firstly upon the magnitude of its action in relation to a percipient, and secondly upon the conditions of the percipient’s perceptive organs. Hence in order that a sound may be heard the rates of vibration of the air must be such and such, the ears and brain must be such and such, and so on. Beyond these limits there are no sounds. Thus most objects of experience though influencing us do not express themselves in sounds to us such as the earth, sun, moon, stars and so forth. In the transcendental Parama- shiva or Turīya state which is Nirvāṇ a, all Stress is dis- solved and Śakti is then nothing but Cit, Cidrūpini, Cinmātrarūpiṇ i. This may be illustrated by the case where causal stress being constituted by a number of forces all these severally vanish and are each therefore separately zero so that the resultant is zero. This is the Transcendent Niṣ kala state in which there is no Sṛ ṣ ti-Kalpanā, no Artha, and no Śabda (Aśabda). In the case of Cosmic Suṣ upti we need not take into consideration any external system, for nothing is external to the Cosmos. In this case we have the only static condition where each term is not separately zero, but where each of the forces constitut- ing the Stress balances one another with the result that there is a state of equilibrated energy. This is the state of the Guṇ as in Sarūpa-parināma which, with loss of equili- brium in creation, is Virūpa-parināma. Vyaṣ ti Suṣ upti may be due to two sets of facts. Either the forces constituting this state, without each being separately zero, yet have that resultant, in which case there is equilibrium in the Vyaṣ ti causal body provided the external cosmic system does not disturb this internal equilibrium of the Vyaṣ ti system; or these forces result in something, but this resultant is exactly counterbalanced by the action of the external system. Thus THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 42 this something which would otherwise be the Vyaṣ ti stress system practically vanishes and equilibrium is esta- blished in this last mentioned system. In the first case the external system has no actions on the given internal system but it has action on other Vyaṣ ti systems. Thus the world is not asleep because the individual is so. In the second case the external system has action on the given internal system but this action is just negatived by the reac- tion of the internal on the external. In both cases the external system is an actual stressing attitude. In Svapna and Jāgrat Avasthā the equilibrium of the Samaṣ ti and Vyaṣ ti Suṣ upti or causal body is lost, and in Sṛ ṣ ti there is a system of kinetic stresses which again in Laya lapse into a state of potential stresses. The world process is thus divided into the three stages of Sṛ ṣ ti (creation), Sthiti (maintenance), and Laya (dissolution) which is a passing from a state of homogeneity (Laya) to one of heterogeneity (Sṛ ṣ ti and Sthiti) and back to homogeneity again in an unending series of evolution and involution with periods of rest between. The growth of the universe is thus a pulsing forth of the Bindu holding potentially within Itself, as massive (Ghanibhūta) Śakti, all into which it subsequently evolves. This great Universe dies down again into that from which it sprang. Though we thus speak of three stages it cannot be properly said that there is Sṛ ṣ ti, that when it stops there is Sthiti, and then ultimately there is Laya. Evolution (Sṛ ṣ ti) and involution (Laya) are going on even during Sthiti. There is always, for instance, molecular birth and death. Each of these terms is employed according as one aspect or the other is emphasised. During Laya the stresses are potential. That is actual movements cease, so that the stresses are due simply to the configuration of relative positions of the units determined by their Earmas up to the time of Laya. ŚAKTI AS STRESS 43 There is for instance, stress in a stringed bow though the string may not be in actual movement. The nature of Īśvara experience as the ultimate Fact is as such logical and therefore human categories if stretched to the fact will inevitably lead into paralogisms and antinomies. In the same way creation is an unresolved riddle. Why should the spell of cosmic Susupti be broken and in what way does the Will of God influence it? Ultimately these ques- tions are unanswerable in all faiths. We may say that Īśvara during Laya has experience of the causal body. The absolute “ear,” “tongue,” “eye” which God possesses are reabsorbed into a massive consciousness of Bliss (Ānanda) as is partially the case with the Jīva in Suṣ upti for these are differentiations of His infinite Jñāna-Śakti. These are veiled during Laya, that is the kinetic stresses (Śakti Viśvarūpa become potential (Śakti Cidrūpiṇ i). What is patent becomes latent. The world becomes “Memory” which at the next creation is “remembered” just as in the individual the world is lost to him in dream- less sleep, and when waking he sees and recalls the events of a past day. Yet here the world exists during our sleep for others. But when Īśvara goes to sleep things do not remain as they are. Things return to their causal form or seeds. During Laya, Īśvara has a massive experi- ence of the totality of these “seeds,” for as Śruti says “I am one, I will now be many.” To the question whether this creative act is instantan- eous or successive it may be replied probably neither the one nor the other. That is the category of time is inappli- cable to creation as such or creation as a whole. Creation considered as an instantaneous flash or a successive flow is Vyavahārika and not Pāramārthika. On this basis however there is a difference of opinion between Dṛ ṣ ti-sṛ ṣ ti-vāda and Karma-sṛ ṣ ti-vāda. Acoording to the first, and to me THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 44 preferable, view, as Īśvara thought, so at once the whole world appeared in its stages as subtle and gross. At every moment also creation is taking place. It is not something wholly in the past. According to the second or more com- monly accepted doctrine, the Tattvas came out gradually the one after the other in a specified order (Krama) though such Krama is not referable to time as we know it and which appeared at a lower stage. This latter time is the Janmakāla of the Kālavādins according to whom all is Kāla. The Supreme Time or Mahākāla is Nirguṇ a, Nirviśeṣ a, Nirvikāra or Brahman. As regards the cosmic cycle it is claimed to be proved by (a) induction from observed facts of experience which, all giving signs of periodicity, afford a basis for generaliza- tion; and (b) the alleged actual remembrance by Ṛ ṣ is and other super-souls such as Jaigiṣ avya of Caturyuga, Manvantara, Ealpa and so forth. Apart therefore from Śruti the proof is inductive and experimental and not deductive. Creation proceeds from the generic to the specific. When Laya as a state of potential stresses passes into Sṛ ṣ ti which is a system of kinetic stresses we have first the most generic condition of the latter namely Sāmanya-Spanda, that is general undifferentiated movement. It is the mani- festation of the tendency of Laya to pass into Sṛ ṣ ti. From the standpoint of Consciousness it is the first stage of “Seeing” (Īkṣ aṇ a) that is cosmic ideation on the Part of Īśvara. In the individual it is the borderland between Suṣ upti and Svapna, the moment that Suṣ upti is breaking and Svapna is drawing to pass into Jāgrat. The inertia of the first has passed but the specialised movements of the second and third are not yet in evidence. It is a kind of massive undifferentiated state containing potentially all specialities. The Śabda or acoustic aspect of this tendency ŚAKTI AS STRESS 45 of potential stress to pass into kinetic stress is the Pranava or Maṇ tra “Om ̣ .” This tendency realises itself in the first place in Bhūta- sṛ ṣ ti by Īśvara. Īśvara has consctiousness of his Ānanda- maya Body and Causal Body. The latter means the experience “I am all” (Sarvātmakatva). He experiences Himself as all whether as a whole, as generals or particulars. As Knower of all He is Sarvaña, as Knower of its varieties He is Sarvavit. They are to Him, Himself, for the Māyā with which He is associated does not govern Him and therefore His knowledge does not bind Him. The state of Īśvara though not governed by, is yet associated with, Māyā and is therefore not that of Supreme Mokṣ a. Īśvara wills to be many and the Bhūtas issue from him. As Īśvara He does not think Himself to be their creator. The crea- tion of the Bhūtas (Bhūta-sṛ ṣ ti) according to the Vedāntic order means the evolving of (a) the Apañcīkrta Bhūtas or Tanmātras and (b) their primary compounds which are again (aa) Sūkṣ ma that is Antahkaraṇ a, Indriya and Prāṇ as and (bb) Sthūla that is the Pañcikṛ ta Bhūtas. Broadly speaking these are the elements of creation; the creation of which implies also their natural names or Bījas. Thus from Om ̣ are evolved the Bījas of the Bhūtas Ham ̣ , Yam ̣ , Ram ̣ , Vam ̣ , Lam ̣ and other Bījas such as Hrim ̣ the Māyā Bīja or Praṇ ava of the differentiating Śakti. These elements are special (Viśeṣ a) in relation to the tendency and general movement (Sāmānya-spanda) above mentioned, but are general (Sāmānya) in relation to the derivatives which follow. There than follows Bhautika-Sṛ ṣ ti by Hiraṇ yagarbha that is the creation of the secondary compounds; that is again the mixing up of the “elements” into diverse forms, first the typal and then the variational. This is done by Īśvara in His aspect as Hiraṇ yagarbha. These too THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 46 have their natural names (Śabda). Hiraṇ yagarbha who is the Lord of Brahmaloka thinks himself to be a creator. This is a state of duality in which He thinks that all things are His. Hence Hiraṇ yagarbha as affected by Māyā is a Jīva. Lastly coming to the completed Sthiti we have the actions and reactions of the Bhūtas and Bhautikas such that they continue as a system of the kinetic stresses. These actions and reactions have their natural names which may be called phenomenal Śabdas. Some of these namely those wbich fall between our limits of sensibility are sensi- ble to us. So much as to Śabdas classified with reference to aspects of creation. Śabdas may be either directly or indirectly appre- hended. In the latter case they are received. The ordinary individual does not hear the natural name or sound of Agni or “Ram ̣ ” directly. He is told that it is so having received it from those who have heard that sound. It is “received” (Āpta) and not directly apprehended (Sākṣ ātkṛ ta). For, from the point of view of apprehension, Śabdas are of two kinds, Sākṣ ātkṛ ta and Āpta. The Śabda range of Īśvara, Hiraṇ yagarbha, and Virāt may be thus re- presented. Thus Īśvara has no Āpta or received (indirect) Śabdas: but all Śabdas are directly apprehended (Sākṣ ātkṛ ta) by Him. Hiraṇ yagarbha, as Hiraṇ yagarbha, that is a parti- cular aspect of Īśvara has direct apprehension of Bhautika- sṛ ṣ ti Śabdas and Sthiti Śabdas and indirect of Bhūtas- sṛ ṣ ti and Laya Śabdas, Virāt as Virāt has direct ap- prehension only of Sthiti Śabdas and indirect apprehension of the rest. This deals with the Samaṣ ti or collective aspects of Experience. Coming to the individual or Vyaṣ ti aspects we have the corresponding states of Prājña, Taijasa and Viśva. These unlike the collective states are mutually ŚAKTI AS STRESS 47 exclusive, the one of the other, and may thus be figured. Prājna Kārana Taijasa Sūkshma Vishva Sthula Prājña has direct but veiled or partial apprehension of his own Vyaṣ ti causal (Laya) Śabda but not of others. This Śabda is however not sound as language for himself. Taijasa has both direet and indirect experience of Vyaṣ ti (i.e., some) subtle Śabda. And Virāt has the same of gross Śabdas. Here in these two cases there is gradation. The gross ear has capacities of varying degree. A scientist may by means of a delicately constructed apparatus hear sounds which are not sensible to the natural ear. A Yogī may hear still more. Thus if either were to hear the rise of sap in a tree that sound would be the direat approximate natural name of that vegetable function. A Yogī in Śat- cakrabheda or piercing of the six centres by Kuṇ dalini- Śakti may, it is said, directly apprehend the Bījas Om ̣ , Ham ̣ , Yam ̣ and the rest, as the passage of śakti gradually vitalises the six centres. A Yogī by mounting to a higher or the highest plane of existence can have direct experience (Sākṣ ātkṛ ta) of any or all kinds of Śabdas. The Absolute Ear hears the Śabda Tanmātra in Ākāśa, not through the impact of undulations, but it hears movement as movement. In Brahmajñāna the Yogī becomes the Brahman Itself when all Stress ceases and there is Peace. CHAPTER VI ETERNALITY OF ŚABDA THE term “eternal” may mean “always is” (a) without change or (b) with change. The former is existence un contradicted in the three times. Change again may be either immanent (Svagata) or its reverse (Taditara). Thus if there be only one circle (A) any change going on within it is Svagatga change or distinction (Bheda). But if there be two circles A and B of which the latter added a part of itself to the former with the result that A is changed, this is not Svagata. Thus Svagata change is Advaita whilst Non-Svagata change presupposes Dvaita. Applying these observations to the Braham and Jīva, the former has three aspects (a) Brahman as Pure Cit (Brahma svarūpa) (b) Brahman as Cit-Śakti (c) Brahman as Māyā Śakti or Prakṛ ti. In the first or transcendent sense Brahman is Pure Cit and this always is as such. From the finite point of view we may either ignore (veil) it or accept it, but it is ever given. It is the changeless background of all change; but Itself has no kind of change. This is the Niṣ kala Paramaśiva to whose powers or Śaktis we next proceed. Cit-śakti is Cit as Śakti, that is Cit immanent in the world the forms of which as Mind and Matter are productions of Māyā-śakti. This immanent Brahman (Cit-śakti) in the sense of the All (which Professor P. N. Mukhopādhyāna aptly calls “Fact” as opposed to ETERNALITY OF ŚABDA 49 “Fact-section”) always is as such. For the All (Pūrṇ a) never ceases to be all. All is all. Śruti says that Pūrṇ a remains Pūrṇ a though Pūrṇ a be taken from it. Brah- man as Cit-śakti is inseperably associated with Māyā-śakti and has only Svagata change or movement. Brahman as Māyā-śakti—what the author cited calls Stress as distin- guished from the background of Cit—is Brahman as Prakṛ ti. This is eternal in the sense that it always is, though either as latent or as patent, as a kinetic force or as a tendency. Here eternity does not exclude change of condition. Brahman as Prakṛ ti has Svagata change. We must not then confound the terms Real and Eternal. According to Advaita-Vedānta the transcendent Brahma- svarūpa is both real and eternal, for “real” is here used in the sense of that which does not change (Kūtastha) whereas Māyā with its changes is neither real nor unreal. “Eternal” therefore includes “change of condition.” Non- eternal or finitized being is, pragmatically considered, marked by three kinds of change and distinction (Bheda), viz. Intrinsic (Svagata) such as the distinction which exists between the leaves and branches of the same tree, and extrinsic which is again of two kinds, uiz., Sajātīya such as the distinction which exists between one kind of tree and another kind of tree, and Vijātīya suoh as the distinction which exists between a tree and the earth and rocks which surround it. The eternal Śabdabrahman manifests at creation (Sṛ ṣ ti) and lapses into its quiescent ground in dissolution (Laya). The Śabda of its first creative movement is the Nāda or Dhvani “Om ̣ .” From this issue all particular Śabdas both Varṇ ātmaka and Dhvanyātmaka. A given particular is obviously not the same for ever. But are particulars as such eternal? The creation of particulars is recurrently eternal in tbe sense that during each THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 50 Sṛ ṣ ti particulars appear. But are the particulars them- selves eternal? The question may mean either of two things. In the first sense the obvious answer is, as stated, in the negative. Then are particulars as such eternal? In other words are there particulars in all times, in Sṛ ṣ ti as well as in Laya? This given particular (say the pen with which I am writing) may not be in all times, but will not some particulars (though different from those now given) exist always? There is a genus or type (Jāti) wit its particulars (Vyakti). The Jāti never exists without its Vyaktis. Some Vyaktis (though different from those now given) will be associated with the Jātis in all times though both may be either latent or patent. In Laya for instance the Jātis associated with their Vyaktis become latent. Associated with what Vyaktis? Not the present ones; but the Vyaktis immediatly antecedent to the state of Prakṛ ti equilibrium. A given Vyakti is Vyakti-viśeṣ a. Any Vyakti or some Vyakti is Vyakti sāmānya. The former is not, but the latter is, eternal though it may be either veiled or unveiled. The Jātis are eternal and manifested in every creation and their Śabdas are eternal. The Vyaktis are only eternal in the sense above explained. Each creation is not an exact copy of the previous creation in every particular. Particulars through revolving round certain fixed Jātis (latent or patent) change. Thus a given Jīva may be now a Brāhmaṇ a. Through Karma he changes and after death he may change his Jāti and become a Śūdra or a Devatā. And so he may go on until he reaches the antecedent state of Mahāpralaya. Let it be supposed that at that moment he is a Devatā again. He is a Devatā-vyakti associated with Jāti. In Pralaya he will be veiled as such together with his Jāti, and together with all his Sam ̣ skāras active (Prārabdha) as well as nascent (Sam ̣ cita). It is the resultant of these ETERNALITY OF ŚABDA 51 Sam ̣ skāras that will determine his condition of birth after the expiry of Prakṛ ti’s equilibrium. The end of this journey is reached only in Liberation (Mukti). Then is the Vyakti Śabda eternal? If by this term is meant a Śabda denoting a given Vyakti (Vyakti-viśeṣ a) then this is a proper name (non-connotating) and is not eternal. But with the exception of a few proper names (those which are attached as arbitrary signs to this Vyakti or that) all names or words represent Jātis that is groups or classes of things. A Vyakti-viśeṣ a is represented by either a proper name or a specific combination of class names, such as, ‘this paper I am writing on;’ all these being class names the combination of which makes or denotes a Vyakti-viśeṣ a. Only such Śabdas as are approximate natural names (either simple or in combination) are eternal and the rest are not. The Veda claims to give the names of class things and class functions which are approximately na- tural. Hence (granting this claim) these Śabdas are eternal (Nitya). By Veda is here meant Vaidik language and by natural name Vaidika-Śabda. Thus assuming that the word “Gauh” is an approximate natural name, it has existed in every universe and has there meant the animal cow. If the word “Cow” as a variation of this has originat- ed in some time, in some place and in some persons, then outside this limitation of time, place, and person the word has not existed and has not represented the Artha or animal cow. The ultimate' test of a natural name is of course ex- perimental verification. Vaidik language involves different strata. Natural names are of different kinds and degrees, Whether other Śabdas and their combinations are eternal depends on whether those words and their combinations are or are not approximate natural names. Apart from tradition the proof is experimental verification by Yoga. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 52 If they are variations of natural names (Vaidika-Śabda) the extent to which they vary, and the conditions of time, place, and person to which they are subject, must determine the nature of their bond with their Arthas. No a priori answer is possible. Sabdabrahman thinks creatively, his Pratyaya being cosmic ideation (Sṛ ṣ ti-kal- panā). The Śabda of this is Om ̣ and the Artha is the totality of the universe denoted by, and potentially inher- ing in, the creative impulse of which Om ̣ is the sound-ex- pression. From this Om ̣ was derived all the letters (Varṇ as) and sounds (Dhvanis). These Vaidik-Varṇ as are eternal and represent in themselves and their variations all the possibilities of articulate speech in all languages. In Veda the Karma of these Varnas is eternal and therefore the Vaidik words are also, it is claimed, eternal. The vowels are continuous sounds formed by varying the size of the mouth cavity. The vowel sounds produced by the voice are due (See Catchpool’s “Text-book of Sound,” p. 290) to the vibrations of two cartilaginous plates, the “vocal chords” placed at the top of the windpipe, edge to edge with a narrow slit between them; air blown through this slit from the lungs keeps the plate vibrating. The apparatus is really a free reed. The vocal chords have muscles attached to them which can vary the frequency of the vibration and the pitch of the sound produced. The different vowel sounds are produced by varying the size and shape of the mouth cavity. The consonants are particular interruptions of those sounds. They cut short the vowel sound but cannot themselves be sounded without vowels. And for this reason the vowels are known as the Śaktis of the consonants. This subject of the Var ṇ as occupies an important place in the Tantra-Śāstras in which it is sought to give a practical applioatioa to the very anoient doctrine concerning ETERNALITY OF ŚABDA 53 Śabda. The letters are classified accoraing to their place of pronunciation (Uccāraṇ a) such as gutturals, labials, dentals and so forth. The lips, mouth, and throat form a pipe or musical instrument which being formed in various ways and by the aid of the circumambient air produces the various sounds which are the letters of the Alphabet. Pāṇ ini (see Part I of Siddhānta Kaumudī) and Patanjali’s Mahābhāshya deal with the effort or Prayatna in speech, dividing it into inner (Āntaraprayatna) and outer effort (Bāhyaprayatna). The former is of four kinds Spṛ ṣ ta, Iṣ at Spṛ ṣ ta, Vivritta, Samvritta according as the effort fully or slightly touches the place of origin of the sound and according as the mouth is open or closed. Bāhyapra- yatna is of eleven kinds namely Vivāra, Samvāra, Śvāsa, Nāda, Ghoṣ a, Aghoṣ a, Alpaprāṇ a, Mahāprāṇ a, Udātta, Anudātta, Svarita. Vivāra pronunciation is with the mouth open, Samvāra when it is closed. In Śvāsa there is a predominant use of the breathing, in Nāda there is a humming sound, in Ghoṣ a ringing sound, Aghoṣ a being the opposite of this. In Alpaprāṇ a the sound is quickly pronounced, little demand being made on the Prāṇ a, Maha- prāṇ a being the opposite of this. In Udātta the sound is given with a loud voice, in Anudātta with a low voice, and Svrtrita is a mixture of these two. In Paṇ ini various letters are assigned to each of these classes of Prayatna. Thus the consonants from Ka to Ma belong to Spṛ ṣ ta Āntara- Prayatna; Ya, Ra, La, Va to Iṣ at Spṛ ṣ ta Āntara-Prayatna and so on. The Tantra-Śāstra in its doctrine and practice of Ṣ atcakrabheda indicates various parts of the body which are “touched” in the pronunciation of various letters. By this is meant that in the sounding of certain letters various parts of the body take a part. Thus the letter Va is pro- nounced from that part of the body wherein is the Mulādhāra, THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 54 and the letter Ha from between the eyebrows in the Ājña- Cakra. The sound produced by the body in motion (for the external cause of sound is something in a state of vibra- tion) is propagated by sound-waves in the circumambient air. The rise and fall of pressure which occur as sound- waves arrive at the ear, produce by their effect on its structures the sensation of sound and the nature of this sensation depends on the nature of the rise and fall of pressure; in other words on the character of the sound waves. According to Indian doctrine, God evolved man after having evolved most (if not all) other species of living beings so that language (as also intelligence, moral sense, and many other things which had been less perfectly developed in the lower animals) became more developed in man. The lower animals were “approaches” to man, the difference between man and animal being according to this doctrine a difference of degree and not of kind. It is possible then that there may be an inchoate Varṇ āmaka- Śabda in the higher animals, though it is to be noted that the proposition (which is dealt with elsewhere) that “there is no thinking without language” is true only if by thinking is meant some kinds only of cognitive processes. Apart from these, man gets on without language and therefore also the animals. It is only the after-construc- tion on perceptive processes which call for language and this we find mainly if not wholly in man alone. Pāitanjala- Darśana also discusses the question of transmigration into an animal body. In this case there is a soul which had been in a human body or even in a Devatā body before and has therefore the Sam ̣ skāras (linguistic and others) of those births implicitly given amongst its animal Sam ̣ sksras. Its instinot therefore may be (partly if not wholly) “lapsed intelligence” and its Dhvanyātmaka language a partly veiled Varṇ ātmaka or human language. ETERNALITY OF ŚABDA 55 What is eternal then is Śabda in its aspect as Causal Stress or Śabdabrahman, the letters (Vaidika-Varṇ a) evolved from the primordial Dhvani the Praṇ ava or “Om ̣ ”, and the combinations of these letters which constitute approximately natural names. These according to Hinduism are the Vaidika-Śabdas. Whether that claim is well- founded is another question which is not here discussed. CHAPTER VII ŚABDA AS LANGUAGE IT has been said that there is no thought without language. This proposition requires examination both from the Brah- man and Jīva standpoint. If it be assumed that there is no thinking without language this merely establishes the necessary connection of thought and language and not a law that words or names must come to the mind first and then thoughts. They may be inseperably connected as aspects of one and the same concrete, that is actual, process, but between aspects there is no sequence. When a gun is fired the explosion of the cartridge is the causal stress. This manifests to the ear as a report, to the eye as a flash, and also it may be by the movement of the object hit. But the last three are co-effects of the first that is the explosion. In the same way when there is a centre of Causal stress in Cit we may have several lines of effectual manifestation. But it cannot be said that one line of effectual manifestation causes another. Now Śruti as already mentioned calls creation Śabda-prabhava and Śabda-pūrva, both terms implying sequence as between a cause and its consequences. When again Śruti says “Brahmā created Devatās with the Śabda ‘Ete,’ ” what is meant is that the causal stress of that special creation manifests to His absolute “Ear” as a sound which is the pure form of what we can approxi- mately utter and hear as the sound “Ete.” We may, as stated, have several lines of effectual manifestation on there ŚABDA AS LANGUAGE 57 arising a centre of causal stress in Cit, one of which is (say) the sound “Ete”, and another the appearance of the Devatās. But we cannot say that one line of effectual manifestation causes another. Therefore when Śruti says that Śabda underlies, precedes and enters Jagat, Śabda is not used in the sense of sound but as the causal stress or initial Spanda which from the subjective aspect is Iccā- śakti. The universe is creative ideation (Sṛ ṣ tikalpanā). To use the terms of human speech this ideation is intuitive and not inferential and therefore does not involve language which is one of Its products. The proposition that there is no thought without language is correct only in a Vyāva- harika sense and is then only true if by “thinking” is meant the formation of concepts or general notions, judg- ments and drawing inferences. For even in us, intuitive processes, such as perception and ideation, are done without language. To use the apt language of Professor Prama- thanātha Mukhopādhyāya, words are an “after-thought or after-construction in relation to the intuitive experiences of life.” (See as to the principles from which this statement follows “Approaches to Truth”, “Patent Wonder”). To begin with experience is had without language (Apara- śabda) both in the Turiyā (Aśabda condition) and the Suṣ upti (Paraśabda or Causal Stress) states. Coming down to Svapna and Jāgrat it is to be recognised that there are some ways in which language may be associated with thinking processes. On the other hand some processes may go on without language. In Svapna and Jāgrat Avasthā, Arthas and Pratyayas necessarily imply the possibility of sound manifestation, that is, vocal language, but do not always actually suggest their acoustic counter- parts. In some cases they do go on apparently without language, though there is always the possibility of their being expressed in language. A child sees, hears and so THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 58 forth almost without language, so does the animal and we ourselves in part. Most of the particular objects of perception have during such perception no specific names for us; still we perceive them and may afterwards recall the class names. Absence of language occurs primarily in two cases, namely in intuitive perception and intuitive ideation. Much seeing and hearing is done intuitively and without language. By intuitive ideation is meant the forming of a mental image of an object. Thus I see a tree: close my eyes and see it again in mental image. Many such sights and sounds pass through our mental range from time to time which do not always call up their names. But though these intuitive processes may actually go on without language, there is the possibility of their being vehicled in language, and in description, analysis, classifica- tion, judgment and other mental elaborations such linguistic vehicle is indispensable. For the moment it is required to describe, analyse, classify perceptions, recourse must be had to language. Looking, I see a thing and very well see it. But this seeing is often done without actually remem- bering the name “tree” or “mangoe tree.” To describe, classify and otherwise to elaborate this seeing I must re- member the name. In this sense language is called an “after-construction.” Language again is a system of signs either natural or arbitrary, either vocal or non-vocal, by which we describe things and consider the attributes and relations of things. In this definition four marks are em- ployed, namely, natural, arbitrary, vocaI and non-vocal. Taking two at a time there are six combinations namely natural-vocal, natural non-vocal, arbitrary-vocal, arbitrary non-vocal, natural arbitrary, vocal non-vocal. The last two may be at once rejected as the marks in them are contradic- tory. The first four give us four kinds of signs which exhaust possible language. Of the first the example is Vaidika-Śabda, ŚABDA AS LANGUAGE 59 including Bīja Mantras uttered by the vocal organs and of the second we may instance “expressive” signs made to a man (who does not understand the spoken language) by means of the hand or other bodily organ in order to indicate a particular object. The third and fourth classes refer to arbitrary forms of the first two, Arbitrary-vocal is an arbit- rary combination of natural vocal signs, each separately being vocal and natural but their combinations being arbitrary as where two or more natural words are taken and an arbitrary meaning is given to the whole group, e.g. code words. In the same way it may be possible to combine two or more non-vocal natural signs and give the whole thing an arbitrary meaning. A particular name attached to a thought or thing may be arbitrary as in the case of some proper names, but names as such are necessary to higher mental processes directly and also to intuitive processes implioitly. All proper names however are not arbitrary. Those that are, are attached as signs to objects to denote them or mark them off from other objects. They do not connote any attributes or relations of the things to which they may be attached. Our perceptions and ideations often go on without language. Many rapid automatic inferences are drawn and habitual actions are performed without lan- guage. But sometimes these processes are with their lan- guage accompaniment and the moment we want to review, describe, classify, and judge these processes, their language accompaniment appears in consciousness. Now Śabda according to previously given definitions is either Para or Apara. The former is Movement or Stress considered in itself, that is, apart from conditions of its manifestation to specialised sense organs or sense capa- cities. One of these sense capacities is the ear which is subject to degrees, since the capacity of one individual is greater than that of another. This gradation THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 60 points to a highest or absolute capacity which may be called the Absolute Ear. The appearance or manifesta- tion of Paraśabda or causal Stress to the highest capacity (wherever that be) is Śabda-Tanmātra. This last is still a manifestation and not the Stress itself. It is the Stress- in-itself appearing to an ideal ear. It is this stress in itself regarded from a special standpoint. Just as we con- ceive an absolute ear, so we may conceive an absolute eye, tongue and so forth. Each means the Ideal limit (a mathe- matical term) of certain capacities of specialised feeling which are exercised in us in varying degree. Śabda Tan- mātra therefore means not sound in general or undifferen- tiated pure sound only, but Sāmānya (general) sounds in- cluding the highest, the Praṇ ava or Mantra “Om ̣ ,” as well as Viśesa (special) sounds. In the Tanmātra form they are both of them sounds as apprehended by the highest capacity and therefore not subject to the conditions of variability. “Sound in itself” or “sound as such” therefore does not necessarily mean “undifferentiated sound.” Thus a dove is cooing in a grove of mangoe trees hard by. I hear it. You may hear it better. By a scientific instru- ment (megaphone, microphone) it may be heard better still, and so on. But what is that sound as apprehended by a perfect capacity of hearing? What is this cooing sound in itself or the standard of this cooing sound of which you, I, the Yogī hear so many variations? The answer to this will give us the Tanmātra of a Viśeṣ a sound. Now Paraśabda is not language. Aparaśabda includ- ing Śabda-Tanmātra is. In the individual (Vyaṣ ti) con- sciousness there is intuitive consciousness (which answers to Pratyaya) of veiled Ānanda. The Artha is the tempor- arily equilibrated causal body. But this Artha does not manifest itself to the sleeper at that time in language. In Suṣ upti the individual is without language though he ŚABDA AS LANGUAGE 61 has an intuitive experience of his Vyaṣ ti Ānandamaya causal body. But the Artha in Suṣ upti, though wanting language, must have its Paraśabda. The individual is a centre correlated to other centres in a cosmic system. For a while he is in equilibrium in Suṣ upti. Dynamically this means that the algebraic sum of the forces of the other centres exerted upon the indi- vidual and of the forces of his own causal body exerted upon the other centres is zero. It follows therefore that the whole oosmic system need not be in equilibrium whilst the individual (that is, his causal body) is in equilibrium. His slumber does not mean the slumber of the universe. The question is not here discussed as to the forces con- stituting the individual causal stress during Suṣ upti. This I deal with elsewhere. To explain equilibrium in Suṣ upti we require only to assume that the resultant action of the universe on the individual causal body and the resultant reaction of the individual causal body on the universe annul each other during Suṣ upti or dreamless sleep. They (at the former) need not be separately nil. Hence the going by the individual into slumber means an actual stressing attitude of the cosmic system which is Paraśabda. But for a certain attitude of the external system there would be no equilibrium in the internal system. Nay more: this Paraśabda may manifest itself as sound (i.e., as language) to other centres such as Śabda-Tanmātra to the absolute Ear, Sūkṣ ma-Śabda of varying degree to the Yogic ear, or as the self-produced physical sounds of the sleeper to the gross ear. Just as a Devatā has a Bīja mantra or Primary Natural Name, so has each other individual Jīva, corresponding to their respective causal bodies, and these may be heard in varying degree by finer ears and fully by the Absolute Ear. But the individual does the sleeping without language just as he may make THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 62 sounds in his sleep without being conscious of it whilst a person sitting by him hears them. Laya or Cosmic Suṣ upti is the dreamless slumber of Bhagavān or Īśvara. If our own analogy can be pushed up to this, then this Cosmic Suṣ upti is also without language, though it is an intuitive experience by God of His own causal body. Since there are no other centres here and no absolute ear other than that of Īśvara (who is ex hypothesi in Suṣ upti), this intuitive experience is absolutely without language (Mauna). It is silence itself. But Paraśabda is there still, namely equili- brated Samaṣ ti (Causal Stress). Hence language or no language, the correlation of Śabda and Artha persists. Thus language is not the whole of Śabda. Śabda, Artha and Pratyaya are the three poles of a polar triangle. In all planes of consciousness below the pure or transcendent plane this polar triangle necessarily holds. In Īśvara experience the three poles meet together at a point so that Śabda = Artha = Pratyaya. In the individual Suṣ upti experience also they are not clearly distinguishable. Language can be put for Śabda (causal movement or stress) only when there arises the possibility of its being apprehended as sound by some hearing capacity (either absolute or relative). A name or a word ceases to be such when the apprehension by the appropriate cognitive capacity is not there. A name is a manifestation to such cognitive capacity and when the conditions of manifestations are not there the manifestation disappears. But the causal stress (Paraśabda) of the name remains. Hence in Vyaṣ ti Suṣ upti actual names or words (or vocal language) lapse back into their causal stress. The operation is essentially the same in Samaṣ ti Suṣ upti or Laya. So that Śabda is (that is, equals) language, actual or possible, in all cases. In the lower plane (Svapna, Jāgrat), however, language may be put for Śabda but subject to this provision that the ŚABDA AS LANGUAGE 63 language-pole may be regarded as being sometimes above and sometimes below the threshold line of normal or prag- matic consciousness. Thus in the case of the intuitive processes afore-mentioned we may save the polar triangle by assuming that the language pole though not apparent is still there below the threshold line ready to be called up whenever occasion should arise. Thus the development from infancy may be shown by the following diagram in which A = Artha, P = Pratyaya and S = Śabda as langu- age, shown as being above or below the line which is the threshold— A A A A A P P P P P S S S S S In this diagram, showing the child’s development, the five diagrams do not represent definite stages but only the gradual separation of A and P and the rising of S above the line. First no language or more strictly speaking only simple rudimentary sounds—Artha and Pratyaya merge into one, there being no discrimination. Then Artha and Pratyaya are more and more discriminated and their language correlate is more and more developed and brought above the threshold line. Animals probably remain in the first two stages of the child. In Jāgrat and Svapna, Artha end Pratyaya are all necessarily associated not merely with Śabda but with that condition of Śabda which we call language. But the association may be either manifest or unmanifest. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 64 In the latter case whilst Artha and Pratyaya are above the threshold line of normal consciousness, Language is below it, so that in the intuitive proceesee above described Artha and Pratyaya alone seem to appear, though their normal associates are waiting for them below the thresh- old line. The moment it is desired to review, describe, classify Artha and Pratyaya, then the Śabdas as words appear. Thus : Judging, inferring, classi- fying etc. Some inuitive Processes A A P P S S Threshold Line The above account, whilst saving psychology, would imply that Śabda, Artha, and Pratyaya being involved (though as identities) in Īśvara consciousness must be involved in all downward experience also. It is however necessary to clearly understand that Śabda is not necessarily language in all cases, and that language may be either consciously or subconsciously given. According to the scheme suggested the correlation of Artha, Pratyaya and Śabda as Language is essential in the ŚABDA AS LANGUAGE 65 planes of Jāgrat and Svapna, but they may be latent as regards the third partner in some intuitive processes, but patent in others as well as in conceiving, judging, inferring and so forth. The conclusion therefore is: (1) The Turīya state is undifferentiated. Hence in it there is no Artha, Śabda, Pratyaya. A, S and P severally vanish. (2) The Suṣ upti state (Samaṣ ti or Vyaṣ ti) is temporarily equili- brated Consciousness in which there are A, S and P, but their resultant is ineffectual. In the Vyaṣ ti consciousness there are Artha, Śabda, Pratyaya. But these three seem to blend into one and are not clearly distinguishable. Here Śabda is not language to the subject himself. (3) The Svapna and Jāgrat states in which the temporarily equili- brated consciousness ceases are actually stirring Vyaṣ ti or Samaṣ ti consciousness. In them there is Śabda, Artha, Pratyaya, but in some intuitive processes (perceptional and ideational) Śabda as language is below the threshold line of the normal Consciousness. Thus the cosmic and individual states must all be ultimately explained (so far as this can be) by the dynamical theory of Stress or Śakti in which an investigation is made as to the conditions of equilibrium and movement. CHAPTER VIII NATURAL NAME WHAT is a natural name? Every thing is composed of moving material forces. Even what seems stable is in movement, for all its parts are in movement, though they are some time held together as a whole until by design or in the course of nature they are disrupted and dissolved. Matter itself is only a relatively stable form of cosmic energy. Because all is in movement, the world is called Jagat or that which moves. Everything is moving which is not the unmoving (Niṣ panda) Braham. This movement, which is the world, is apprehended by man as sound, touch and feel, form and colour, taste and smell. This is its effect on the sense organs (Indriyas) and mind (Manas), which are again themselves in movement, being ultimately composed of the same Tanmātras which are the components of the mind’s object or matter. All movement is accompanied by sound. In other words, movements presented to a subject is apprehended by the ear and mind as sound, just as it is apprehended by the eye as form and colour, or by the tongue as taste. We say ‘ear and mind,’ for it is to be remembered that according to Indian notions the Indriya or sense is not the physical organ ear, eye and so forth, but the faculty of mind operating through that organ as its instrument. The physical organs are the usual means whereby on the physical plane the functions of hearing and so forth are accomplished. But as they are mere instruments and their power is derived from the mind, a Yogī may ac- complish by the mind only all that may be done by these NATURAL NAME 67 physical organs, and indeed more, without the use of the latter. So also a hypnotised subject can perceive things, even when no use of the special physical organs ordinarily necessary for the purpose is made. The paramountcy of mind is shown by the fact that an object is not perceived unless the mind gives its attention. So in the Bṛ hadāra- ṇ yaka-Upaniṣ ad it is said, “My mind was elsewhere: I did not hear.” Now movement being accompanied by sound, let us suppose we could hear (which we cannot do through the individual natural ear) the sound produced by the generating stress or constituting forces of (say) the house- hold fire, then the sound so heard would be the natural name of that fire. Again the sap rises in the trees. Could we hear the forces constituting this rising sap, then the sound heard would be the natural name of that vegetable function, and so on. Natural name in its purest sense may therefore be defined as the sound produced by the generat- ing stress (Śakti) or constituting forces of a thing, not as apprehended by this ear or that (which apprehends within limits and subject to conditions) but by what may be called the Supreme and Infinite Ear which apprehends un- conditionally a sound, which is sound as it is. By Supreme Ear is meant the power (Śakti) of apprehending sound in itself or as such, without subjection to the varying con- ditions of Time, Place (i.e., Plane) and Person. It is that which hears causal stress of a thing as such or uncondition- ally. Then the natural name of a thing is that sound which the Supreme Ear hears. Natural language in its highest sense is a language of natural names only. In this sense no language below the absolute plane can be such. In this sense even the Vedio language and its Mahāmantra “Om ̣ ” is not natural language. The relative ear does not hear such stress uncondi- tionally. To it therefore a thing has no natural name. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 68 In this connection we must distinguish between the sound accompanying causal stress and the sound which a thing gives forth under the action of stimuli. The latter may be heard, but the former not. Fire or heat acting upon various things may produce various sounds which the ordinary relative ear hears, but its causal stress is experienced as a sound which a Yogī alone hears. Nevertheless there may be according to the Śastra what is called an approximate natural name, that is the sound of the causal stress heard by a Yogī and transmitted imperfectly by him. We say ‘imperfectly’, because it is transmitted by an imperfect agent as a sound which can be heard by the gross ear. Prajāpati hears the causal sound by His Supreme Ear (not gross or physical) and utters it by His Supreme Tongue to His Sādhaka who, not yet himself possessing the Supreme Ear, hears it a little imperfectly. In him the primordial sound is somewhat veiled. By Sādhana he either attains the Supreme Ear or stops short of it. In the former case he is like Prajāpati himself. In the latter case he communicates by his relative “tongue” the imperfectly heard primæval sound to his disciple (Śiṣ ya) who can by Yoga either verify the archetypal sound, or falls short of it. In this way the primordial sounds descend down to our relative planes, where the natural sounds, that is, causal sounds of many objects, are not represented at all, and those that are represented are represented suitably to conditions of relative ears and relative tongues. According to the Mantra-Śāstra the Bīja Mantras represent approximately natural names. Thus the causal stress of fire is a sound heard by the Yogī which is said to be represented for the ordinary relative ear as the sound or Bīja “Ram ̣ ” (रँ ). Vital function under different stimuli producee various sounds, some of which the ordinary ear hears, but the causal NATURAL NAME 69 sound of vital function as breathing is represented by the Prāṇ a-Bīja “Ham ̣ sa” and so on. If attention is paid to breathing it will be found that the outward breath is in the form of the letter Ha and the indrawn breath of Sa. It is not possible to indraw the breath and say the letter Ha, but it is pushed forth by the outward breath. And so with “Om ̣ .” The creative energising out of which this world evolves is Śabda and it is an immense sound (Nāda) to the Supreme Ear as uttered by the Supreme Tongue which is also Nāda. But no finite ear can hear it perfectly and no finite tongue can utter it perfectly. The sound which has descended to us as “Om ̣ ” cannot therefore be a natural name of the creative process in the full sense; but having descended through the Mānasaputras and a line of Gurus each of whom more or less closely approximated to the pure sound in his personal experience, it is practically taken as an approximate natural name of the initial creative action. It is an open continuous sound, uninterrupted by any consonant which clips it, vanishing as it were upward in the Nādabindu which is placed on the vowel. The same observations apply to Ham ̣ (हँ ), Yam ̣ (यँ), Ram (रँ ), Ham ̣ saḥ (हं सः), and other Bījas. So much for “natural name” in the pure sense and approximate sense of the term. The term “natural” in this connection can however be interpreted in five different senses : (1) Sound as produced by causal stress. Śabda is stress which may or may not reach the normal of conscious- ness. If two things are affecting one another, then the name for the total mutual action is stress, of which the respective actions of each of those things are the elements or partials or components. Thus we have stress for three things, for four things, and so on. Ultimately we reach universal stress which is an infinite system of correlated THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 70 forces. A particular thing may be defined as a partial experience of this infinite system which has been well called by Professor P. N. Mukhyopādhyāya (to whom I am indebted in the matter here discussed) “fact section.” This experience is Jīva. The infinite system is however never really finitized by these partials. When the stress between one such partial and another touches the normal of consciousness in either or both, we may have under cir- cumstances and within certain limits sensation of sound in either or both. The stress is Śabda and the sound is Dhvani. It is stress or Śabda which constitutes a thing. Whether this Śabda is followed or accompanied by a certain Dhvani or not will depend upon (a) the magnitude of its action in relation to a percipient subject, and (b) upon the condition of the percipient’s perceptive organs. Hence in order that the sound of a thing’s constituent stress may be heard, the rates of vibration of the air must be such and such, the ears and brain must be such and such and so forth. Thus most objects of experience, though influencing the individual, do not express themselves in sound to him such as the earth, rocks, sun, moon, and stars. Sound as produced by causal stress and apprehended by the Supreme Ear and uttered by the Supreme Tongue is natural name in its pure sense and in this sense none of our sounds are natural. If by this approximate ‘natural name’ of a thing we mean its sound (that is, the sound produced in us by its causal stress) as apprehended by the relative ear to which it is revealed, then most things have no natural names to us, though they may have to other beings with different perceptive conditions. A being who has an experience of the causal stress itself and whose ears (gross or subtle) can respond to it in any form (i.e., whatever be the rates of vibration of air and ether) knows the natural names of all things. Such a Being is Prajāpati Himself and NATURAL NAME 71 Souls that resemble Him. Hence the natural names of such things are revealed through Vākya which, though the Jīva may not completely verify now, he may pro- gressively verify by personal experience, and ultimately completely verify by personal experience too. In this sense only do Śruti and Āgama, that is, the Tantra Śāstras, give the natural names of Artha, sensuous or supersensuous. The test of a natural name is this—If “Supreme or Absolute Ear” be defined as that which hears causal stress of a thing as such unconditionally, then the natural name of a thing is that sound the Supreme Ear hears. The relative ear does not hear this and there- fore to it this has no natural name. (2) Sound as produced by causal stress as projected on to our planes, with necessary limitations, through Mānasa- putras and others. This is approximate natural language, and as the Mantras Om ̣ , Ham ̣ , Ram ̣ , and the like; it con- stitutes one stratum of the Vedic language. In this case the pure sound is represented by a sound capable of being heard by the relative ear. The Yogī who hears the Mantra “Om ̣ ” does not hear it as the sound “O m ̣ ,” but as a sound which the relative ear can hear as “Om ̣ .” “Om ̣ ” is thus only a gross sound which approximates to the real sound only so far as the gross relative ear permits. The pure sound is thus represented by its nearest gross equivalent. (3) A thing, such as a conch shell or an animal, may under the action of external forces give forth variable sounds of certain kinds. This may be perceived by us and we ordinarily oall it its natural sound, and sometimes name it after it as “cuckoo,” “crow.” But it is not the sound produced by the “causal stress” (which may be reduced to the motions of the electrons and therefore un- perceived except to the Yogī). Hence we must distinguish between the sound produced by causal stress, and the THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 72 sound which a thing gives forth under the action of stimuli such as the crackle (another onomatopoeic name) of fire when wood is thrown on it. The latter may be heard but the former not. These names, “cuckoo” and so forth, are practically regarded as natural names, though according to the definition they are not. Such names enter into all languages, Vaidik and others. Fire or heat acting upon various things may produce various sounds which the relative gross ear hears. But its causal stress produces, it is said, the sound Ram ̣ (रँ ), which Bīja Mantra a Yogī alone hears. Vital function under different stimuli is producing various sounds in the body, some of which may be heard, but the causal stress in the form of vital function is repre- sented by the Mantra “Ham ̣ sa” and so on. Prajāpati (as above stated) hears the causal sound or Pure Natural Name by His Supreme Ear (not gross or physical) and utters it by His Supreme Tongue to His Sādhaka, who, not yet possess- ing the absolute ear, hears it only imperfectly. This, as pointed out before, is the approximate natural name. The Primordial Sound is thus somewhat veiled in him. By Sādhana he either attains the Absolute Ear or stops short of it. In the former case he is like Prajāpati Himself. In the latter case he communicates by his relative tongue the imperfectly heard Primaval sound to his Śisya, who can either by Yoga himself verify the archetypal sound, or falls short of it. In this way the primordial Sounds descend down to our relative planes where (a) the natural or oausal sounds of many objects are not represented at all, and (b) those that are represented are so represented suitably to conditions of relative ears and relative tongues. But these approximate natural names must be distinguished from what are popularly called natural names (in the third class), which are not sounds of the causal stress but are due to the action of external forces on a particular object which is NATURAL NAME 73 constituted of the causal stress, the sound of which is the true natural name, pure or approximate. (4) There is then a, class of secondary natural names, that is, those which are not, in the primary sense, purely or approximately natural, as sound of causal stress, nor natural in the onomatopoeic sense, but which are secondarily natural in that they are evolved out of elements of sounds which are primarily (though approximately) natural. The Causal Stress ahen striking the ear produces sound, when striking the eye produces light and colour; and when striking other sense organs produces other kinds of sensation. The stress or constituting force is one and this is Śabda: but it manifests itself differently to the different sense organs. If then, instead of calling a thing in terms of its sound, it is desired to express it in terms of its other manifestations (sensations) to us, we want to state its relations to other perceptive faculties, how in such cases can this be expressed? The “natural sound” in its primary sense cannot do this; the thing as a whole may be best represented by the natural sound, but not its touch, colour, taste and smell specifically: yet this latter repre- sentation is also important and useful. The sound or Bīja Ram (रँ ), for example, may be the approximate natural name of Agni, but unless we can grip the causal stress of Agni itself, it tells nothing about the attributes and rela- tions of the thing with which we are practically concerned. Ordinarily Ram ̣ (रँ ), Hrim ̣ (), Aim ̣ (), Om ̣ () are unmeaning. For this reason we hear talk of Mantra being “Jabber,” as if any body of men in the world’s history deliber- ately oocupied themselves with what was in fact meaningless jabber. That is not necessarily to say that the theory is correct, but that it is not absurd and without sense as sup- posed. Now-a-days when the Śāstra is nearly lost, it may be so in those cases where the Mantras are said without THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 74 understanding. These Bījas may be made to denote things or processes, but ordinarily (unless it is possible to penetrate into the kernel itself) they do not connote qualities or attri- butes of things; and hence are what J. S. Mill calls non- connotative terms. They are however according to Śastra really connotative. Hence in the average plane man requires other terms besides Ram (रँ ) to represent Agni. Suppose we take the quality “burning” (Dāhikā-Śakti). Then in order to express Agni in terms of this quality we may do (or it might have been done for us by linguistic tradition) either of two things: (a) Taking the letters (Varṇ as) and remembering that each represents the natural sound of a certain thing or process, it is possible to make such a permutation and combination of them (taken two or more at a time) that “burning” may be represented by the combination thus formed. Here a compound term is formed (either by ourselves or by tradition) by the colloca- tion in due order of elementary approximate natural sounds (viz., the letters). To express the same attribute more than one such combination may be possible. (b) Or there may exist already simple roots (Dhātu) formed in their turn either by the combination of elementary natural sounds or in the onomatopoeic fashion (see 3 ante), which with proper affixes and suffixes can be made to connote “burning” and thus evolve the term Agni. Here again, to express the same quality or relation, different words may be evolved by ourselves or by tradition. Thus there are synonyms or Paryāya. These secondary names may be arranged in grades in accordance with the degree of their closeness to primary names. Hindu philologists distinguish between Śaktyartha and Lakṣ yārtha, that is, Abhidāśakti and Lakṣ aṇ āśakti and classify each. This in itself is a vast subject. It is sufficient to say here that words have two Vṛ ttis, namely, Abhidhā and NATURAL NAME 75 Lakṣ anā. The first is Śakti in the sense that it compels the understanding of the thing denoted by a word. The object “cow” is described by and is the Vākyārtha of the word or Śabda “cow”. The second only approximately denotes the object (Artha). It so to speak leads the hearer to the door but does not enter. Lakṣ ya is that denoted by Lakṣ anā, which means a sign, that is, object denoted by a sign. Thus the word Brahman is not Vākyārtha of the Supreme Brahman (Nirguṇ a-Parabrahma), but it is Vākyārtha of the Saguṇ a-Brahman. The word Brahman is only Lak ṣ yārtha of the Supreme Brahman. We may say that these secondary names are not in- different as to their expressiveness of the qualities and relations of things. Some do it better and more closely than others. Agni, Vahni, Hutāśana, and other names of Fire are connected with the Bīja Mantra Ram ̣ (रँ ) in this sense, that while the latter approximately represents the natural name of the thing as a whole, the former express the attributes and relations of the thing specifically regard- ed. Hence whilst “Ram ̣ ” (रँ ) is apparently non-connotative, the former are connotative. (5) Primary and secondary names may be combined in such order (Krama) and metre or harmony (Chandah) that by vitalizing one another, these in combination may appear as an approximate name of a thing or process. In this man- ner a Vaidik or Tāntrik Mantra (consisting of several words) may, it is said, naturally denote a Devatā or a function. Beside these five senses of natural sound of which the pure and absolute sense is that first given, there is non- natural or artificial sound or name, which means an arbit- rary name taken at random to denote a thing, such as some proper names. The test of natural names is, it is said, twofold an capable of experimental verification: (1) Whether the THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 76 causal stress of a thing makes a sound (say the Bīja Yam ̣ ) may be verified by Yoga. The thing being given, a sound evolves. (2) This sound repeatedly and harmonically uttered, that is in Japa of Mantra, must create or project into perception the corresponding thing. This too is cap- able of experimental verification. In this case the sound being given, a thing evolves. CHAPTER IX VAIDIKA-ŚABDA THE Vedas communicate the natural names of some things, subject to the necessary limitations involved in their re- presentation subitable to conditions of relative ears and toungues. No Vedic word is an absolute natural name. This cannot be. Just as in the Tanta Śastra we find Bīja mantras, which are said to represent approximately natural names, scattered here and there in a varied mass of ordinary Sanskrit which remotely represent natural sounds, so is the case in Śruti. There are, it is said, closely approximate natural names, combined according to natural laws of harmony (Chandah), forming Mantras which are irresistibly connected with their esoteric Arthas (Devatās); but these are commented upon, explained, applied and so forth in passages which do not express natural names in this sense. On analyzing these Mantras themselves, both Vaidik and Tāntrik, there are found some sounds which are not and others which are in natural use. Here each word in the Mantra does not necessarily stand for an approximate natural sound (that is produced by causal stress). These tendencies to the archetypal forms may be varying. But in the Mantra it is their order of combination and rhythm that mainly counts. Thus as a whole the Mantra may be the approximate natural name of a Devatā or function. Its creative and projecting power THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 78 lies in the two things: (a) The mutual aiding and in- hibiting of the sounds in the Chandah; the veils of the individual sounds are removed by the order of their colloca- tion. Here the “Curves” of sound are constructive and not destructive. (b) The cumulative effect of the repetition of sounds and strings of sounds also may produce the aforesaid result. By repetition is there summation of stimuli. So that by analyzing the Vaidik language we get this: (1) Certain approximate natural names, standing alone or in groups, such as Om ̣ , Ham ̣ , Ham ̣ saḥ , Svāhā and so on. These are fundamental sounds or primaries. (2) Certain combinations of sounds which, though not natural distributively, naturalize each other in and by the order and harmony of the combinations. Thus arise Mantras which become approximate natural names of objects and processes. These may gather creative mo- mentum by repetition. (3) A large mass of sounds or names used to explain the meanings and applications and results of the above which need not be natural names in the above sense. Hence it follows that the Veda which is heard by the gross ear and spoken by the gross tongue is not a system of natural names. It is however claimed to be a system of approximate natural names in varying degree. The Veda of the Absolute Ear and Tongue is a system of abso- lute natural names. Then is the relative and approximate Veda the pri- mordial, universal, unitary language? The answer must be in the negative, but in the case of the first class of names it is amongst all languages most nearIy so upon the basis of the theory here dealt with. In the second class of names it is less so and in the third it is least so. VAIDIKA ŚABDA 79 There are four different strata, in Vaidik experience. First there is the nameless Supreme Experience; then the three above described. Śabda, Artha and Pratyaya are absolutely connected in the absolute plane but progres- sivel less so in the lower strata. The natural connection of Śabda and Artha means that the latter being given the former is there whether audible by us or not; the former being given, the latter is created or projected. But we must distinguish between what is here called natural name and what often receives that term. Thus a conch shell is blown. What is the natural name here? Not the sound which we may make it give forth, for these are produced by our effort and vary, but the sound of the causal stress which generates and keeps together the shell. The blowing sound is only practically natural. What is the basis of the Vaidik theory? In the final resort experimental verification is the test of Āyurveda. Besides the division of name into natural and arbi- trary, of the former into absolute and relative, and of the latter into primary and secondary, name may be classified according as it is (a) typal or (b) variational, as for exam- ple of the first the Sanskrit word “Gauh” and of the second the English word “Cow”. Language according to Indian notions is not something arbitrary and invented. No man ever invented a language. Volapuk, Esperanto and the like are mere combinations of the sounds of pre- existing language. The Vaidik Language was revealed by Īśvara to the Mānasaputras and others and through them to men. This itself as ordinary worldly (Laukika) epeech became corrupted and when rectified was called Sanskrit, that which has been purified. A distinction must therefore be made between the original Vaidik language and current Sanskrit in which however there are words which also occur in the Vedas. Now the ordinary orthodox view ie THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 80 that there is a typal or standard language and that this is the universal language of which all others are variations. Whenever a typal or standard name has a variation, the following questions arise: (a) When does that varia- tion appear and for how long does it last? (b) In what places or planes does that variation arise? (c) In what persons or groups of persons does that variation appear or for whom does it arise? Briefly stated a variation is always subject to condi- tions of time, place and person. Then a variation may be (a) common (Sāmānya), or (b) special (Viśeṣ a). The former is what comprises a whole class of objects. Thus “Cow” is a sound variation appearing in a whole class of persons; Gāi or Gābhī with another class of persons name- ly Bengalis. The special variation is one appearing in an individual object. Thus one individual pronounces the word “Cow” slightly differently from what another does. Every person in fact has his own way of pronunciation. Again a variation may be (c) voluntary, or (d) involun- tary. The former is due to the free will of a person or a group of persons; the latter is not so. The typal sounds are eternal. They are latent how- ever during cosmic sleep (Suṣ upti). The Sāmānya varia- tions of the typal sounds are not eternal in the sense and to the extent that the types are; they appear when the conditions of their expressions appear, and disappear when these go. If we take these four divisions two at a time, we get six possible combinations—(1) Common and special varia- tion, (2) Common and voluntary variation, (3) Common and involuntary variation, (4) Special and voluntary varia- tion, (5) Special and involuntary variation, (6) Voluntary and involuntary variation. Of these, the first and last are impossible, being self-contradiotory. Of the remaining VAIDIKA ŚABDA 81 four, the second is not eternal. In so far as a common variation is due to the free will of a person or persons it has an absolute beginning; for if it be simply the repetition of a previous cosmic order, then it is not a free act but predetermined. The third class are eternal but not to the extent the types are. Comparing them with the latter we can say that they are passing, though recurrently. Types too are recurrently passing during creation (Sṛ ṣ ti) and dissolution (Laya), but their cycles of recurrence are larger. They are eternal in the full sense in so far as they approximate to their type. For the same reasons given as regards the second class, the fourth class is not eternal. The fifth class is not eternal in so far as it is brought about by the part volitions of persons. The whole question is however of so great difficulty, that it is difficult to fully unravel the tangle in which we find it. How and where are we to draw the line between voluntary and non-voluntary, between absolute will and finite will? Is again the cosmic cycle exactly recurrent or not? From a practical point of view we may perhaps not greatly err if we say (1) that the general plan and the types are recurrent and eternal; (2) that the common variations are recurrent and eternal sub- ject to more conditions; and (3) that the special variations are practically not eternal. It is claimed for the Veda that it is a system of standard and typal and therefore natural names. But natural name has, as already explained, various meanings. There are therefore different strata of natural name in Veda. Name may be either (a) natural or (b) conventional, that is, arbitrary. With.the latter we are not here concerned. Natural name may be (c) Absolute, that is, as apprehended unconditionally, or (d) Relative, that is, as apprehended subjected to varying conditions. Veda as a manifesta- tion is not the first. Absolute name is only heard on the THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 82 unconditioned plane. We are therefore concerned with the relative natural name. This may be either (e) primary, or (f) secondary. The first is the causal stress, thing or functioning as a whole, as represented approximately to the relative ear and is again twofold as (g) the elementary sounds or letters (Varṇ a), and (h) as compound sounds, such as are found in Bījas and roots (Dhātu). In the Yoga Bhāṣ ya, that is, Vyāsa’s commentary on the Pātañ– jala-Darśana (3, 17), it is said: Tatra vagvarṇ eṣ vartha- vatāti. According to this, each letter is intrinsically Sar- vābhīdhāna-śakti-prachita, that is, possessing the power (Śakti) to denote and connote all object (Artha). For, as the Viśvasāra-Tantra says: “what is not here is no- where” (Yannehāsti na tat kvacit). A letter (Varṇ a) is the whole cosmos in miniature. One Varṇ a differs from another in the relative latency of the universe of Artha involved in it, the universe being the same in both. They come to denote special Arthas by virtue of the order (Krama) of their collocation (Kranānuro’vhinorthasam ̣ - ketenāvacchimnah.) Their partioular meanings or Sam ̣ keta are thus due not to intrinsic difference but to order (Krama) in grouping. In the relative secondary natural name, functioning is specifioally represented. The specific attributes and relations are given. These again may (i) appeal directly to the ear, and be either (j) self-produced, or (k) induced or excited; or (l) they may appeal to other senses and either (m) consist of single words which are combinations of Var- ṇ as themselves, or Dhātus, or (m) of combinations of words which may be either (o) harmonic, or (p) non-harmonic but Kramic. The first and main division of this soheme is into natural and arbitrary. As to this it is to be observed that all names are made up of elements of sounds or letters VAIDIKA ŚABDA 83 (Varṇ a). But to naturally connote an Artha, the Varṇ as cannot be arbitrarily selected and arranged. To naturally represent a given Artha, certain Varṇ as which are in some way connected with that Artha must be chosen and arranged according to a certain order (Krama). A word in which such selection and order are not in evidence is a conventional name, e.g., a telegraphic code (though even in this there is a designed Krama), many proper names, and algebraical symbols. The Krama of the Vaidika-Śabdas is said to be eternal. To explain this further, let it be supposed that it is desired to evolve a certain Artha, say an atom of hydrogen. A certain number of moving electrons arranged in a certain order must be chosen. The number and order being different we have a different kind of atom. Suppose again it is desired to evolve water. Two atoms of hydrogen and one atom of oxygen must be taken and so arranged by electric or other influence that a molecule H2O is evolved. So also is the case of any com- pound material substanae. The Varṇ as are in relation to ordinary sounds, what the atoms are in relation to material substances. The atoms can be aggregated into molecules and things only in certain definite proportions and not arbitrarily; so with the Varṇ as and natural words. Further as radio-activity and other facts prove, an atom is a system of moving electrons. It is not therefore absolutely simple and elementary. Similarly what we re- cognise as the Varṇ as may not be absolutely simple or elementary sounds; they are however so for all practical purposes, as the atoms are for all chemical purposes. There are about 75 1 different atoms but the electrons which make them up are of the same kind; their number and arrangement account for the differences of Oxygen, Hyd- rogen, Carbon and other atoms. In the same way the ——————————————————————————————————————————————— 1 19 other atoms have been discovered since. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 84 garland or rosary of letters (Varṇ amāla) may be evolved out of the same kind of elementary sound by differential aggregation. It may be that the basic elementary sound is the uninterrupted Anāhata Dhvani finitised into various points (Śabdabindu) ar atoms (Śabdaparamāṇ u) of sound. So again taking any curve, say a circle—its circum- ference may be regarded as the sum of an infinite number of small bits of straight lines: these are the elements. Any ritualistic diagram, such as, say, the Sarvatobhadramaṇ dala, or a Yajna or Homa may be similarly regarded. Hence a natural word may be compared to, and in the case of a Bīja Mantra can be represented by, a diagram (Yantra) which in that case, becomes the graph of the Bīja in question, or of causal stress of which that Bīja is the acoustic manifestation and counterpart. Lastly an electron is an unit charge of electricity, which after all may be only an element of ether in stress. This element of ether in stress is Paraśabda Paramāṇ u according to the definition given; and as heard by the relative ear it is Śabda Paramāṇ u. So that this last and the electron are naturally connected. Hence Śabdas (aggregates of Śabda paramaṇ us) and Arthas (aggregates of electrons) are connected. But as electrons aggregates at random will not make a natural Artha, so Śabda-Paramāṇ us aggregated at random do not make a natural name. Physically the vibrations represented by a Varṇ a can be resolved into component vibrations which are harmonic motions. As Rourier’s theorem gives it, a complex harmonio motion may be analysed into simple harmonic motions. All the ordinary letters are complex harmonic motions; and physically speaking a simple harmonic motion is Śabda-paramāṇ u. Physiologically each single vibration acting on the ear, nerves and brain centres, produces a single pulse of cerebral agitation, a single “nerve-shock,” VAIDIKA ŚABDA 85 just as a single tap on the door produces a single shock and this again a single sound. This single pulse of brain excite- ment ought to produce a single pulse of feeling, a feeling- atom or a “feeling element,” as W. E. Clifford called it in developing his theory “mind-dust,” which was controverted by W. James (See Professor P. N. Mukhyopādhyāya’s “Ap- proaches to Truth”). The view of the last mentioned author is as follows—It is difficult to say in the absence of direct Yogic testimony whether these feeling-dusts actually exist. Ordinarily we do apprehend the Varṇ as as being themselves elementary or simple sounds; perceptually or presentatively they are simple. But they can certainly be represented as made up of feeling-dusts, or what the author cited calls Śabda-Paramāṇ us (Sound atoms) each answering to a single nerve-shock and to a single external vibration; and for aught we know the feeling-dusts may themselves be actually apprehended by the Yogic ears. A secondary natural name means this: Take Fire. The stress or functioning as a whole which constitutes the thing has an acoustic equivalent which is said to be approximately Ram ̣ (रँ ). But if we wish to consider and speak of the various attributes and relations of the thing “Fire” specifically; if for instance we wish to denote the virtue of winding movement which marks the activity of fire (e.g. the vortex of heated gas and the curling up of smoke), this specific virtue and relation is not connoted by the causal or Bīja name (Ram ̣ ) in particular. Hence taking the root “Ag” which signifies tortuous movement by reason of that particular collocation of these two particular Varṇ as (in fact the unheard causal stress of tortuous move- ment itself may have for its approximate acoustio equivalent the sound ‘Ag’) and selecting the proper prefix and suffix, we get Agni. Tradition might have done this, but it is possible to coin a new word to connote a particular property THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 86 of a thing by the process above outlined. Should we wish to connote the relation of fire that it purifies, there is the root Pū. If it is wanted to connote the relation that it consumes all things, there are the two roots “Hu” and “Ash” and the word Hutāśana is formed. And so on. The Bīja name gives the whole-thing-view; other names give side views, specific-relations-views. Agni is called Vaiśvānara because it is present in Viśvanara or all living beings as the heat of oxidization or combustion; it is called Vahni because it carries (root Vah) offerings to the gods; Anala because it pervades (root An—to be) all things and so forth. The words “smooth”, “rough”, “horrible”, “tre- mendous” and so forth are secondary natural names falling under the class (l) as appealing to other senses than the ear. “Smooth”, “rough” and so forth in utterance produce organic sensations (that is, sensations of the organism as distinguished from those of the special sense organs) which are closely connected with, and suggest, the actual sensa- tions of smooth and rough objects. Class (i) directly appealing to the ear refers to ono- matopoeic words, which are evidently of two kinds. A cuckoo or a crow itself naturally produces a sound and this directly appeals to the ear. On the other hand a flute gives out a certain kind of sound, if it is acted upon by a certain stimulus. Sometimes a thing may be called after a sound which it acoidentally produces. Under class (n) we have two forms. The Krama in a combination of words may be rhythmic or non-rhythmic. The former is Chando- baddhavākya. When it is said that Veda claims to give the approxi- mate natural names of class things and class functions, there is thereby practically included the whole scheme of natural names. “Approximate” or dynamical name VAIDIKA ŚABDA 87 admits of “more or less,” so that the primary group gives, approximate natural names par excellence, and the secon- dary group gives in varying degree approximate natural names. Within the secondary group the class (o), that is Mantras, represent the closest approximation to natural names. The test of a natural name is ultimately experimental, that is the sound (Śabda) being given, the object (Artha) is evolved: the object being given, the sound is evolved. In absolute natural names these relations are at once established. In relative names they are established in varying measure through Krama and Japa. Ultimately the question whether Veda is a, system of approximate natural names is thus a question of fact. This leads to a consideration of the claim made by Veda that it is the standard language, an eternal system of natural names of which all others are variations. Hitherto we have dealt with the matter philosophicalIy. We now approach the historical and philological question. The two must be kept apart. Much may be said in favour of the philosophical theory, namely, that the relation between Śabda and Artha is eternal, that there is some Śabda which is the natural name of the Artha, that this natural language is the standard language, that all others are a straying away from and variation of the true norm and so on. But the point now arises as a question of fact, viz., assuming all that is said in theory, is the Vaidika language, that is the language in which the Vedas are ss they exist to-day, the eternal standard language? The orthodox affirm that it is, and that the sound “Gauh” is the natural name and standard representation in speech of the object “Cow” for all eternity. That the relation of Śabda and Artha is eternal and that some Śabdas may be natural names of objects are philosophically probable. It is however an THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 88 entirely different matter when it is affirmed that the Vaidika speech, as existing to-day is that language. Philologists and historians will deny this, for they will point out changes in that speech and make claim as regards priority in age for the language of other peoples. Assuming that there was, as the Biblical tradition runs, once, a universal language, it will be denied that the Vaidika language as known to us to-day is that. It will moreover be shown that even in Veda itself there is evidence to the contrary. Thus it has been argued that according to the Śatapatha-Brāhmana the original language was monosyllabic. With this question of philology and history I am not here concerned. But the ultimate philosophical question is, “Who, if any one, first said that this sound meant that thing?” The Indian answer is that the relation of the word and the object denoted are eternal and not a conventional thing, that there is a system of Natural Names, whatever in fact that system may be. This stands clear of the claim made for the Vedic language, as it exists to-day, that it is that system. CHAPTER X THE TATTVAS A KNOWLEDGE of the Mantra Śastra involves an under- standing of the thirty-six Śaiva-Śakta-Tattvas. Thus it is said that Śakti is in Śakti-tattva, Nāda in Sadhākhya Tattva, Bindu in Īśvara-Tattva. What then are these Tattvas to which reference is made both in the Śaiva and Śākta-Tantras? Unless these be fully understood, no pro- gress in knowledge of the Mantra Science as here described may be expected. The Śaiva-Śākta Śāstra calls experience as Śakti by the term Vimarśa. Experience has two elements—the “I” (Aham ̣ ) and the “This” (Idam ̣ ), the subjective-know- ing aspect (Grāhaka) of the Self and the objective or known (Grāhya) aspect of the Self. For it must be remembered that an object is nothing but the one Self appearing through Māyā as non-Self to Itself as subject. At base the ex- perienced is nothing but the experiencer: though this is not realised until the bonds of Māyā which make subject and object appear to be different are loosened. The “I” side of experience is that in which the Self rests in the light of one’s own Self without looking towards another (Ananyonamukhah aham ̣ -pratyayah); just as the experience (Vimarśa) which looks towards another is called—Ida m ̣ (Yastu anyonmukhah sa ida m ̣ iti pratyayah). But this “Other” can only be the Self, for there is in reality nothing but the one Self. It is experienced, however, differently. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 90 In the Supreme state it exists with the ‘Aham ̣ ’ in a mingled union; in the pure experience between this state and Māyā the “Other” is recognised to be an aspect of the Self; in impure experience governed by Māyā the object appears to be different from the limited self. Experience again is, at its two poles, Perfect Ex- perience of the Perfect Universe and the limited experience of the three worlds of reincarnation. Between these two extremes there are intermediate experiences marking the stages whereby the one pure Spirit or Consciousness in- volves itself in matter. The Hermetic maxim says: “As above so below.” Si- milarly the Viśvasāra-Tantra says: “What is here is there, what is not here is nowhere.” Yad ihāsti tadmyatra, yan nehāsti na tat kvacit). Śaiva doctrine says: “That which appears without, only so appears because it exists within.” (Vartamānāvabhāsānam ̣ bhāvānām ̣ avabhāsanam ̣ antah- sthitavatām eva ghatate bāhirātmanā). “The manifesta- tion of those things which presently appear, happen in the form of external things because they exist within.” “There- fore what exists in our experience, evolved from the Supreme also exists in the Supreme experience though in another way.” The Supreme experience called Parāsam ̣ vit is not a mere abstract objectless knowing (Jñāna). It is the coale- scence into one undivided unity of the “I” and the “This,” that is, of Śiva and the supreme unmanifested Śakti. The former is the illuminating (Prakāśla), knowing aspect, and the latter that Vimarśa aspect which is “the known.” But here the two are undistinguishably one. This supreme experience has the immediacy of feeling. It is Bliss (Ananda) which is defined as “Resting in the Self” (Svarūpaviśrānti). In the Māyika world the Self concerns itself with what it takes to be the non-Self. Here the Universe which is the objeet of Śiva's experience is the Perfect Universe, that is, THE TATTVAS 91 Supreme Śakti which is but another aspect of Himself as consciousness. She is beautifully called in the Parā- prāveśikā: “The Heart of the Supreme Lord” (Hṛ - dayam ̣ pārameśituh). For the Māyika experiencer (Māyā pramāt ṛ ) the universe is the manifested world of objects seen as different from himself. Supreme Śiva and Śakti exist in mutual embrace and love. “Bliss is su- preme love” (Niratiśayapremāspadatvam ̣ ānandātvam ̣ ). The Supreme state is described by the Bṛ hadāraṇ yaka- Upaniṣ ad in the words, “He indeed was just as man and woman in embrace” (Sā ha etāvān āsa yathā strīpumām ̣ - sau sam ̣ pariṣ vaktau); when there is neither within nor without, when all thought of lover, loving and loved are forgotten in the joy of blissful unity. The experience is spaceless, timeless, full, all-knowing, almighty. This is the state of Śiva without Kalā (Niṣ kala) or Paramaśiva. This is Parāsam ̣ vit which is beyond all Tattvas (Tattvātītā). As the Perfect Universe it is called Paranāda (Supreme “Sound”) and Parā-vāk (Supreme “Speech”). Parama- śiva is an experience of the Perfect Universe, that is, of Paranāda (Amarṣ a paranādagarbhah). Such universe is pure Śakti (Śakti-svarūpa). Our worldIy experience is as it were an inverted re- flexion of all this seen in the causal waters of Māyā. Māyā-Śakti is the sense of difference (Bhedabuddhi) which makes the Puruṣ a, who is subject to it, see the Universe in the form of an observing self with a multitude of ob- jects conceived of as being outside of and separate from it. In the Mayika world each self excludes the other selves. In the Supreme experience there is one Self experi- encing Itself. The Puruṣ a is Consciousness, subject to Māyā and the five Kañcukas which are limiting forces contracting the natural perfections of the Self. Thus the Perfect state is formless, the world state is with form: the THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 92 first is spaceless, timeless, all-pervading, the latter is the reverse and so forth. Kāla produces limitations of time. Niyati destroys independence (Svatantratā), regulating the Puruṣ a as to what he should or should not do at any given moment of time. The Supreme experience is full and in want of nothing (Pūrṇ a). Raga Kañcuka creates interest in objects as something other than the self and therefore desire for them. The all-knowingness (Sarva- jñata) and all-mightiness (Sarvakartṛ tā) of the Supreme Śiva are circumscribed through the action of Vidyā and Kalā, and the Puruṣ a becomes a “little knower” and “little doer.” The intermediate Tattvas next described explain the process how from the creative aspect of the Perfect Ex- perience the imperfect World-experience comes into being. Śiva has two aspects in one of which He is Transcendent and in the other Creative and Immanent. The creative (Sakala) aspect of the Supreme Śiva (Niṣ kala-Parama- śiva) is called Śiva-tattva, wherein is the Śakti called Unmanī. Through operation in His areative aspect Śiva becomes His own object as the Manifested Universe. For in truth there is nothing else than Paramaśiva. Śiva- tattva is the first creative movement (Prathama spanda) of the Unmoving Paramaśiva. Śakti-tattva is only the negative aspect of, or in, the Śiva-tattva. The function of Śakti is to negate (Nishedhauayāpārārūpā śaktih). She who is Consciousness negates Herself, that is, deprives experience of the element of objectivity which is Itself as Parā-Śakti. There is thus left only the other side of experience which is Prakāśamātra, that is, what we should call the “I” (Aham ̣ ) side of experience when regarded as consisting of an “I” and “This” (Idam ̣ ). Because in this experience there is no trace of objectivity whatsoever, either of such objectivity latent or expressed as exists in THE TATTVAS 93 the Supreme or other lower and derived form of experience, the Śiva Tattva is called “the very void” (Śūnyātiśūnya). It is the experience in which the Self is not looking towards any other (Ananyonmukhah aham ̣ pratyayah). The objective content, so to speak, of Consciousness is a mere negation. It is Śūnya because it is empty of objec- tive content. Śakti-tattva is a;so spoken of as the Will (Icchā) of Siva as yet Unmanifest and inseparable from Him (Santatasamavāyinī). This account of Śakti’s operation is extraordinarily subtle, explaining as it does how the supreme unitary experience is also the first source of dual experience. Such latter experience and the stages whereby the latter is fully developed can only be produced by positing an aspect in which there is a breaking up of the unitary experience. This is done by first blotting out from the Perfect experience its object or the Perfect Universe (Parā Śakti, Paranāda) thus leaving a mere subjectivity. To the subjectivity thus disengaged there is again gradually unveiled the universe at first as unmanifested and then (through Māyā) as mani- fested Śakti. In Parā Samvit the “I” and the “This” existed as one undistinguishable unity. In Śiva Tattva through the operation of the associated Śakti Tattva, the “This” (Idam ̣ ) is withdrawn from experience so that the “I-experience” (Aham ̣ -vimarśa) alone remains. To this the ‘Idam ̣ ’ or Universe is again by degrees presented, when there is no longer an undistinguishable unity of “I” and “This,” but an “I-This” in which both, though distinguishable, are yet part of the Self which eventually through Māyā-Śakti becomes an “I” and “This,” in which the two are severed the one from the other. How this occurs, the description of the remaining Tattvas ex- plains. The Śiva-Śakti Tattva is not an emanation, because it ever remains the same whether in Creation THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 94 or Dissolution. It is the seed and womb of the whole universe. The first emanation or manifestation (Ābhāsa) of and by Consciousness is called the Sadskhya or Sadāśiva Tattva. Here it is to be observed that the cause ever remains the same and what it was, though appearing differently in the effect. The Supreme Experience changelessly endures even though in its creative aspect it gives birth to the Universe. This Ābhāsa is like the Vivartta of Māyā-vāda, the difference between the two lying in the fact that accor- ding to the former the effect is real, and according to Śam ̣ kara, unreal. This difference again depends on the definition given of “reality.” Real evolution (Pariṇ āma), in which when one thing is evolved into another it ceases to be what it was, exists only in the compounded products of the material world. In Sadāśiva-Tattva there is the commencement of the first subjective formation of ideas. It is called Nimeṣ a (closing of the eyes) as contrasted with Unmeṣ a (opening of the eyes) of the next stage of experience. In the former the Universe as Śakti is seen only faintly. The Self hazily experiences Itself as object. It is the first step in evolution and the last in involution. Unmeṣ a is the distinct blos- soming (Sphutatvam ̣ ) and externalization (Bāhyatvam) of the Universe. The “This” (Idam ̣ ) is faintly perceived by the “I” (Aham ̣ ) as part of the one Self, the emphasis being therefore on the “I” side of experience. Sadāśiva is He whom the Vaiṣ navas call Mahāviṣ nu, and the Buddhists, Avalokiteśvara who sheds compassion on all. According to tradition, this is the source whence the Avataras come. It is in this Tattva that there is what the Mantra-Śāstra calls Nāde-Śakti. The third stage of the developing consciousness is Īśvara, Tattva, the externalization of the last. The THE TATTVAS 95 Universe (Idam ̣ ) is experienced by the “I” (Aham ̣ ) dis- tinctly and yet as part of, and not separate from, the one Self. As in the last experience the emphasis was on the “Aham ̣ ,” here it is on the “Idam ̣ .” This Tattva is called Bindu in Mantra-Śāstra, and is so called because Con- sciousnes here completely identifies itself with the Universe as unmanifested Idam, and thus subjectifies it and be- comes with it a Point (Bindu) of Consciousness. Thus by way of example the mind is completely subjectified and exists for each of us as a mathematical point, though the body, to the extent to which it is not subjectified, appears as an object or extended thing. The fourth Tattva is known as Vidyā, Sadvidyā or Śuddhavidyā. In the experience of this stage, emphasis is equal on the “I” and the “This” (Sāmānādhikaraṇ ya). In Śiva-Tattva there is the I-experience (Aham ̣ Vimarśa); in Sadāśiva the I-This experience (Aham ̣ -idam ̣ Vimarśa); in Īśvara-Tattva the This-I experience (Idamaham ̣ Vimar- śa). In each case the stress is laid on the first term. In Vidyā-Tattva there is an equality of either term in an experience which is that of the true relation of the Aha m ̣ and the Ida m ̣ , consisting of a synthesis (Sam ̣ gamana) of the two on a single “basis” (Adhikaraṇ a) and not on two different “bases” according to the experience of those under the influence of Māyā (Māyāpramātṛ ) thus eliminating the duality which exists in the latter experience. By equality of the “I” and the “This”, experience is in the state of readiness for the next stage in which the two are to be severed. Sadvidyā as being the inter- mediate stage between the pure (Śuddha) and impure (Aśuddha) Creation is called Parāparadaśā. It is also spoken of as experience of difference in the form of Mantra (Bhedābheda-vimarśanātmaka-mamtrarūpa). It is experi- ence of difference because the Idam ̣ is separated from THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 96 the Aham ̣ . It is the experience of non-difference because they are still regarded as part of one Self. The experience is compared to that of the Īśvara of the Dvaitavādins, who sees the Universe as different from Himself and yet as part of and in connection therewith.” All this is my mani- festation” (Sarvo mamāyam ̣ vibhavah). The experience is said to be in the nature of Mantra, because here we are in the region of pure spiritual ideation. As yet there is no objective manifestation such as exists in our world. Below this Tattva it is said that there were created eight Pudgalas, that is, Jīvas in the form of knowledge (Vijñāna-rūpa) and then seven crores of Mantras and their Maṇ dalas. At this point Māyā-Śakti intervenes and divides the Aham ̣ and Idam ̣ , and the Kañcukas or limitations of the natural perfections of Consciousness make It subject to time and space, birth and death, limitation, and desire for object, which It now conceives of as persons and things other than Itself. This is the Puruṣ a-Prakṛ ti-Tattva. Puruṣ a in Śaiva-Śākta philosophy is the Ātmā or Śiva subject to Māyā and the Kañcukas which are limiting forces whereby the Self as Pure Consciousness loses Its natural perfections. Prakṛ ti is the Śāntā Śakti of Śiva in contracted form existing as the equilibrium of the Guṇ as which are themselves a gross form of the Śaktis of Will (Icchā), Action (Kriyā) and Knowledge (Jñāna). All things exist in Her who is of the nature of feeling in a homogeneous mass. Puruṣ a is enjoyer (Bhoktā) and Prakṛ ti the enjoyed (Bhogyā). The latter is at first the barest objectivity seen as different from the experiencing Self as Puruṣ a. Prakṛ ti then differentiates into the Tattvas of Mind (Antahkaraṇ a), senses (Indriya), and matter (Bhūta) which constitute our universe, THE TATTVAS 97 Puruṣ a does not merely mean man nor indeed any ani- mal. Every single thing in the Universe is Puruṣ a. Thus an atom of sand is a Puruṣ a or consciousness, identifying it- self with solidity (Pṛ thivī), manifesting its limited Conscious- ness as atomic memory and other ways. What Conscious- ness thinks, that is, identifies itself with, that it becomes. To sum up, the Supreme Experience (Parā-sam ̣ vit) has a creative aspect (Śiva-Śakti-Tattva), which is a Consciousness of “I” (Aham ̣ -vimarśa) which gradually experiences the Universe (Idam ̣ ) as part of Itself, at first faintly with predominant “I”, then clearly with predomi- nant “This”, and then as equal “I and This”, ready for severance by Māyā. The latter then cleaves consciousness in twain, thus setting up a dichotomy of Subject and Object, though in truth the object is nothing but the Self as its own object. Lastly Śakti, as Prakṛ ti, differentiates into the multitudinous beings which make the universe. But throughout it is the one and only Śiva whether as the Supreme Experience or as the Consciousness embodied in solid matter. Śakti, Nāda, Bindu mentioned in previous arti- cles are Śakti-Tattva, Sādākhya-Tattva and Īśvara-Tattva (here described), considered from the standpoint of the Mantra Śāstra which treats of the origin of Śabda or Sound. With the Tattvas, the Kalās are associated. These are the forms of activity (Kriyā) of the Tattvas as Śakti. Thus Sṛ ṣ ti (Creation) is a Kalā of Brahmā. Pālana (Pro- tection) is a Kalā of Viṣ nu and Mṛ tyu (Death) is a Kalā of Rudra. It is, however, not always as easy to see the appro- priateness of the Kalās in the simple examples given. The Śākta Tantras speak of 94 Kalās, namely, 19 Kalās of Sadāśiva, 6 of Īśvara, 11 of Rudra, 10 of Viṣ nu, 10 of Brahmā, 10 of Fire, 12 of Sun, and 16 of Moon. According to Saubhāgya-ratnākara the 19 Kalās of Sadāsfiva are Nivṛ tti, Pratiṣ ṭ hā, Vidyā, Śānti, Indhikā, THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 98 Dipikā, Recikā, Mocikā, Parā, Sūkṣ māmṛ tā, Jñānāmṛ ta, Amrtā, Āpyāyanī, Vyāpinī, Vyomarūpā, Mūlavidyāman- trakalā, Mahāmantrakalā, Jyoitṣ kalā The 6 of Īśvara are Pītā, Śvetā, Nityā, Aruṇ ā, Asitā, Anantā. The 11 Rudra Kalās are Tīkṣ ṇ ā, Raudrī, Bhayā, Nidrā, Tandrā, Kṣ udhā, Krodhinī, Kriyā, Utkārī, Amāyā, Mṛ tyu. The 10 of Viṣ ṇ u are Jada, Palini, Śānti, Iśvarī, Rati, Kāmikā, Varadā, Hlādinī, Prīti, Dīkṣ ā. The 10 of Brahmā are Sṛ ṣ ti, Ṛ ddhi, Smṛ ti, Medhā, Kānti, Lakṣ mī, Dyuti, Sthirā, Sthiti, Siddhi. The 10 of Fire are Dhūmrārci, Ūṣ mā, Jvalinī, Jvālini, Visphuli n ̣ ginī, Susri, Surūpā, Kapilā, Havyavahā, Kavyavahā. The 12 of Sun are Tapinī, Tāpinī, Dhūm ̣ rā, Marīci, Jvālini, Ruci, Suṣumnā, Bhogadā, Viśvā, Bodhinī, Dhāriṇ ī, Kṣ amā. The 16 of Moon are Amṛ tā, Mānadā, Pūsā, Tusti, Pusti, Rati, Dhṛ ti, Śaśinī, Caudrikā, Kānti, Jyotanā, Śrih, Prīti, An ̣ gadā, Pūrṇ ā, Pūrṇ āmṛ tā. Out of these 50 are Mātṛ kā-Kalās which manifest through the Paśyantī, Madhyamā, and Vaikharī stages (Bhāva) as the gross letters (Varṇ a). The 50 Mātṛ kā-Kalās are given in the same acoount as follows: Nivṛ tti, Pratiṣ ṭ hā, Vidyā, Śāntī, Indhikā, Dīpikī, Recika, Mocikā, Parā, Sūkṣ mā, Sūkṣ māmṛ tā, Jñānāmṛ tā, Āpyāyanī, Vyāpinī, Vyomarūpā, Anantā, Sṛ ṣ ti, Ṛ ddhi, Smṛ ti, Medhā, Kānti, Lakṣ mī, Dyuti, Sthirā, Sthiti, Siddhi, Jadā, Pālini, Śānti, Aiśyarā, Rati, Kāmikā, Varadā, Āhlādinī, Prītih, Dīrghā, Tīkṣ nā, Raudrī, Bhayā, Nidrā. Tandrā, Kṣ udhā, Krodhinī, Kriyā, Utkārī, Mṛ tyurūpā, Pītā, Śvetā, Asitā, Anantā. These 94 Kalās are worshipped in the Wine Jar which holds Tārā dravamayī, or the Saviour-Mother in liquid form. She Herself, is called Sam ̣ vit-Kalā and so the Yoginīhṛ daya-Tantra says— Deśakālapadārthātmā yad yad vastu yathā yathā Tat-tadrūpeṇ a yā bhāti tam ̣ śraye Sam ̣ vidam ̣ Kalām ̣ . CHAPTER XI ŚAKTI—POTENCY TO CREATE IN the previous chapter I have referred to Śakti, Nāda, Bindu. In this and the two next I will deal in great detail with each of these three concepts of Śakti. One of the clearest accounts known to me of the evolution of Śakti is that given in the authoritative Tāntrika-Prakaraṇ a called Śāradā (also spelt Sāradā) Tilaka by Lakṣ maṇ ā- cārya. This work was formerly of great authority in Bengal. Its value is much increased by the commentary of Rāghva-Bhatta. As this work with its commentary is of prime importance, and is cited throughout the following chapters, I may here note the following account which Lakṣ maṇ ācārya gives of himself at its close. Mahā- bala a great sage was succeeded by his son Ācāryapaṇ dita, a Deśika (Tāintrik-Guru). His son Śrīkṛ ṣ ṇ a-Deśika had a son Lakṣ maṇ a-Deśika who wrote the Śāradā-Tilaka. Rāghava, in his commentary called Padārthādarśa, says that Lakṣ maṇ a was the disciple of Utpalācārya, who was the disciple of Somānanda, who was the disciple of Vasugupta, who was the disciple of Śrīkaṇ ṭ ha. This is the Gurupan ̣ gkti of Lakṣ maṇ a. His disciple was the great Kāśmīrian Abhinava-Gupta, the author of Paramārtha- sāra. The latter’s disciple was Kṣ emarāja, the author of the Śivasūtra-Vimarśini. The date generally assigned to Abhinava-Gupta is the eleventh century. Therefore Sj. Akśaya Kumāra Maitra, Director of the Varendra Anu- sam ̣ dhāna-Samiti, who has supplied me with these details THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 100 of the Gurus and Śiṣ yas of the author, concludes that the Śārada was written at the end of the tenth or begin- ning of the eleventh century. Rāghava mentions 1510 as the age of his commentary. Taking this to be the Vikrama Sam ̣ vat we get 1454 A.D. as its date. These details serve another purpose. There are persons who insist on a total disconnection between the Śaiva and Śākta-Tantras. Lakṣ maṇ ācārya was a member of the Kāśmīrian Śaiva School, and his work was, as I have stated, of great authority among the Bengal Śāktas. The Śāradā (Chapter, I, verse 7) says: “From Sakala- Parameśvara, vested with the wealth of Sat, Cit, Ānanda issued Śakti; from Śakti came Nāda; and from Nāda issued Bindu.” Saccidānanda-vibhavāt sakalāt parameśvarāt Asīc-chaktis tato nādo nādād bindu-samudbhavah. Parameśvara is here Śiva-Tattva. He is Sakals, because He is with the creative Kalā or Śakti. As already explained Śakti, when Vyaṣ tirūpā, that is individualised, is called Kalā. Śiva is always with Śakti. But in the supreme state, Śakti is unmanifest and exists in Her own (Svarūpa) form as Being-Consciousness-Bliss (Sacchidā- nandamayī, Cidrūpiṇ ī), undistinguishable from Śiva. Sakala-Śiva is thus Saguṇ a-Brahman. He is said to be vested with the wealth of Sat, Cit, Ananda or Being, Consciousness and Bliss to show that His association with Avidyā does not deprive Him of, or affect, His own true nature (Svarūpa). Śiva has two aspects. In one of these He is the Supreme Changeless One who ie Saccidānanda and Saccidānandamaya. This is Parā-sam ̣ vit. In the other He changes as the Universe; change being the experience of the Jīva so created. The cause of such change is Śiva-Tattva inseparably associated with Śakti-Tattva. ŚAKTI—POTENCY TO CREATE 101 “There issued Śakti.” This is Śakti-Tattva of the Thirty-six Tattvas. Śakti evolves Nāda, and Nāda, Bindu. These are aspects of Śakti preparing to create the Uni- verse and are dealt with in future chapters. Here I am concerned with Śakti-Tattva only: that is, with that form of Śakti which is specifically so calIed; since Nāda, Bindu and the rest are all but names for different aspects of Śakti. It may be asked how Śakti can be said to issue from that which was already with Śakti. Rāghava-Bhatta explains that the author here follows the Sām ̣ khya principle of the appearance of realities from realities (Sadutpattivāda) and speaks of the condition of readiness (Ucchūnāvasthā) of Her who being without beginning or end existed in a sub- tle state identified with Caitanya in Dissolution (Yā anādi- rūpā caitanyā-dhyāsena Mahāpralaye sūkṣ mā sthitā). Adhyāsa is the attribution of the nature of one thing to another according to which something is considered to be what it is not. In other words during Dissolution there is some potential principle in the Brahman which, as manifest, appears not to be Consciousness (Cit), but which owing to the absence of operation during the dissolved (Laya) state is identified with Cit. The distinction is very subtly marked by the Sanskrit word Cit for Śiva and Cidrū- piṇ ī for Śakti. Cit is there in either case, for ultimately there ie nothing but Consciousness. But that principle which in creation manifests as seeming Achit is in itself Cidrūpiṇ ī. One is Consciousness and the other is a principle in the form of Consciousness. I prefer to look at Śakti from the Consciousness aspect which is Her own form (Svarūpa) and to say that Śakti in Dissolution is what She really is, namely, Cit. In creation Conscious- ness, as Śakti, has power to veil Its own true nature, and when we are ourselves subject to this power we attribute unconsciousness to It. The substance in either case is THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 102 this: In Dissolution, Consoiousness and Bliss alone is. Then without derogation to the changelessness of Con- sciousness there is an apparent dichotomy into subject and object, that is, Consoiousness and Unconsoiousness. Śakti is conceived as ready to create the Universe oom- posed of Guṇ as as its effect (Kārya). In other words, pure Consciousness becomes the world-experience. The Prayogasāra says: “She, who is eternal and all-pervading, the Genetrix of the Universe, issues from Him.” Vāyavīya- Samhitā says: “By the will of Śiva, Parā-Śakti is united with Śiva-tattva and at the beginning of Creation appears from It just as oil from sesamum seed when pressed.” The Pancarātra is also cited by Rāghava-Bhatta as saying, “The Parama Puruṣ a at the beginning of Creation, seeing that She who is Saccidānandarūpini is the source (Adhiṣ thāna) of the manifestation of all Tattvas makes manifest eternal Prakṛ ti.” These statements, like all our accounts in such matters, are pictorial thinking, being necessarily imperfect attempts to explain the manifestation of activity of Consciousness. Cause and effect are really one, but appear different. The first aspect of Śakti is its causal (Kāraṇ a) aspect. But this again may be analysed into the various stages of its capacity and preparedness to create. These stages are marked by certain names which again are mere labels denoting states of Śakti. Thus Nāda and Bindu are names for those aspects of Śakti which are more and more prone to Creation (Ucchūnāvasthā). Nāda and Bindu are but two states of Her Creation (Sṛ ṣ tyupayogyā- vasthārūpau). Śakti-Tattva is the first kinetic aspect of Brahman. Śakti then becomes more and more kinetic until, as Bindu, Śakti is Īśvara-Tattva. This Bindu differentiates into the Triangle of Divine Desire called the Kāmakalā upon which there is that Brahman Sound ŚAKTI—POTENCY TO CREATE 103 (Śabda-brahman), which bifurcating into Śabda and Artha, is Śakti in its aspect as effect (Kārya) or the manifested Universe of Mind and Matter. This “Tāntrik” account gives firstly an apparent “development” in the causal body of Śakti being in the nature of a resolution of like to like; and then a real development (Pariṇ āma) of the effects (Kārya) produced from the causal body. The whole is necessarily described after the manner of a gradual process stated in terms of our own psychological experience. But such a process exists only in time which first appears with the Sun and Moon. Bhāskararāya in his commentary on the Lalitā Sahasranāma (Verse 117) cites Gorakṣ anātha as saying in his Mahārthamañjarī, “In a moment the world is created and in a moment it is destroyed." Śakti-Tattva and Śiva-Tattva are inseparable (San- tata-Samavāyinī), the former being only the negative as- pect of the latter. Both exist even in Dissolution, the first emanation proper being Sadākhya which corresponds with Nāda in the above mentioned verse. Śiva-Tattva is defined in the Tattva-Sandoha 1, as follows: “That, beyond which there is none other, moved of His own will in order to create the whole world. The first movement (Spanda prathama) is called the Śiva-Tattva by those who know.” Yad ayam anuttaramūtir nijecchyākhilam idam jagat sraṣ tum Paspande sah spandah prathamah Śiva-tattvam ucyate tajjñaih. As the Vimarśinī on the Pratyabhijnā says—It is the “I-experience not looking towards another” (Amanyon- mukhah aham ̣ pratyayah). It is the self-side of experience, Prakāśa or Jñānamātra, which is such, because of the nega- tion of all objectivity or not-self by Śakti-Tattva. For this Jñānamātra, She, as Vimarśa-Śakti, provides through gradual stages the objects of its experience. Her function is THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 104 negation (Niśedha-vyāpāra-rūpā Śaktih) of all objectivity so as to produce the mere subjective knowing (Prakāśa- mātra) which is the Śūnyātiśūnya. She then evolves from Herself the objective world in order that it may be the con- tent of the Śiva consciousness. She is pure Will ever asso- ciated with Śiva. She is the seed of the whole Universe of moving and unmoving things then absorbed in Herself. Icchā saiva svacchā santatasamavāyinī satī śaktih. Sacarācarasya jagato bījam ̣ nikhilasya nijanilīnasya. (Tattva-Sandoha, 2.) She is thus called the Womb (Yoni), or Seed-state (Bījāvasthā), and by the Parāpraveśikā, “Heart of the Supreme Lord” (Hṛ dayam ̣ , Paramestituh). The Yoginī- hṛ daya-Tantra says that men speak of the heart of Yoginī; She is Yoginī because She is connected with all things both as Cause and Effect. This Yoginī is knower of Herself (Yoginī svavid). She is called the Heart: for from the Heart all issues. She is the Heart of the Universe: the pulsing movements of which are Herself as Śakti. What more can be said than the words of the Yoginīhṛ daya, “What man knows the heart of a woman, only Śiva knows the heart of Yoginī.” In the Pratyabhijñā-Hṛ daya (Sū 4) it is said, “The auspi- cious supreme Śiva desiring to make manifest the Universe which is one with Himself first of all shines forth as the one Cit as the Very Void detaohed from Māyā (that is, there is no objectivity) and as undifferentiated Illumination (that is, Prakāśa or Jñāna). He then next appears in the form of diverse experiencers consisting of an infinite endless number of Tattvas, words and beings which are in the nature of a blooming forth of Consciousness and Bliss." (Śri-parama- śivah svātmaikyena sthitam ̣ viśvam ̣ avabibhāsayiṣ uh ŚAKTI—POTENCY TO CREATE 105 pūrvam ̣ cidaikyākhyāti māyānāṣ ṛ itaśiva-paryāyaśūnyāti śūnyātmatayā prakāśābhedena prakāśamānatayā sphurati: tatah cid-rasāśyānatārūpāśeṣ a-tattva-bhuvanabhāva-tattat- pramātrādyātmatayā’ pi parathate). The substance of the matter may be stated thus: whilst from the static transcendental aspect (Paraśiva, Parāśakti) Consciousness changelessly endures, there is from the kinetic creative aspect (Śiva-Śakti) a polarisa- tion in consciousness, the poles of which are Śiva, and Śakti representing the Aham ̣ and Idam ̣ aspects of experi- ence. Owing to this polarisation there is in lieu of the unitary experience a division into the knower, knowing and known, Mātṛ , Māna, Meya, as it is called. Conscious- ness then identifies itself with the products of its own kinetic Śakti, that is, with mind as the subject of experi- ence and with matter as its object. This polarisation is explained in the Śākta-Tantras by the illustration of the grain of gram (Caṇ aka). Under the sheath of the grain of gram two seeds are found in such close union that they appear when held together as one. With, however, the tearing of the outer sheath the two halves of the seeds fall apart. These two seeds are said to be Śiva and Śakti and the encircling sheath is Māyā. Like all attempts to explain the unexplainable, the illustration is to some extent defective, for in the gram there are two separate seeds —but Śiva-Śakti are an undistinguishable unity. The commentator on the Ṣ at-cakranirūpaṇ a (Serpent Power) cites the following: (v. 49): “In the Satyaloka is the formless and lustrous One. She is like a grain of gram devoid of hands, feet or the like. She has sur- rounded Herself by Māyā. She is Sun, Moon and Fire. When casting off (Utsṛ jya) the covering She divides in two (Dvidhā bhittvā) and becomes intent on (Unmukhi) creation, then by differentiation of Śiva and Śakti arises THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 106 creative ideation (Sṛ ṣ ti-kalpanā).” By “differentiation” is meant the polarisation of Consciousness into subjective (Prakāśa) and objective (Vimarśa) aspects. The Self sees another. The same commentator cites the Prapanca- sāra Tantra as saying that the Parabindu divides into two parts, of which the right is Bindu, the male, Puruṣ a or Ham ̣ , and the left is Visargah, the female Prakṛ ti or Sah. Ham ̣ sah is the Union of Prakṛ ti and Puruṣ a and the Universe is Ham ̣ sah. In, however, the MSS. on which my edition of this Tantra is based it is said that Parabindu divided by Kalā becomes threefold—Bindu, Nāda, Bīja. The difference is of no moment for this Bindu (Kārya) is Śiva and Bīja is Śakti, and Nāda is merely the relation (Mithah-samavāyah) of the two. The combined Ham ̣ sah indicates the same relation as is expressed by Nāda. In the Kulacūdāmaṇ i Nigama (Chap. I, vv. 16-24), the Devī says of the first stage: “I, though in the form of Prakṛ ti, lie hidden in Being- consciousness-bliss (Aham ̣ prakṛ tirūpā cet saccidānanda- parāyaṇ ā). Then in the initial creative stage when Karma ripens the Devi in the words of the Nigama “becomes desirous of creation and covers Herself with Her own Māyā.” This is the appearance of the kinetic Śakti. The same doctrine is stated with greater or less detail in various ways. Unitary experience, without ceasing to be such, is yet, as Jīva polarised into the dual experience of the Māyika world. Consciousness as Cit-Śakti and Māyā-Śakti projects from itself, in a manner conformable with our own psychological experience, the object of its experience. The Māyika experiencer (Māyā-pramātrī) takes what is one to be dual or many. This is the division of Śiva and Sakti which are yet eternally one. All action implies duality, Duality is manifestation. Manifestation is nothing but an appearance to consciousness. As there is ŚAKTI—POTENCY TO CREATE 107 ultimately but one Self, the Self appears to itself; that is, consciousness is polarised. These two poles are the con- tinuity of the “I” (Aham ̣ ) and its ever changing content which is “This” (Idam ̣ ). Just as there is absolute rest and a world movement, so Śakti or Creative Consciousness is itself of twofold aspect, static and dynamic. Cosmic energy in its physical aspect is potential or kinetic, the first being that state in which the equilibrated elements of Power hold each other in check. It is not possible to have one without the other. In any sphere of activity, according to these views, there must be a static background. If one Spiritual Reality be assumed it cannot be actually divided into two. It is possible, however, that there should be a polarisation in your experience whereby what is indivisibly one and the self, appears as many and the not-self. How? The answer is Māyā, that Power of Her whereby what is impossible to us becomes possible. Māyā is Śakti, but Śakti is not to be identified only with this form of It. In the thirty-six Tattvas, Māyā is a particular and comparatively gross form of Śakti which appears after the evolution of the Sadvidyā-Tattva. It is defined as that Śakti which is the sense of difference (Bhedabuddhi); that is, the power whereby the individual consciousness, distinguishing itself from others, considers itself separate from them. Śakti is understood differently in the Śākta Tantra and in Śamkara's Mayevada; a matter of primary importance from the point of view of Sādhana and with which I will deal on some future occasion. Whatever be the description given, all acoounts must end in the inconceivable Śakti (Acintyā). She the One, the Primordial Śakti (Ādyā- Śakti) appears as many; and so the Śākta Sādhaka saying, “Aham ̣ Devī na cānyosmi” (I am the Devī and, none other), thinks to himself “Sa’ham ̣ ” (She am I). CHAPTER XII NĀDA—THE FIRST PRODUCED MOVEMENT ŚAKTI-TATTVA dealt with in the preceding chapter is really the negative aspect of the Śiva-tattva. Though spoken of seperately the two are indissolubly one. Śakti- tattva, as the Tattva-sandoha says, is the Will of Śiva as yet unmanifest: Icchā saiva svacchā santatasamavāyinī satī śaktih. Sacarācarasya jagato bīja m ̣ nikhililasya nijanilīnasya. These two principles (Śiva-Śakti-Tattva) are the ultimate Potency of creation, and as and when they (con- sidered as one Tattva) commence to act, the first movement towards manifestation takes place. After the previous restful state of Śiva-Śakti there follows the union for the purpose of creation of the two principles which are Śivatattva and Śaktitattva. So it is said in the Śākta- Tantra, “Śiva-Śakti-samāyogāt jāyate sṛ ṣ tikalpanā” (From the union of Śiva and Sakti arises creative ideation). This union and mutual relation is called Nāda. As the relation is not some substantial thing apart from Śiva or Śakti, Nāda is really Śiva-Śakti; passing from the state of mere potency into that of the first ideating movement, from which at length, when finally perfected, the whole universe is evolved. The Sākta-Tantras frequently employ erotio symbolism to explain the creative pro- cess. This has led a missionary author to the conclusion that “throughout its symbolism and pseudo-philosophisings NĀDA—THE FIRST PRODUCED MOVEMENT 109 there lies at the basis of the whole system . . . the con- ception of the sexual relationship as the ultimate ex- planation of the universe.” An American author reviewing one of my works has called it “a doctrine for suffragette monists”—“religious feminism run mad.” Both statements are examples of those depreciative misunderstandings which are so common in Western descriptions of Eastern belief and which seem so absurd to anyone who has under- stood the subject. How can “sexual relationship” which exists on the gross plane of matter be the ultimate explana- tion of That which has manifested not only this but all other relations and subjects. As for “feminism” and the supposed priority of the feminine principle, the doctrine has no more to do with either than with old age pensions or any other social question. We are not dealing with the biological question whether the female antedates the male principle, of the social question of the rights of Woman, but with those ultimate dual principles, aspects of the one active Consciousness, which projects from Itself both man and woman and all other dualities on the universe. Śivā and Śakti are one and neither is higher than the other. But how are European writers to be blamed when we find a distinguished Indian Sanskritist affirming that according to Śākta doctrine “God is a woman” (the italics are mine). Śakti is spoken of as female, that is, as Mother, be- cause that is the aspect of the Supreme in which It is thought of as the Genetrix and Nourisher of the universe. But God is neither male nor female. As the Yāmala says for the benefit of all such ignorance, “Neyam ̣ yoṣ it na ca pumān na ṣ aṇ do na jadah smṛ tah.” These are all symbolisms borrowed from the only world which we ordi- narily know—that around us. As for the charge of pseudo- philosophy, if it be that, then same critioism must apply to the Advaitavāda Vedānta. For the Śākta-Tantra is THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 110 the Sādhanā-śāstra of Advaitavāda presenting the teachings of Vedānta in its own manner and in terms of its own ritual symbolism. Thus it is said that Nāda is the Maithuna of Śiva and Śakti and that when Mahākāla was in Vipa- rīta, Maithuna with Mahākāli (a form of Maithuna again which is symbolical of the fact that Śiva is Niṣ kryā and Śakti Sakṛ yā) there issned Bindu. For Maithuna, others substitute the logical term Mitha-samavāyah as a descrip- tion of Nāda, which is Kriyāśakti. Before the appearance of Śabda there must be two. Unity is necessarily action- less. Two involves a third—which is the relation of both; a Trinity of Power which is reflected in the Trimūrti of the Māyika world as Brahmā, Viṣ ṇ u, Rudra. From Nāda came Mahābindu and this latter differenti- ated into the Tribindu which is Kāmakalā, the Mulā of all Mantras. In Pralaya, Śiva and Śakti exist as the ”two in one”; Śiva as Cit, Śakti as Cidrūpiṇ i; the Parā Śakti—not being different or separated from Śiva (Avinā- bhāvasambandha) and being undivided supreme Cit-Śakti (Akhaṇ da-paracicchakti). The Śāradā-Tilaka (1-7) then says: From the Sakala- Parameśvara vested with the wealth of Saccidānanda (Saccidānandavibhavāt) appeared Śakti (Śakti-Tattva); from Śakti, Nāda and from Nāda, Bindu (Mahābindu). Sakala means with Kalā; that is, the Brahman with what the Sām ̣ khya calls Mūlaprakṛ ti, that which the Vedānta calls Avidyā and the Śākta-Tantras or Āgamas call Śakti. On the other hand Niṣ kala Śiva is Nirguṇ a Śiva or that aspect of the Brahman which is unconnected with the creative Śakti; just as Sakala-Śiva is the Brahman so associated. Śiva, in either aspect is always with Śakti; for Śakti is but Himself; but whereas the Śakti associated with Paramaśiva is Cidrūpiṇ ī and Viśvot- tīrṇ ā or beyond the Universe, the Śakti which is associated NĀDA—THE FIRST PRODUCED MOVEMENT 111 with the creative Śiva is that which appears as Uni- verse (Viśvātmikā). The Parāśakti is one with Caitanya at rest. The other aspect which ripens into Nāda and Bindu denotes the “swollen” condition of readiness (Ucchūnāvāsthā) of Her who existed in a subtle state in the great dissolution (Mahāpralaya). These two Śaktis (Nāda, Bindu) are stages in the movement towards the manifestation of the Self as object, that is, as the Universe. In these, the mere readiness or potency of Śaktitattva to act develops into action. In Nāda-Śakti therefore Kriyā predominates. When we speak of stages, development and so forth, we are using language borrowed from the mani- fested world which, in the sense there understood, are not appropriate to a state prior to manifestation; for such manifestation does not take place until after the appearance of the Puruṣ a-Prakṛ ti-Tattva and the deve- lopment from the latter of the impure Tattvas from Buddhi to Pṛ thivī. But a Sādhana Śāstra, even if it had the power to do otherwise, could not usefully use terms and symbols other than those borrowed from the world of the Sādhaka. The Prayogasāra, says that the Śakti who is “turned towards” the state of Liberation (Nirāmaya-pa- donmukhī) awakes as Nāda and is turned to Śiva (Śivon- mukhi) at which time She is said to be male (Pu m ̣ rūpā). For then She becomes Ham ̣ in Ham ̣ sah. She who was one with Paraśiva, in Pralaya as the coalesced “I” (Aham ̣ ) and “This” (Idam ̣ ), now in Her creative aspect as Śakti- tattva transforms Herself into Nāda. Nāda is action (Kriyāśaktirūpa). In simple language, potency and readi- ness to create, (Śaktitattva), becomes for the first time active as Nāda, and then more so as Bindu, which is a further development of Kriyā Śakti dealt with in the next chapter, THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 112 According to Rāghava-Bhatta in his Commentary on the Śāradā some writers do not speak of Nāda, though the author of the Śāradā does so in order to indicate the sevenfold character of Tāra. The Nāda state is however indicated by those Acāryas who speak of Kāla. So it is said, “in the Kālatattva which is Sound” (Ravātmani- kālatative). In the Hymn to Bhuvaneśī also it is said, “Obeisance to Thee who art called Tattva in the character of sound” (Namaste ravaiverna tattvābhidhā me). Nāda occupies the same place in the Mantra scheme as the Sādākhya-Tattva of the 36 Tattvas, for Bindu is Īśvara Tattva. They are each transcendent aspects of Śabda in the respective Tattvas. As Consciousness reaches forth to enjoyment and the “I” is separated from the “This,” what was mere diffusive consciousness as Sadākhya-Tattva is objectified into the all embracing Ākāśa, the Guṇ a of which is gross Śabda; that is some thing experienced as an object apparently different from and other than ourselves. Nāda which etymologically means “Sound” is a technical term of the Mantraśāstra. The latter Śāstra is concerned with Mantravidyā, and Mantra is manifested Śabda whiah also literally means “Sound.” By “Sound” of course is not meant gross sound which is heard by the ear and which is the property of the Kāryākāśa developed as a Vikṛ ti from the Prakṛ ti-Tattva which, with the Puruṣ a-Tattva, occupies the place (though without its dualities) of the Puruṣ a and Prakṛ ti of the Sam ̣ khya. Gross sound belongs to the impure creation as Guṇ a of Ākāśa or the ether which fills space. To avoid miscon- ception, it is better to use the word Śabda which with Artha is manifested in the “Garland (or Rosary) of Letters” (Varṇ armālā) with which I will later deal. Nāda is the most subtle aspect of Śabda, as the first putting forth of Kriyāśaktī. Paranāda and Parā NĀDA—THE FIRST PRODUCED MOVEMENT 113 Vāk are Parāśakti. Nāda into which it evolves in the unmanifested (Avyaktātmā) seed or essence (Nādamātrā) of that which is latter manifested as Śabda, devoid of partioularities suoh as letters and the like (Varṇ ādivi- śeṣ a-rahitah). It develops into Bindu which is of the same character. From the Mantra aspect, as the source of Śabda, this Mahābindu as it differentiates to “create” is called the Śabda-brahman. Bindu when differentiated is also the source of the Vikṛ tis or Tattvas and of their Lords (Tattveśa). In its character as Śabda-brahman it is the source of the maaifested Śabda and Artha (Śab- daśabdārthakāraṇ am ̣ ). Śabda-brahman is thus a name of Brahman as the immediate creative source of the manifold Śabda and Artha. What Śabda-brahman is, has been the subject of con- tention, as Rāghava-Bhatta’s Commentary shows. It is sufficient to say here (where we are only concerned with Śabda-brahmātmah Bindu so far as it is necessary to explain Nāda) that Rāghava-Bhatta, says the Śabda- brahman is the Caitanya in all beings (Caitainyam ̣ sarva- bhūtānām ̣ ). This cosmic Śakti exists in the individual bodies of all breathing creatures (Prāṇ i) in the form of Kuṇ dalinī (Kuṇ dalīrūpā). Nāda therefore which assumes the aspect of Bindu is also Caitanya and Śakti. Nāda is thus the first emanative stage in the production of Mantra. The second is Bindu, or Śabda-brahman; the third is Tribindu (Bindu, Nāda, and Bijā) or Kāmakalā; the fourth is the produotion of Śabda as the Mātṛ kās which are the subtle state of the subsequently manifested gross letters (Varṇ a); and the last is these gross letters (Sthūlaśabda), which compose the manifested Śabda or Mantra composed of letters (Varṇ a), syllables (Pada) and sentences (Vākya). Thus Mantra ultimately derives from Nāda which is itself the Kriyā-śaktirūpa aspect of THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 114 Śiva-Śakti who are the Supreme Nāda (Paranāda) and Supreme Speech (Parā-vāk). The Prayogasāra says: “Oh Devī! that Antarātmā in the form of Nāda (Nādātmā) itself makes sound (Nādate svayam ̣ ),” that is, displays activity. “Urged on by Vāyu (that is, the Prāṇ a-vāyu in Jīvas) it assumes the form of letters.” Nāda again is itself divided into several stages, namely, Mahānāda or Nādānta, the first movement forth of the Śabda-brahman; Nāda, when Śakti fills up the whole Universe with Nādānta, in other words, the completed movement of which Nādānta is the commencement; and Nirodhinī, which is that aspect of Nāda in which its universal operation having been com- pleted, it operates in a particular manner and is trans- formed into Bindu, which is the completion of the first movement of Śakti, in which She assumes the character of the Creative Lord of the Universe (Īśvara-Tattva). Nādānta considered as the end and not the commencement of the series is that in which there is dissolution of Nāda (Nādasya antah layah). Above Bindu, the Śaktis which have been already given in previous articles become more and more subtle until Niṣ kala Unmanī is reached which, as the Yoginīhṛ daya says, is uncreate motionless speech (Anutpamnaniṣ pandā-vāk), the twin aspects of which are Sam ̣ vit or the Void (Śūnya-Sam ̣ vit) and Sam ̣ vit as tendency to manifestation in a subtle state (Utpatsuh sam ̣ vid utpat- tyavasthā sūkṣ mā). Unmanī is beyond Kāraṇ arūpā-Śakti; where there is no experience (Bhānam ̣ ) or Kāla or Kalā nor of Devatā or Tattva, in the sense of category, as that which distinguishes one thing from another. It is Svanir- vāṇ am ̣ param ̣ padam ̣ , Nirvikalpa-nirañjana-śiva-śakti which is Guruvaktra. Nāda and Bindu exist in all Bīja Mantras which are generally written with the Bindu above and the Nāda below, for this is the form of the written Candrabindu. NĀDA—THE FIRST PRODUCED MOVEMENT 115 In however some of the old pictorial representations of Om ̣ kāra the real position of Nāda is shown as being over Bindu as an inverted crescent. Thus the great Bīja, Hrīm ̣ () is composed of Ha, Ra, Ī and Ma. Of these Ha—Ākāśa, Ra—Agni, Ī—Ardhanārīśvara and M—Nāda- bindu. The five Bhūtas are divided into two groups Amūrtta (formless) and Mūrtta (with form). Both Ākāśa and Vāyu belong to the first group, because until the appearance of Agni as Rūpa, there is no colour and form. Agni therefore heads the second division. When Ākāśa is with Agni there is form; for Ra is the first manifestation of Rūpa. This form is in Ardhanārīśvara, the combined Śiva-Śakti, who hold all in themselves. The first three letters represent the Ākāra or form aspect. The Mantra receives its complete form by the addition of the Māhātmya which is Nāda-bindu which are Nirākāra (formless) and the Kāraṇ a (cause) of the other three in which they are impli- citly and potentially contained; being in technical phrase Antargata of, or held within, Bindu, which again is Antargata of all the previously evolving Śaktis mentioned. The meaning of the Bīja-Mantra then is that the Cidākāśa is associated (Yukta) with Rūpa. It is thus the Śabda statement of the birth of General Form; that is, Form as such of which all particular forms are a derivation. Hrīm ̣ is, as pronounced, the gross-body as sound of the ideation of Form as such in the Cosmic Mind. The degree of subtlety of the Śaktis preceding and following Nāda is in the Mantra-Śastra indicated by what is called “the utterance time” (Uccāraṇ akāla). Thus taking Bindu as the unit, Unmanī is Nirākāra and Niruccāra, formless and without utterance, undefined by any adjective: being beyond mind and speech and the universe (Visśvot- tīrṇ ā). The Uccāraṇ akāla of Samanī (so named Manahsahi- tatvāt, on account of its association with mind; the preceding THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 116 Śakti Unmanī being Tadrahitā or devoid of that), is 1—256, of Vyapika 1—128 and so on to Nādānta 1—32, Nāda 1—16, to Ardha-candra which is 1—2 of Bindu and to Bindu itself. Nāda is thus, in the Mantra-Śāstra, that aspect of Śakti which evolves into Bindu, which later as differentiating into the Tsibindu is called the Śabda-brahman, who is the creative source of Srabda and Artha, and thus of the reveal- ed Śabda which Mantra is. I would in conclusion meet an objection, which I have heard urged, namely that the Mantra-Śāstra treats its subject with unnecessary complexity of detail. It is undoubtedly diffioult and requires careful study. Simple minds may be satisfied with the statement that God created the world. Veda too gives an explanation of the cosmic problem in two words “He saw” (sa aikṣ ata). But who saw, and what, and how did He see? How also if there be only One came there to be anything to see? And what is “to see” (Īkṣ ana)? For the process is not like looking out of a window and seeing a man passing. “He” is Consciousness which is in Itself (Svarūpa) actionless. How then did “I” see and thus become active? Because It has two aspects one (Niṣ kala-śiva) in which It is actionless and the other (Sakala-śiva) in which It is Activity as the embodiment of all the Sam ̣ skāras. In this last aspeat it is called Śakti. The latter term denotes Active Consciousness. How can one and the same thing have two contradictory aspects; We cannot say, otherwise than by affirming Svabhāva. By way of analogy we can refer to what psychology calls dual and multiple personalities. The ultimate Reality is alogical and unexplainable (Anirvaoanīya). That it is one and not two is, it is said, proved by Veda and the actual experience (Svānubhava) had in Yoga. What is “seeing”? It is not the observing of something outside which was there before it was NĀDA—THE FIRST PRODUCED MOVEMENT 117 observed. “Seeing” is the rising into consoiousness (void of objects) of the memory of past universes existing in the form of the Sam ̣ skāras. Before this can occur, Consciousness must obscure to Itself Its nature and (though in truth an unity) must experience itself as an “I” observing a “This” which it has through Māya Śakti projected outside Itself. There is no answer again to the question how this is possi- ble except inscrutable Śakti (Acintya-Śakti). But just as a man rising from deep sleep has first a more or less bare awareness which is gradually filled out with the thought of self and particular objects; consciousness coming to itself, so that in the waking state it again recognises the world which had vanished utterly in dreamless slumber; so it is with the Cosmic Consciousness. Just as man does not pass at once from dreamless slumber to the fullest waking perception; so neither does the Cosmic Conscious- ness. It passes gradually from its dreamless slumber (Suṣ upti) state which is the general dissolution (Mahāpra- laya) to the waking state (Jāgrat) which is consciousness of the gross universe. The degrees in this emanative process are the Tattvas described in the last article. Manifestation, which is nothing but presentation of apparently external objects to the inner consciousness, is, as experienced by the limited consciousness, gradual. The seeds of the “I” and “This” are first formed and then grown. The first principal stage is that before and in Īśvara Tattva of Bindu and which therefore includes Nāda. The second is that of the World-consciousness arising through the agency of Māyā- śakti. These two stages are marked by two principal differences. In the first the “This” (Idam ̣ ) is seen as part of the self, the two not being differentiated in the sense of inner and outer. In the second the object is externalised and seen as different from the self. In the first, when the Self experiences itself as object, the latter is held as a THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 118 vague undefined generality. There is, as it were, an aware- ness of self-scission in which the self as subject knows itself as object and nothing more. The degrees in this process have been already explained. In the second not only is the object defined as something which appears to be not the self, but there are a multiplicity of objects each marked by its own differences; for Māyā has intervened. The whole world-process is thus a re-awakening of the Cosmic Consciousness from sleep to the world, into which at Dissolution it had fallen; and the Tattvas mark the gradual stages of re-awakening, that is re-awakening to the world, but a falling into sleep so far as true Conscious- ness is concerned. So in Kuṇ dalīyoga when Kuṇ dalinī sleeps in the Mūlādhāra, man is awake to the world; and when She awakes, the world vanishes from Consciousness which then regains its own state (Svarūpa). There is no reason to suppose that, judged in the terms of our present experience, the change is other than gradual. But how, it may be asked, is this known or what the stages are; for were we there? As individuals we were not; for we speak of that which preceded the formation of the Sakala Jīva Consciousness. But Jīva was there as the plant is in the seed. It is the one Śiva who displays himself in all the Tattvas. Those who fall back into the seed have experience of it. There are, however, two bases on which these affirma- tions rest. In the first place there is correspondence between all planes. “What is without, is so manifested because it is within”; not of course in the exact form in which it exists without, but in the corresponding form of its own plane. We may therefore look for instruction to our daily life and its psychological states to discover both the elements and the working of the cosmic process. These also disclose a gradual unfolding of consciousness from something in the nature of mere awareness to the definite perception NĀDA—THE FIRST PRODUCED MOVEMENT 119 of a variety of multiple objects. But the normal experience is by its nature limited. That normal experience is, however, transcended in Yoga-states, when conscious- ness becomes Nirālam ̣ bapuri, that is, detached from worldly objects: the experience wherein is (in part at least) available for the instruotion of others. Secondly the Śāstras are records of truth beyond the senses (Atīndriya-Tattva). The Tattvas are not put forth as mere speculative guesses or imaginings of what might have been. When, however, supersensual truth is describ- ed in language it is necessarily expressed in terms, and with the use of symbols, of present experience. That ex- perience is had under conditions of time and space and others. We know and speak of mere potency ripening into actuality, of potential energy becoming more and more kinetic, of shifting states of consciousnees, and so forth. These are matters the knowledge of which is drawn from the world around us. But this does not necessarily make them wholly untrue or unreal as applied to higher planes. One of the commonest errors is to raise false partitions between things. The experience is real for it is Śiva’s and His experience is never unreal. It is according to its degree (that is on its plane) real; an expression (limited though it be) of the ultimate Reality Itself. We can think in no other terms. But it is also true that these terms and symbols, having only complete validity on our plane, are no longer wholly true for Consciousness as it rises from it. But other forms of Consciousness must take their place until the Formless is reached. The Tattvas explain (limited though suoh explanation be by the bounds of our thought and language) the modes through which the return- ing Consciousness passes until it rests in Itself (Svarūpa- viśrānti) and has Peace. And so the Buddhist Mantra- yāna aptly defines Yoga (which in Tibetan is called THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 120 rNal-rByor) in the sense of result, as the “Finding rest or peace.” This final state, as also those intermediate ones which lie between it and the normal individual world-con- sciousness, are only actually realised in Jñāna-Yoga (by whatsoever method Jñāna is attained) when the mind has been wholly withdrawn from without and faces the opera- tive power of Consciousness behind it (Nirāmaya-padon- mukhī). But here we are dealing with Mantra-yoga when the mind is thinking the states which Jñāna, in whatever degree, realises as Consciousness. The Mantra-Śāstra looks at the matter, of which we write, from the stand- point of Mantra that is of manifested Śabda its object. Kuṇ dalinī is both Jyotirmayī, Her Sūkṣ marūpa; and Mantramayī, Her Sthularūpa. We begin with the latter. All things are then defined in terms of Śabdārtha and of the various causal forms which precede it. The first of such produced forms is Nāda which becomes Bindu and then on the differentiation of the Tattvas the “hidden sound” (Avyakta-rava), the Logos or Cosmic Word utters “the Garland of Letters” (Var ṇ amālā) of which all Mantras are formed. It traces the degrees in which the ideating Cosmic Consciousness becomes, as Supreme Speech (Parā- vāk), the Genetrix of the subtle and gross Śabda which are the Mātṛ kās and Varṇ as respectively. That Supreme Speech (Parā-vāk) is without idea or language, but is represented as gradually assuming the state in which it utters both and projects from Itself into the sensual world the objects (Artha) which they denote. The actual manifestation of these from Para-śabda through Paśyantī, Madhyamā and Vaikharī, will be described in another Chapter. The practice of Mantra-Yoga not only gives, from a merely intellectual standpoint, an understanding of Vedānta which cannot ordinarily be had by the mere reading of NĀDA—THE FIRST PRODUCED MOVEMENT 121 philosophical texts; but also produces a pure Bhāva ripening into Mahābhāva through the purification of mind (Citta-śuddhi) which such practice (according to the rules of Sādhana laid down in the Tantras or Mantra- śāstra) gives, as one of its Siddhis. What the Western, and sometimes the English educated Indian, does not understand or recognise, is the fact that the mere reading of Vedāntic texts without Citta-śuddhi will neither bring true understanding or other fruitful result. The experi- enced will find that this apparent complexity and wealth of detail is not useless and is, from an extra-ritual standpoint, to a considerable extent, and from that of Sādhana wholly, necessary. A friend of mine was once asked by a man in a somewhat testy manner “to give him a plain exposition of the Vedānta in five minutes.” It takes years to understand perfectly any science or profession. How can that, which claims to explain all, be mastered in a short talk? But more than this; however prolonged the intellectual study may be, it must, to be fruitful, be accompanied by some form of Sādhana. The Tantra-Śāstras contain this for the Hindu, though it is open to him or any other to devise a better if he can. Forms ever change with the ages, while the Truth which they express, remains. CHAPTER XIII BINDU OR ŚAKTI—READY TO CREATE FROM Nāda, previously described, evolved Bindu (Nādād bindu-samudbhavah). What then is Bindu? Literally the term means a “Drop” or a “Point” such as the Aunsvāra breathing. But in the Mantra-Śāstra it has a technical meaning. It is not, as a distinguished Indian Sanskritist called it, merely a “Drop.” It is not that “red drops” mix with “white drops” and so forth, a descripiton of his, which reminds one more of the pharmacy or sweet shop than the Śāstra. This and other statements betray an ignorance of Indian tradition and a mental attitude alien to Indian thinking which distinguishes so many of those whose souls have been captured in the net of an English education. Those who speak another’s language and think another’s thought must see to it that their own Indian self is not, through the dangers to which it is thus exposed, lost. But even an educated Western, ignorant of the Śāstra, but with a knowledge of the history of religious thought would have perceived the significance of the term Bindu when he had learnt that one of its literal meanings was a “Point.” In an anonymous Mystical Work published in the eighteenth century by one of the “French Protestants of the Desert” called Le Mystere de la Croix, it is said (p. 9), “Ante omnia Punctum exstitit; non to atomon, aut mathematicum sed diffusivum. Monas erat explicite; BINDU OR ŚAKTI—READY TO CREATE 123 implicite Myrias. Lux erat, erant et Tenebræ; Principium et Finis Principii. Omnia et nihil: Est et non.” “Before all things were, there was a Point (Punctum: Bindu) not the Atom or mathematical point (which though it is without magnitude has position) but the diffusive (neither with magnitude nor position). In the One (Monas) there was implicitly contained the Many (Myrias). There was Light and Darkness: Beginning and End: Everything and Nothing: Being and Non-being (that is, the state was neither Sat nor Asat).” The author says that the All is engendered from the central indivisible Point of the double triangle (that is, what is called in the Tantras, Ṣ atkoṇ a- Yantra) regarded as the symbol of creation. “Le Tout est engendré du point central indivisible du double triangle.” This “Point” is one of the world’s religious symbols and is set in the centre of a Ṣ atkoṇ a as above or in a circular Maṇ dala or sphere. On this symbol St. Clement of Alexandria in the second century A.D. says that if ab- straction be made from a body of its properties, its depth, breadth, and then length, “the point which remains is a unit, so to speak, having position; from which if we abstract position there is the notion of unity” (Stromata V. 2. Ante Nicene Library, Vol. IV). Again Shelley in his “Prom- etheus” says: “plunge into eternity where recorded time seems but a point.” Where does the Extended universe go at the Great Dissolution (Mahāpralaya)? It collapses so to speak into a Point. This point may be regarded as a mathematical point in so far as it is without any magnitude whatever, but as distinguished from it, in that it has in fact no posi- tion. For there is then no notion of space. It need hardly be said that this is a symbol, and a symbol borrowed from our present experience cannot adequately represent any state beyond it. We only conceive of it as a point, as something THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 124 infinitesimally subtle, which is in contrast with the extend- ed manifested universe which is withdrawn into it. This point is Bindu. But this again is to make use of material images borrowed from the world of objective form. Bindu is an aspect of Śakti or Consciousness; therefore it is interpreted also in terms of our present consciousness. As so interpreted and as Īśvara-Tattva, in which it is, Śakti is called Bindu; because here consciousness completely identifies itself with the universe as unmanifested Idam ̣ and thus subjectifies it and becomes with it a point of consciousness. Thus by way of example the individual mind is completely subjectified and exists for each of us as a mathematical point (and so it is spoken of by some as being of atomic dimension) though the body to the extent to which it is not subjectified appears as an object or extended thing. We do not conceive of our own minds as extended because of this complete subjectification. In the same way the consciousness of Īśvara completely sub- jectifies the universe. He does not of course see the universe as a multiplicity of objects outside and different from Himself; for if He did, He would be Jīva and not Īśvara. He sees it as an object which is a whole and which whole is Himself. In Sadākhya-Tattva “Otherness” (Idam ̣ ) is presented to Consciousness by Śakti. This Idam ̣ is then faintly perceived (to use the language of the Vimarśinī on Īśvara-Pratyabhijñna III. 1, 2) “in a hazy fashion (Dhyāmalaprāyam) like a picture just forming itself (Unmīlita-mātra-citra-kalpam); seen by the mind only and not as something seen outside by the senses (Antahkaraṇ aikavedyam ̣ ).” The object thus vaguely surges up into the field of conscionsness in which the emphasis is on the cognitive aspect or “I” (Aham ̣ ). This however is not the “I” or “This” of our experience, for it is had in the realms beyond Māyā. The “This” is then experienced BINDU OR ŚAKTI—READY TO CREATE 125 as part of the Self. In Īśvara Tattva all haziness gives place to clarity of the “This” which is thus seen com- pletely as part of the Self; the emphasis being an the “This.” After equal emphasis on the “I” and “This”, the two are in Śuddhavidyā-Tattva wholly separated by Māyā. When therefore the Yogī passes beyond the Māyik world his first higher experience is in this Tattva. Nāda and Bindu are states of Śakti in which the germ of action (Kriysā-śakti) so to speak increasingly sprouts with a view to manifestation producing a state of compactness of energy and readiness to create. Rāghava- Bhatta (Comm. Śāradā I. 7) speaks of them as two states of Śakti which are the proper conditions (Upāyogyāvasthā) for creation. They are, like all else, aspecta of Śakti, but are names of those aspects which are prone to and ready for creation (Uccūnāvasthā). Bindu is said to be the massive or Ghanāvasthā state of Śakti. The Prapañcasāra- Tantra says that Śakti is seized with the desire to create and becomes Ghanībhūtā (Vicikīrṣ ur ghanībhūtā). Thus milk becomes Ghanībhūta when it turns into cream or curd. In other words, Śakti is conceived as passing gradually from its subtle state through Śakti-tattva and Nāda (in its three-stages) and becomes what is relatively gross or massive as Power which is fully equipped to pass from the stage of potenoy into that of active manifestation. That stage is Bindu which is called Mahābindu or Para- bindu to distinguish it from the other Bindus into which it subsequently differentiates. The commentary of Kālīcaraṇ a on the Ṣ atcakra- nirūpaṇ a (see Serpent Power, V. 4) citing Toḍ ala-Tantra (Ch. VI) says that the Supreme Light is formless; but Bindu implies both the Void (Śūnya) and Guṇ a also. Bindu is the Void in so far as it is the Supreme Brahman. It implies Guṇ a as being the creative or Śakti aspect of THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 126 the Brahman which subsequently evolves into the Puruṣ a, and Prakṛ ti-Tattvas of which the latter is with Guṇ a. The commentary to V. 49 states that this Bindu is the Lord (Īśvara) whom some Paurāṇ ikas call Mahāviṣ ṇ u and others the Brahmapuruṇ a: and (V. 37) that Para-bindu is the state of “Ma” before manifestation; being Śiva- Śakti enveloped by Maya. As to this it may be observed that the letter M is male, and Bindu which is the nasal breathing, sounded as M, is the unmanifested Śiva-Śakti or Ma which is revealed upon its subsequent differentiation into the three Śaktis from which the universe proceeds. Bindu as the Cause is Cidghana or massive Consciousness and Power in which lie potentially in a mass (Ghana), though undistinguishable the one from other, all the worlds and beings about to be oreated. This is Parama-Śiva and in Him are all the Devatās. It is thus this Bindu which is worshipped in secret by all Devas (V. 41) and which is indicated in its different phases in the Candra- bindu (Nāda-Bindu) Śakti and Śanta of the Om ̣ and other Bīja mantras. This Bindu is in Satyaloka which, within the human body, exists in the pericarp of the thousand-petalled Lotus (Sahasrāra,) in the highest cerebral centre. It is, as I have already said, compared to a grain of gram (Caṇ aka) which under its outer sheath (which is Mayā) contains the two seeds (Śiva and Śakti) in close and undivided union. Kālīcaraṇ a (V. 49) thus oites the following: “In the Satyaloka is the formless and lustrous one. She is like a grain of gram devoid of hands, feet and the like. She has surrounded Herself by Mayā (that is She is about to create by the agency of this Power of Hers). She is Sun, Fire and Moon. She being intent on creation (Unmukhī) becomes twofold (Dvidhā bhitva) and then, by differen- tiation of Śiva and Śakti, arises creative ideation BINDU OR ŚAKTI—READY TO CREATE 127 (Sṛ ṣ tikalpalnā). Śiva and Śakti are of course not actually divided for they are not like a chapatti or some other material thing. It might seem unnecessary to make such obvious remarks, did not experience tell me of the absurd misunderstandings which exist of the Scripture. When we read that God “is a woman,” that the Śākta Tantra is “Feminism” with a doctrine similar to that of Prof. Lester Ward’s primacy of the female sex, that “the conception of the sexual relationship is the ultimate explanation of the universe” and so forth, no caveats, however obvious, are unnecessary. What of course is meant is that, whereas in Praḷ aya, Śiva and Śakti existed as one unity of consciousness, They in creation, whilst still remaining in themselves what They always were, project the universe which is Śakti; and then we have the Paramātmā and Jivātmā consciousness which seem to the latter to be different. Although Parabindu and all which evolves from It are nothing but aspects of Śakti and in no wise different from it, yet as representing that state of Śakti which immediately precedes creation, it is this state of Śakti which is said to be the cause of the universe of name and form (Nāmarūpa); concepts and concepts objectified; or Śabda the word and Artha its meaning. The states of Śakti preceding Bindu are those in which the Bindu state is in process of being “evolved” according to what we may call an Avikṛ ta-Pasiṇ āma and when evolved it is the cause of the universe. Really they are merely aspects of one and the same pure Śakti. This is not an evolution in time. As Plotinus says, the universe “was formed according to intellect (here the Cosmic Power or Prapañca-Śakti which manifests as Mahat) and in- tellect not preceding in time but prior” (in the sense that cause precedes effect). This again, as all descriptions, THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 128 (in so far as they are applicable to the transcendent Śakti) is imperfect, for sequence of cause and effect in- volves to our minds the notion of time. This Supreme Bindu as containing in Himself all Devatās is the ultimate object of adoration by all classes of worshippers (V. 44) under the name of Śiva, or Mahāviṣ ṇ u or the Devī as those call it “who are filled with a passion for Her Lotus Feet.” The sectarianism of the lower mind, still existent in both East and West, is here shown to be a matter of words (the fight for which is of such interest to many) and is reduced to its real common denominator. As the Lord says in the Gītā, Whomever men may worship all such worship comes eventually to Him. Para-bindu is thus the Head of every line of creation; of the Tattvas or Vikṛ tis from Buddhi to Pṛ thivi and their Lords (Tattveśa) and of the Śabda or Mantra creations; all belonging to the Vikāra-Sṛ ṣ ti or Pariṇ āma- Sṛ ṣ ti. The development after the manifestation of Prakṛ ti is a real evolution (Pariṇ āma), for Consciousness has then been divided into subject and object in time and space. What is spoken of in terms of a development in the Īśwara body is not that. There Śakti assumes various aspects with a view to create but without manifestation. Śakti-tattva, whilst remaining such, assumes the aspects of Nāda and Bindu. The next stage is thus desoribed in the Śāradā-Tilaka (Ch. 1-8, 9) as follows: Paraśaktimayah sākṣ āt tridhā’sau bhidyate punah. Bindur nādo bījam ̣ iti tasya bhedāh samīritāh. Binduh śivatmako bījam śaktir nādas tayor mithah. Samavāyah samākhyātah sarvāgamaviśāradaih. (That which is supreme Śakti again divides Itself into three, such divisions being known as Bindu, Nāda, BINDU OR ŚAKTI—READY TO CREATE 129 Bīja. Bindu is said to be of the nature of Śiva and Bīja of Śakti, and Nāda is the mutual relation between these two, by those who are learned in the Āgamas). One Ms. I have seen has ‘Bindur nādātmako’, but the commentary of the Ṣ atcakra (V. 40) explains this as Śivāt- maka. These form the three Bindus (Tribindu). Nāda here again is Trait d’union, the Yoga of the other two Bindus as the Prayogasāra calls it. (See Rāghava’s Comm. to V. 8 of Ch. I Śāradā). These are Śiva, Śiva-Śakti, Śakti. By this it is not to be understood that Śiva or Śakti are ever altogether dissociated but the aspects may be regarded as Śiva or Śakti-pradhāna respectively. Bhāskararāya in his valuable commentary on the Lalitā-Sahasranāma says “From the causal (Kāraṇ a) Bindu proceeds the effect (Kārya) Bindu, Nāda and Bīja. Thus these three which are known as supreme, subtle and gross arose.” (Asmāc- ca kāraṇ abindoh sākṣ at krameṇ a kāryabindus tato nādas- tato bījam ̣ iti trayam utpannam ̣ tadidam ̣ parasūkṣ masthūla- padair apy ucyate, V. 132). One text of the Prapañcasāra-Tantra says that the Parabindu divides into two parts, of which the right is Bindu, the Male, Puruṣ a or Ham ̣ , and the left Visarga, the Female, Prakṛ ti or Sah making the combined Ham ̣ sah. Ha m ̣ sah is the union of Prakṛ ti and Puruṣ a and the universe is Ham ̣ sah. In however the Ms. on which my edition of that Tantra is based it is said that the Bindu (Para) divided by Kāla becomes threefold as Bindu, Nāda, Bīja. Substantially the matter seems one of nomenclature, for the two Bindus which make Visarga become three by the addition of the Śiva-Bindu. Moreover as Ham ̣ g is Śiva and Sah is Śakti, the combined Ham ̣ sah implies the relation which in the Śāradā account is called Nāda. So it is also said from the first vowel issued “Hrīm ̣ ,” from the second Ha m ̣ sah, and from the third the Mantra “Hrī m ̣ , THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 130 Śrī m ̣ , Klī m ̣ ,” the first indicative of general form; the second being a more Sthūla form of Ākāśa and Agni (Sa = Ākāśa; Ra = Agni) held as it were within the “skin” (Carma) of the enveloping Ardhanārīśvara: the third commencing with the first and last letters including all the 24 Tattvas and all the fifty letters into which the general Form parti- cularises itself. Para-bindu is Śiva-Śakti considered as undivided, undifferentiated principles. On the “bursting” of the seed which is the Parabindu the latter assumes a threefold aspect as Śiva or Bindu, Śakti or Bīja and Nāda the Śiva-Śakti aspect which, considered as the result, is the combination, and from the point of view of cause, the inter-relation of the two (Śāradā I. 9) the one acting as excitant (Kṣ obhaka) and the other being the excited (Kṣ obhya). The commentary on V. 40 of the Ṣ at- cakranirūpaṇ a speaks of Nāda as the union of Śiva and Śakti; as the connection between the two and as being in the nature of the Śakti of action (Kriyā-śakti-svarūpa). It is also said to be that, the substance of which is Kundalī (Kuṇ dalinīmaya). All three are but different phases of Śakti in creation (Comm. I. 39) being different aspects of Parabindu which is itself the Ghanāvasthā aspect of Śakti. Thus in the first division of Śakti, Nāda, Bindu, Nāda is the Maithuna or Yoga of Śiva and Śakti to produce the Para-bindu which again differentiates into threefold aspects as the Śaktis, though in grosser form, which produced it. Though the Guṇ as are factors of the gross Śakti Prakṛ ti, they are in subtle form contained within the higher Śaktis. This Śakti as the first poten- tially kinetic aspect about to display itself is the Cit aspect of Śakti and Cit Śakti is, when seen from the lower level of the Guṇ as, Sāttvik; Nāda is in the same BINDU OR ŚAKTI—READY TO CREATE 131 sense Rājasik, for Śakti becomes more and more kinetic gathering together Its powers, as it were from the previous state of barely stirring potency, for the state of complete readiness to create which is Bindu, and which in the aforesaid sense as Ghanībhūta foreshadows that Tamas Guṇ a which at a lower stage is the chief factor which creates the world, for the latter is largely the product of Tamas. Each aspect of the Tribindu again is associated with one or other of the Guṇ as. These divisions of aspect from the Guṇ a stand-point are not to be understood as though they were separate and exclusively concerned with only one of the Guṇ as. The Guṇ as themselves never exist separately. Where there is Sattva there is also Rajas and Tamas. In the same way in the case of the three Śaktis Icchā, Jñāna, Kriyā, from which the Guṇ as develop, one never stands by itself, though it may be predominant. Where there is Icchā there is Jñāna and so forth. And so again Śakti, Nāda and Bindu are not to be severed like different objects in the Māyik world. In eaoh there is implicitly or explicitly contained the other. Parameśvara assumes (for the Jīva) successively the triple aspects of Śakti, Nāda Bindu, Kārya Bindu, Bīja, Nāda, thus com- pleting by this differentiation of Śakti the sevenfold causal sound-forms of the Praṇ ava or Om ̣ kāra; namely, Sakala Parameśvara [which is Saccidānanda, for even when the Brahman is associated with Avidyā its own true na- ture (Svarūpa) is not affected,] Śakti (Śakti-Tattva) Nāda (Sādākhya-Tattva) Parabindu (Īśvara-Tattva) Bindu (Kārya) Nāda and Bīja. It is not clear to me where (if at all) the Śuddha-vidyā-Tattva comes in according to this scheme, unless it be involved in Nāda the Mithah-samavāya; but the Puruṣ a-Prakṛ ti-Tattvas appear to take birth on the division of the Para-bindu into Śiva and Śakti or Ham ̣ and Sah; Ham ̣ sah being the Puruṣ a-Prakṛ ti Mantra. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 132 The first impulse to creation comes from the ripening of the Adṛ ṣ ta of Jīvas, on which Sakala Parameśvara puts forth His Śakti (which means Himself as Śakti) to pro- duce the Universe wherein the fruits of Karma may be suffered and enjoyed. All the above seven stages are in- cluded in, and constitute, the first stage of Īkṣ aṇ a or “Seeing” and is that stage in which Śabda exists in its supreme or Para form (Para-śabdasṛ ṣ ti). She who is eternal (Anādirūpā) existing subtly as Cidrūpiṇ i in Mahā- pralaya becomes on the ripening of Adṛ ṣ ta inclined (Utsuka) towards the life of form and enjoyment, and reveals Herself on the disturbance of the equilibrium of the Guṇ as. As the Vāyavīya-Sam ̣ hitā says “Parā-Śakti through the will of Śiva is revealed with Śiva-Tattva (for the purpose of creation). Then She manifests as the oil which is latent in, and exudes from, the sesamum seed.” Parameśvara is Saguṇ a-Śiva or the Īśvara of Vedānta Philosophy with Māyā as His Upādhi. He is Sat, Cit, Ananda in Māyā body and endowed with all Śaktis (Sarva-vedānta-siddānta-sāra-sa m ̣ graha 312, 313, 315). There is, as the Pañcadaśī says, (3-38), a Śakti of Śiva which is in and controls all things which have their origin in Ānanda or Īśvara. When Īśvara is moved to create, this Īśvara-śakti or Māyā which is the aggregate of, and which yet transcends, all individual Śaktis issues from Him and from this Māyā issue all the particular Śaktis by which the universe is evolved and is maintained. The same substance is, to a large extent, to be found in all accounts under a variety of presentment or Symbols; even where there are real differences due to the diversity of doctrine of different Vedāntic schools. This is not the case here: for the account given is a Sādhana presentment of Advaita- vāda. The Śākta-Tantra teaches the unity of Paramātmā and Jīva, though its presentation of some subjects as Śakti, BINDU OR ŚAKTI—READY TO CREATE 133 Māyā, Cidābhāsa is different (owing to its practical view point) from Śam ̣ kara’s Māyāvāda. On this matter I may refer my readers to the article which I recently wrote on Śakti and Mayā in the second number of the Indian Philosophical Review (Baroda) since incorporated in my “Śakti and Śākta.” The three Bindus constitute the great Triangle of World-Desire which is the Kāmakalā; an intricate subject which I must leave for a future chapter. The three Bindus are Sun, Moon and Fire and three Śaktis Icchā, Jñāna, Kriyā associated with the three Guṇ as Sattva, Rajas, Tamas. I do not here deal with the order or correspondence which requires discussion. From them issued the Devīs Raudrī, Jyeṣ tha, Vāmā and the Trimūrtis Rudra, Brahmā, Viṣ ṇ u. The three Bindus are also known as the white Bindu (Sita-bindu), the red Bindu (Śoṇ a-bindu) and the mixed Bindu (Miśra-bindu). These represent the Prakāśara, Vimarśa and Prakāśa-Vimarśa aspects of the Brahman which are called in the ritual Caraṇ a-tritaya (The Three Feet). The Gurupādukā-Mantra in which initiation is given in the last or Ṣ adāmnāya-Dīkśā represents a state beyond the Śukla, Rakta and Miśra-Caraṇ as. So it is said in Śruti that there are four Brahmapadas, three here and one the Supreme which is beyond. As is the case in many other systems the One for the purpose of creation is presented in twofold aspect, for Unity is actionless, and their relation involves a third aspect which makes the Trinity. But this apparent differ- entiation does not derogate from the substantial unity of the Brahman. As the ancient Rudrayāmala (II. 22) says: “The three Devas Brahmā, Viṣ ṇ u, Maheśvara are but one and formed out of My body.” Ekā mūrtis trayo devā brahmaviṣ ṇ umaheśvarāh Mama vigrahasam ̣ kḷ ptāh sṛ jaty avati hanti ca. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 134 From the differentiating Bindu are evolved the Tattvas from Buddhi to Pṛ thivi and the six Lords of the Tattvas (preceding Paraśiva the seventh) who are the presiding Devatās of mind and of the five forms of matter. Here on the diremption or dichotomy of Consciousness, Mind and Matter are produced. That is, Consciousness functions in and through the self-created limitations of mind and matter. It was on this division also that there arose the Cosmic Sound (Śabda-brahman) which manifests as Śabda and Artha. This is the Śabda-brahman; so called by those who know the Āgamas. Bhidyamānāt parād bindor avyaktātmā ravo’bhavat. Śabdabrahmeti tam ̣ prāhuh sarvāgamaviśāradāh. (Śāradā-Tilaka I-II) It will be observed that in this verse the first Bindu is called Para and to make this clear the author of the Prānatosiṇ i adds the following note: “By Para-bindu is meant the first Bindu which is a state of Śakti (Parād- bindority anena śaktyavasthārūupo yah prathamabindus tasmāt). Śabda-brahman is the Brahman in Its aspect as the immediate undifferentiated Cause of the manifested and differentiated Śabda, or language in prose or verse; and of Artha or the subtle or gross objects which thought and language denote. It is thus the causal state of the manifested Śabda or Mantra. CHAPTER XIV MĀYĀ-TATTVA WHAT Matter is in itself the senses do not tell us. All that can be predicated of it is its effect upon these senses. The experiencer is affected in five different ways giving rise in him to the sensations o hearing (Śabda); feel by which is experienced the thermal quality of things (Śparśa); colour and form (Rūpa); taste (Rasa); and smell (Gandha). The cause of these are the five Bhūtas which, in the general cosmic evolution, are derived from the Tanmātras or general elements of the particulars of sense perception. These again together with the senses (Indriyas) or faculties of mind operating through a particular physical organ as their instrument and Manas the mental faculty of attention, selection and synthesis of the discrete manifold, derive from the still more general aspects of the Cosmic Mind or Antahkaraṇ a which are the personal forms of limited ex- perience repsectively called Aham ̣ kāra and Buddhi. These again are evolutes from that form of Śakti which is Prakṛ ti-Tattva and which in the 36 Tattvas scheme comes into being through the instrumentality of Māyā-Śakti from the preceding Tattvas of the pure creation extending from Śuddha-vidyā to Śiva-śakti-Tattva; the Svarūpa of the last being Saccidānanda or Pure spirit. Matter is thus a manifestation or aspect of Spirit. The two are ultimately one. They seem to be two because the fundamental Feel- ing (Cit) is able, as Śakti, to experience itself as object. As Professor Haeckel says, in conformity with Śakta Monism, THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 136 Spirit and Matter are not two distinct entities but two forms or aspects of one single fundamental Substance (which is here the Brahman). The one entity with dual aspect is the sole Reality which presents itself to view as the infinitely varied picture of the universe. The two are inseparably combined in every atom which, itself and its forces, possesses the elements not only of vitality but of further development in all degrees of consiousness and will. The ultimate substance is Śakti, which is of dual aspect as Cit-Śakti which represents the spiritual, and Māyā- Śakti which represents the material aspect. These are not separable. In the universe the former is the Spirit- matter and the latter Matter-spirit. The two exist in insepar- able connection (Avinābhava-sam ̣ bandha) as insepara- ble (to use a simile of the Śaiva-Śāstra) as the winds of the heaven from the ether in which they blow. Manifested Śakti or Māyā is the universe. Unmanifest Śakti is feeling- consciousness (Cidrūpā). Māyā-Śakti appears as subtle mind and as gross matter and as the life-force and is in Herself (Svarūpa) consciousness. There is and can be nothing absolutely lifeless or unconscious because Śakti is in itself Being—Feeling—Conscionsness—Bliss (Cid- rūpiṇ ī, Ānandamayī) beyond all worlds (Viśvottīrṇ ā); and appears as apparently unconscious, or partly conscious and partly unconscious, material forms in the universe (Viśvāt- maka). The universe is Śakti. Therefore it is commingled spirit-Matter. Śakti beyond all worlds is Consciousness. The one Consciousness exists throughout; when changeless it receives the name of Śiva; when the source of, and as all moving objects it is called Śakti The universe arises through a Negation or Veiling of true Consciousness. As the Spanda-kārikā says “By veiling the own true form its Śaktis ever arise” (Svarū- pāvara ṇ e cāsya śaktayah statotthitāh). This is a MĀYĀ-TATTVA 137 common doctrine of the three schools here discussed. The difference lies in this, that in Sām ̣ khya it is a second independent principle (Prakrti) which veils; in Māyāvāda Vedānta it is the non-Brahman unexplainable mystery (Māyā) which veils, and in Śākta-Advaitavāda it is Consciousness which, without ceasing to be such, yet veils itself. This statement shortly describes the differ- ence in the three concepts which may however be more fully elaborated. The Mahānirvāṇ a-Tantra says that the Vākya “All this verily is Brahman” (Sarvam ̣ khalivida m ̣ Brahma) is the basis of Kulācāra. But Brahman is Consciousness; and it cannot be denied that there is an element of apparent unconsciousness, in things. Sām ̣ khya says that this is due to another Principle independent of the Puruṣ a-consciousness, namely, the unconscious Prakṛ ti, which is real, notwithstanding its changes. But accord- ing to Advaitavāda Vedānta there is only one Reality. It therefore denies the existence of any second independ- ent principle. Śam ̣ kara attributes unconsciousness to the unexplainable (Anirvacanīyā wonder (Māyā), which is neither real (Sat) nor unreal (Asat) nor partly real and partly unreal (Sadasat), and which though not form- ing part of Brahman, and therefore not Brahman, is yet, though not a second reality, inseparately associated and sheltering with Brahman (Māyā Brahmāsritā) in one of its aspects (Īśvara); owing what false appearance of reality it has to the Brahman with which it is so associated. It is an eternal falsity (Mithyābhūtā sanā- tanī) unthinkable, alogical, unexplainable (Aniruacanīya). The reflection of Puruṣ a on Prakṛ ti gives the appear- ance of consciousness to the latter. So also the reflec- tion (Cidābhāsa) of Brahman on unconscious Māyā is Īśvara and on unconscious Avidyā is Jīva. Though THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 138 Māyā is thus not a second reality, the fact of positing it at all gives to Śam ̣ kara’s doctrine a tinge of dualism from which the Śākta doctrine (which has yet a weakness of its own) is free. The Śākta doctrine has no need of Cidābhāsa. It says that Māyā is a Śakti of Brahman and being Śakti, which is not different from the possessor of Śakti (Śaktimān), it is, in its Svarūpa, consciousness. It is then consciousness which veils itself; not unconscious Māyā which veils consciousness. According to Śam ̣ - kara, man is the Spirit (Ātmā) vestured in the Māyik falsities of mind and matter. He accordingly can only establish the unity of Jīva and Īśvara by eliminating from the first Avidyā and from the second Māyā, both being essentially—and from the transcendent standpoint— nothing. Brahman is thus left as common denominator. The Śakta has need to eliminate nothing. Man’s spirit or Ātmā is Śiva. His mind and body are Śakti. Śiva and Śakti are one. The Jīvātmā is Śiva-Śakti, the latter being understood as in its world-aspect. So is the Paramātmā; though here Śakti, being uncreating, is in the form of Consciousness (Cidrūpiṇ i). The supreme Śiva-Śakti exists as one. Śiva-Śakti as the world is the Manifold. Man is thus not the Spirit covered by a non- Brahman falsity but Spirit covering itself with its own Power of Śakti. As the Kaulācārya Satyānanda says in his Commentary (which I have published) on the 4th Mantra of the Īśopaniṣ ad—“The changeless Brahman which is consciousness appears in creation as Māyā which is Brah- man (Brahmamayī) Consciousness (Cidrūpiṇ i) holding in Herself unbeginning (Anādi) Kārmik tendencies (Karma- sam ̣ skāra) in the form of the three Guṇ as. Hence She is Guṇ amayī (Her substance is Guṇ a) despite being Cinmayī (Consciousness). As there is no second prin- ciple these Guṇ as are Cit-Śakti.” Hence, in the MĀYĀ-TATTVA 139 words of the Yogini-hrdaya-Tantra, the Devī is Prakāśa- vimarśasāmarasyarūpiṇ ī. There is thus truly no uncon- scious Māyā and no Cidābhāsa. All which exists is Con- sciousness as Śakti. “Aham ̣ strī” as the Advaitabhāva Upaniṣ ad exclaims. And so the grand doctrine “All is Consciousness” is boldly and vigorously affirmed. Those who worship the Mother, worship nothing unconscious but a Supreme Consciousness which is Love, the body of which Love is all forms of consciousness-unconsciousness pro- duced by, and which is, Her as Śiva’s Power. In short, Śam ̣ kara says that there is unconsciousness which appears to be conscious through Cidabhāsa. Śākta doctrine says Consciousness appears to be unconsciousness or more truly to have an element of unconsoiousness in it (for nothing even empirically is absolutely unconscious) owing to the veiling play of Consciousness itself as Māyā-Śakti. The result is in the end the same—“All is Consciousness”— but the method by which this conclusion is attained and the presentment of the matter is reversed. This presentment again is in conformity with soienti- fic research which has shown that even so-called “brute matter” exhibits the elements of that sentiency which, when evolved in man, is the full self-consoiousness. It has been well said that sentiency is an integrant cons- tituent of all existence, physical as well as metaphysical, and its manifestation can be traced throughout the mineral and chemical as well as the vegetable and animal worlds. It essentially comprises the functions of relation to environ- ment, response to stimuli and atomic memory in the lower or inorganic plane, whilst in the higher or organic plane it includes all the psychic functions such as conscious- ness, perception, thought, reason, .volition and individual memory. Throughout it is the one Mother who works, now veiling Her Bliss in inorganic matter, now more fully THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 140 revealing Herself by gradual stages as the vitivity (which She is) displays itself in the evolving forms of worldly life, As Haeckel says, sentiency, is, like movement, found in all matter. To reach this conclusion we must assume (as the Śiva-Śākta schools do) that Kriyā and Icchā, its preli- minary, are functions of Consciousness. Abhinava-Gupta in his Commentary on the Pratyabhijñā-Kārikā says, “The characteristic of action is the manifestation of all objects. These objects again characterised by consciousness-uncons- ciousness are in the nature of a shining forth (Abhāsa).” The universe is thus described as a “going forth” (Prasara) of Śiva. The ultimate reality is Saccidānanda which, as the source of appearances, is called Śakti. The latter in its Sat (Being) aspect is omnipresent-indestructible (eternal) Source and Basis both of the Cosmic Breath or Prāṇ a as also of all vital phenomena displayed as the individual Prāṇ a in separate and concrete bodies. Śakti is Life which, in its phenomenal sense as manifested in individual bodies, issues from, and rests upon, and at basis is, Sat. In this aspect manifested Śakti is vitality which is the one fixed unalterable potential in the universe of which all other forms of energy are particular effects. Life is the phenomenal aspect of Spirit in which, as its Cause, it is at the great dissolution merged. There is no absolute end of life but only to certain structures of life. As it had no end it has no absolute beginning. It appears only in creation from the depths of Being which is its unmanifest- ed ground. The search for the “origin of life” is futile; for it issues from Brahman who, in a supreme sense, is Infinite Life. Life is throughout the Universe. Every atom of dust is quivering with it, as are the most sensitive organic structures. In the latter ease it is obvious; in the former it is not so, but is yet traced. The existence and MĀYĀ-TATTVA 141 functions of life cannot be explained on exclusively mechan- ical principles. What is called mechanical energy is the effect and not the cause of vitality or vitivity or Śakti as the Mother of all. The purpose of evolution is to take up the living potential from some lower grade, develop it and hand it over to a higher grade of forms. Śakti as Cidānanda is, as Icchā-Śakti, the source of all forms of will-power and, in matter, of mechanical energy; and as Jñāna-Śakti, of all forms of mentality and feeling, and as Kriyā, of all forms of activity (Kartṛ tva), being in itself all-mighty. The ultimate changeless Reality, in its aspect as Śakti, veils and contracts in various degrees its power of will, knowledge and action. This veiling, negation, limita- tion or contraction is seen at its fullest in so-called “dead inert brute” matter. This allegation of lifeless inertia is however the result of superficial observation. It is true that in gross matter (Bhūta) the light of consciousness is turned down to its utmost. It is nowhere however even empiri- cally extinguished. Cit is faintly manifested by scientific experiment in gross matter; more clearly in the micro- organisms between such matter and the vegetable world, in which, as in the animal world evolved from it, vitality is so obvious that we have been wont to call these alone “alive.” Śākta doctrine starts with the Full (Pūrṇ a) and deals with the creation of things as a cutting down thereof. From a scientific point of view we may commence with the world as it is, taking inorganic matter as the starting point. From such a standpoint we may speak (See “Veda’s vital molecule” and “Notes on the radical vitality of all concrete matter” by G. Dubern) of a Radical Vital Potential in all matter, universal, omnipresent, indestructible, all- powerful; the source as will-power of mechanical energy, and as rudimentary sentiency of all mentality. From the THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 142 Śāstric standpoint the process is one of veiling and unveil- ing. Śakti veils itself down to and in Pṛ thivī-Tattva of gross matter (Bhūta); and thereafter gradually unveils Herself up to and in man who in Samādhi realises his Svarūpa as pure, unveiled, Consciousness. This veiling by Śakti takes place first in Śiva-Śakti- Tattva by the complete negation of the “Idam ̣ ” of experi- ence; and then through the action of the “Idam ̣ ” on the subjective aspect of the consciousness of the pure creation, in which subject and object exist as part of the One Self; and then through that form of Śakti which is Māyā which effects a severance of subject and object which are then experienced no longer as part of the one Self but as separate. The point of junction between Pure and Impure experience is the Tattva variously called Vidyā Sad-vidyā, or Śuddha- vidyā, the first truly realistic stage of the Yogī. Because it is in the intermediate state, it is called Parāpara-dasā (Is. Prat. 111, 1-5) and, as the Svacchanda-Tantra (IV, 95) says, the “Experience in the form of Mantra of both difference and non-difference.” After this Tattva, Māyā intervenes. In the Tattva-Sam ̣ doha (v. 5) it is said, “Māyā is the sense of difference (Bheda-buddhi) in all Jīvas which are parts of Her. Just as the shore holds in the sea, so She ever obstructs the manifestation (Vibhava) of Ātmā which but for Her is otherwise unobstructed.” Māyā vibheda-buddhir nijām ̣ śa-jāteṣ u nikhilajīveṣ u Nityam ̣ tasya nirankuśa- vibhavam ̣ veleve vāridhe rundhe. So also in the Īśvara-Pratyabhijñā it is said, “That which is nothing but the notion of difference (Bheda-dhī) in things entertained by the Doer (Kartā), though in MĀYĀ-TATTVA 143 Himself of the nature of consciousness, is Māyā-Śakti, whom others, as in the case of Vidyeśvaras, call Vidyā.” Bhedadhīr eva bhāve ṣ a kartur bodhātmano’ pi yā. Māyā śaktyeva sā vidyetyanye vidyeśvarā yathā. (III, ii, 6) “She is Vidya-Śakti when She reveals in the Payu state of the Ātmā whose true nature is Lordship (Ai- śvarya), but when She veils (Tirodhānakarī) then She is called Māyā.” Tasyaiśvaryasvabhāvasya paśu-bhāve prakāśikā. Vidyā-śaktis tirodhānakarī māyābhidhā punah. (ib. 7) Śiva has two functions namely Tirodhāna, that by which He veils Himself to His worshipper, and Anugraha whereby He, through His grace, reveaIs Himself by the “descent of Śakti” or grace (Śaktipāta). She is both Madhumatī “Honey” and Māyā (Lalitā-sahasranāma, v. 139). She is that saving (Tāraka) knowledge by which the ocean of the Sam ̣ sāra is crosaed. The Citkalā or Am ̣ śa of the great Consciousness enveIoped by mind and matter is the Śakti which, as the Padma-Purāṇ a says resides as the core of the “inner working” of all Jīvas and the Ānandakalikā or Germ of Bliss therein; She again as the Lalitāsahasranāma says (v. 142) is basis of the false (in the sense of impermanent) universe (Mithyā jagada- dhiṣ ṭ hānā) created by, and which is Her Māyā, the power of the Lord (Sāndilya-Sūtra, 86) which obscures and which, as the Śakta Devī-Purāna says, is called Māyā, because it is the marvellous instrument whereby unheard of results are produced like those of dreams or Magic. She is in all systems, whether as Prakṛ ti, Māyā or Māyā- śakti, the finitising principle whereby forms are created in the formless Consciousness. This She effects by causing that duality of feeling of the self and not-self in the grand experience which is Mahāsattā. Under Her influence the THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 144 Self experiences Itself as object in all the forms of the universe, which when completed is objectively seen as an evolution from Prakṛ ti-Tattva, that state of Śakti which is evolved by the action of Māyā and the five Kañcukas developed from Her. These are specific aspects of the great general limiting Power (Śakti) which Māyā is. With this Prakṛ ti is associated Puruṣ a-Tattva, the two combined being Ham ̣ sa. Puruṣ a-Tattva is Ātmā enveloped by the Kañcukas derived from Māyā and specific of its operation. Śakti as Prakṛ ti, subject to the influence of the Kañcukas, develops on the dis-equilibrium of Her Guṇ as from Her- self, as Virkṛ tis, the impure Tattvas (Aśuddha-Tattva) extending to Pṛ thivi. At this point conscious vital energy materialises, forming, what has been called by the author cited “the crust of the vital molecule” of all forms of solid matter. Subjectively therefore the Māyā process is the establishment of a dichotomy of subject and object in what would otherwise be an unitary experience; and objectively it is the creation of the various psychical and physical forms into which the Universal Substance projects; becoming in the course of such emanation more and more gross. Bindu as the Mantra designation of Īśvara-Tattva is Ghani- bhūta; that is, the first Ghanāvasthā aspect of Śakti be- coming (through Māyā) Prakṛ ti-Tattva and its evolutes which are more and more gross (Sthūla); until passing the first four states of decreasing subtlety of matter, Substance emerges as the solid atoms of matter of which the physical universe is composed. These compounds being the subject of the senses are the materials of physical science which seeks to work the process backwards. At a point, search on the path of objectivity is closed. If it would know more, the mind must turn in on itself and release itself from all objectivity which Māyā is and fall back into that ground of Consciousness (Māyātita) whence it has MĀYĀ-TATTVA 145 emerged. From the Mantra aspect dealing with the origin of language the undifferentiated Śabda which arises on the differentiation of the Bindu into Puruṣ a-Prakṛ ti or Ham ̣ sa develops, with the creation of mind and matter, into the manifested Śabda and Artha which are the Varṇ as or letters (springing from the subtle Mātṛ kās) expressed in Vaikharī speech made up of letters (Varṇ a) syllables (Pada) and sentences (Vākya or the uttered Mantra). Mantra again is the thought (Man) which saves (Trā, Trayate): Saves from what? From firstly the evil which man, subject to Māyā, commits; and then, by the thorough purification of the mind (Citta-śuddhi), from Māyā Herself who is trans- formed in the Sādhaka into Vidyā-Śakti. Mantra is thus here a pure thought-form; a pure Vṛ tti or modification of the Antahkaraṇ a which is Devatā. The senses and mind are also Devatās being operations of the one Divine Śakti. Through Mantra the mind is divinely transformed. Con- templating, filled by, and identified with, Divinity in Mantra form, which is a Sthūla (gross) aspect of Devī, it passes into Her subtle (Sūkṣ ma) Light form (Jyotirmayī Devī) which is the Consciousness beyond the world of Māyik forms; the Īśvara and Īśvarī who as Śabda- brahman are the source of, and appear as, that Māyā which is the Creatrix both of the objective world of Mind and Matter and of the manifested Śabda and Artha; the Word and its Meaning derived from the Mother in Her aspect as Supreme Nāda (Para-nāda) and Supreme Speech (Parā-vāk). CHAPTER XV THE KAÑCUKAS THE six Kañcukas including Māyā which may be regarded as the root of the other five are Kāla, Niyatī, Rāga, Vidya, Kalā. The term Kañcuka means sheath or envelope. The same Tattvas are also called contractions (Sam ̣ koca), for creation is the contracted (Sam ̣ kucadrūpā) form of infinite Śakti. It is to be observed that Māyā, Niyati and Kāla, occupty in the philosophy of the Pāñcarātra-Āgama the very place which is held in the Śiva-Śākta systems by the Kañcukas (See as to this Dr. Otto Scharder’s Ahirbudhyna- Samhitā 63, 64, 90). The author cited opines that the six Kañcukas are only an elaboration of the older doctrine of the three powers of limitation (Sam ̣ koca) of the Pāñca- rātra which are Māyā, Kāla, Niyata. The same idea is expressed by these two terms, namely limitations by which the Ātmā, in its form as the finite experience, is deprived of the specifice attributes which It, as the Perfect Experi- ence, possessed. Consciousness reaching forth to the World of enjoyment becomes subject to the Kañcukas and thus becomes the impure, finite worldly experience where sub- ject and object are completely different; which experience is, as it were, the inversion by the contraction and negation of Śakti of the perfect Experience from whose Śiva-Śakti- Tattva aspect it proceeds. Infinite Consciousness whilst still transcendentally retaining its Svarūpa is, as Śakti, THE KAÑCUKAS 147 narrowed to the degree which constitutes our experience on the material plane. The process may be represented in Diagram by an inverted triangle representing the Yoni or Śakti, in the form of the Pure Tattvas, resting on the point of an upright triangle. The point of inter- section is Māyā from which proceeds the second triangle representing the impure Tattvas, which constitute world- ly experience. Seen in the waters of Māyā all is reversed. Through the operation of Māyā and the Kañcukas, Śakti assumes the gross contracted form of Prakṛ ti-Tattva which in association with Puruṣ a-Tattva is Ham ̣ sa. Śiva and akti are the Bird Hamsa. Ham ̣ sa is both male (Pum ̣ or Puruṣ a) and female (Prakṛ ti). Ham ̣ is Śiva and Sah is Śakti. This Ham ̣ sa-dvandva are in their gross form the universe (Pum ̣ -prakṛ tyātmako ham ̣ sas tadātmakam idam ̣ jagat). Puruṣ a is the Ātmā enveloped by the Kañcukas which are the contractions of Consciousness and Its Powers. Māyā is the root and cause of all limitations of the powers (Vibhava) of consciousness (Ātmā); for Māyā is the sense of difference (Bhedabuddhi) between all persons and things. Each Puruṣ a, (and they are innumerable) being, as the Svacchanda-Tantra says, an universe of his own. Each Puruṣ a creates under Māyā his or its own universe. The Kañcukas are thus the delimitations of the Supreme in Its form as Śakti. It was Eternity (Nityatā) but is now orderly and delimitation (Pariccheda) productive of appear- ance and disappearance (that is life and death). This is the operation of the Time-power or Kāla which is defined as follows in the Tattva-Sam ̣ doha (V, 11) “That Śakti of His which is Eternity (Nityatā) descending and producing appearance and disappearance (birth and death); and which ever in regulated manner performs the function of division or delimitation (Pariccheda) should be regarded as in the form of Kāla-Tattva.” THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 148 Sā nityatāsya śakti nikrsya nidhanodaya-pradānena Niyataparicchedakarīkḷ ptā syāt Kāla-tattva-rūpeṇ a. Kāla is the power which urges on and matures things. It is not in itself subjective or empirical time, though it gives rise to it. It is transcendental Time without sections (Akhaṇ da-Kāla) giving birth to time as effect (Kārya-kāla). This gross time with parts (Sakala-Kāla) only comes in with the creation of the gross Tattvas. So it is said “Time leads me in time” (See Ahirbudhnya 64-67. See also the same Author’s Ueber den stand der Indischen Philosophie zur zeit Mahāvīras und Buddhas 17-30). Consciousness as Śakti is contracted into the mode of temporal thinking. It was freedom and indepen- dence (Svatantrata). This is now contracted and the Puruṣ a is forcibly subjected to guidance and regulation in what he must or must not do in any moment of time. This is Niyati, which is defined in the Tattva-Sam ̣ doha (v. 12) as follows: “That which constitutes that Śakti of His which is oalled Independence or Freedom (Svatan- trata); this same Śakti, and none other, becoming con- tracted and subjecting Him perforce to guidance and regu- lation (Niyamayantī) in a definitely ordered and restricted manner (Niyatam ̣ ) as regards what is to be done or not done (that is, what he must not do at any given moment of time) is Niyati.” Yāsya svatantrākhyā Śaktih sam ̣ kocaśālinī saiva. Kṛ tyākṛ tyeṣ vāsam niyata m ̣ amum nyamayan-tyabhūn Niyatih. Niyati is spoken of in the Pāñcarātra Āgama as the subtle regulator of everything (Sūkṣ ma-sarva-niyāmakah. Ahirbudhnya VI. 46) and is said by Dr. Schrader to include in that system the funotions of the three Śaiva-Śakta Kañcukas, Vidyā, Rāga and Kalā (Ahirbudhnya 64-66). It THE KAÑCUKAS 149 was completely satisfied with Itself for there was then no other. It was the Full (Pūrṇ a) and there was nothing else for it to interest Itself in and thus want. This Śakti, becoming limited, makes the Puruṣ a interested in objects and thus attaches them to enjoyment. This is Rāga which is defined in the Tattva-Sam ̣ doha (v. 10) as follows: “There is another Śakti of His which is eternal complete satisfaction; the same becoming limited and at- taching him ever to enjoyment, this Śakti is reduced to the condition of Rāga-tattva.” Nitya-paripūrṇ atṛ ptih śaktis tasyaiva parimitā nu satī. Bhogeṣ u, rañjayantī satam ̣ amum Rāga-tattvaām yātā. The Brahman is, as the Īśa-Upaniṣ ad says, Pūrṇ a the Full, the All which wants nothing; for there is nothing to the All which It can went. But when the one Experi- ence beoomes dual, and, subject and object are separate, then the self as subject becomes interested in objects that is in things other than itself. Icchā in the sense of desire implies a want of the fullness which is that of the Supreme perfect experience. In the supreme creative sense Icchā is the direction of Consciousnese towards activity. The term Rāga is commonly translated desire. It is how- ever properly that interest in objects which precedes desire. Rāga is thus that interest in objects, seen as other than the self, which ripens into desire (Icchā) for them. Such Icohā is thus a limitation of the all-satisfied fullness of the Supreme. The power of the Supreme was to know or experience all things and so it is Sarvajñatā. This is limited and the Puruṣ a thereby beoomes a “little knower.” This Kañcuka is oalled Vidyā which is defined in the Tattva- Sam ̣ doha (V. 9) as follows: “His power of all-knowingness THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 150 becoming limited and capable of knowing only a few things and producing knowledge (of a limited character) is called Vidyā by the wise of old” Sarvajñatāsya śaktih parimitatanur alpa-vedya-mātraparā. Jñānam utpādayantī Vidyeti nigadyate budhair ādyaih. The supreme is all powerful, mighty to do all things (Sarvakartṛ tā). This power is contracted so that the Puruṣ a can accomplish few things and becomes a “little doer.” This is Kalā which is defined in the Tattva-Sam ̣ doha (v. 8) as follows— “That which was His power of all-doing-ness, the same being contracted and capable of accomplishing but a few things and reducing him to the state of a little doer is called Kalā.” Tat-sarvakartrtā sā sam ̣ kucitā katipayārtha-mātṛ aparā. Kim ̣ cit-kartāram amum kalayantī kīrtyate Kalā namā. Kalā is thus nothing but Kartṛ ttva or infinite activity, agency, and mightiness cut down to the limits of the Jīva’s power; that is lowered to the possibilities of finite action. Thus the Śaktis of the Supreme which are many become contracted. Consciousness thus limited in six- fold manner by its own Śakti is the Puruṣ a associated with Prakṛ ti. Kalā (in its more generic sense) is said in the Śaiva-Tantrasāra (Āhnika 8) to be “the cause of the manifestation of Vidyā and the root when She is operating on that Kartṛ tva which is qualified by the qualifying conditions of littleness; this limited power of agency having been itself the work of Māyā. Now the THE KAÑCUKAS 151 moment that Kalā separates from herself what consti- tutes this qualifying aspect spoken of above as Kim ̣ cit (little) at that very moment there is the creation of the Prakṛ ti Tattva which is in the nature of a generality (Sām ̣ ānya-mātra) unmarked by any specific form of object of enjoyment, such as happiness, sorrow and delusion; and of which another name is the equalisation of the Guṇ as. Thus the creation under the influence of the Kalā-tattva of the limited experiencer (Bhoktṛ ) that is of the Puruṣ a and of the experienced (Bhogya) or Prakṛ ti is quite simultaneous that is without any succession what- ever in the process. Thus being simultaneous they are ever associated.” The eighth Āhnika of the Tantrasāra (the Śaiva and not the Śākta ritual work of Kṛ ṣ ṇ ānanda-Āgamavāgīśa) says: Thus it has been already shown that Kalā is the cause of manifestation of Vidya and the rest (i.e., the other four Kañcukas leaving out Māyā) when She (Kalā) is operating on that agency or doer-ness (Kartṛ tva) which is qualified (Viśeṣ ya) by the qualifying (Viśeṣ aṇ a) condition of littleness; this limited power of agency (Kim ̣ citkartṛ tva as opposed to Sarva-kartṛ tva) having been itself the work of Māyā. Now the moment that Kalā separates from Herself that which constitutes this qualifying aspect (Viśeṣ aṇ a-bhsga) spoken of above as Kim ̣ cit and is an object of knowledge and action, that very moment there is the creation (Sarga) of the Prakṛ ti-Tattva which is of the nature of a generality only (Sāmānya-mātra) un- marked by any specific forms of the enjoyable (Bhogya) such as happiness, sorrow, and delusion (which are there- fore as yet undifferentiated) and of which another name is the equalisation of their Guṇ as (i.e., of Sukha, Duhkha and Moha or of the Guṇ as of Her). Thus the creation under the influence of the Kalā-Tattva of the Enjoyer (Bhoktṛ or THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 152 limited experiencer) and Enjoyable (Bhogya or experienced) is quite simultaneous, that is without any succession whatever in the process and being simultaneous they are conjoined. (Evam ̣ kim ̣ cit kartṛ tvam yan māyākāryam ̣ , tatra kim ̣ cit- tva-viśiṣ tam ̣ yat kartṛ tvam ̣ , viśeṣ yam ̣ tatra vyāpriyamāṇ ā kalā vidyādiprasavacetur iti nirūpitam ̣ . Idānīm ̣ viśeṣ a- ṇ abhāgo yah kim ̣ cid ityukto jñeyah kāryaś ca tam ̣ yāvat sā Kalā svātmanah prithah kurute tāvad eṣ a eva sukha- dukha-mohātmaka-bhogyaviśeṣ ānusyūtasya sāmānya-mā- trasya tad-guṇ a-sāmyā-para-nāmnah prakṛ ti-tattvasya sar- gah—iti bhoktṛ bhogya-yugalasya samam eva kalā-tattvā- yattā sṛ ṣ tih.) Again in the Tantrāloka (Āhnika 9) it is said “So far it has been shown how Agency (Kartṛ tva) which is always accompanied by the power to enjoy (Bhoktṛ tva) is (to be found) in that qualified aspect (that is Kartṛ tva) of the Tattva called Kalā which (aspect) is characterised by a limited agency (little-doerness).” Here may be interposed a note of explanation: Kartṛ tva is creative activity, ideation and formation as contrasted with a merely induced and passively accepted experience which is Jñātṛ tva. Kartṛ tva is the power of modifying the Idam ̣ . The Sām ̣ khyas say that the Puruṣ a is Bhoktā but not Kartā. But the Śaiva-Śāktas hold that there is no Kartṛ tva without Bhoktṛ tva. In Parā-sam ̣ vit there is the potential germ of (1) Jñātṛ tva, (2) Bhoktṛ tva, (3) Kartṛ tva held in undistinguishable unity. In Śiva-Śakti- Tattva the first exists and the second and third are, through Śakti, suppressed. In Sadākhya there are the first and the incipiency of the second and third; and in Īśvara-Tattva all three are developed but as yet undiffe- rentiated. The Īśvara consciousness directed to the “Idam ̣ ” produces equality of attention on “Aham ̣ ” and THE KAÑCUKAS 153 “Idam ̣ ” which is Sadvidyā-Tattva whence arise Māyā and the Kañcukas evolving Puruṣ a-Prakṛ ti. Pasa-sam ̣ vit is the pure changeless aspect of Cit. Īśvara is the fully risen creative consciousness wherein is the undifferentiated Śakti which functions as Icchā, Jñāa, Kriyā, Jñātṛ tva or Jñāna. Śakti in Īśvara does not involve limited modifi- cation, for the whole universe as the Self is present to the Self. But in Puruṣ a there is such modification; the Jñātṛ tva functioning through Buddhi, the Vṛ ttis of which are expressions of the changing, limited, and partial charac- teristics of the knowledge had through this instrument and its derivatives. The citation continues, “But in what constitutes there- in the part ‘Kim ̣ cit’ as a qualifying aspect, Kalā gives birth to the Pradhāna which arises from that (Kim ̣ cit as- pect) as a clear but general objectivity which is separate or distinct from (the Puruṣ a),” Evam ̣ kalākhya-tattvasya kim ̣ cit kartṛ tva-lakṣ aṇ e. Viśeṣ yabhāge kartṛ tva m ̣ bhoktṛ -pūrvakam ̣ Viśeṣ anatayā yo’tra kim ̣ cit bhāgas-tadūhitam ̣ . Vedyamātra m ̣ sphuta m ̣ bhinna m ̣ pradhāna m ̣ sūyate kalā. That is Kartṛ tva is that aspect of Kalā which is characterised by Kim ̣ cit-Kartṛ tva. From the qualifying (Viśeṣ aṇ a, that is, Kim ̣ cit) aspect Kalā produces Prakṛ ti which is distinct from Kalā as Puruṣ a, which Prakṛ ti exists as a mere general objectivity which becomes parti- cular when owing to disequilibrium in tbe Gunas the Vikṛ tis are produced. Again it is said (ibid.): “Kalā produces the Bhogya (Prakṛ ti) and the Bhoktā (Puruṣ a) simultaneously by the notion of, or by seeking for, a distinction (that is by seeking to establish a difference between the two aspects in Herself, namely, Kartṛ tva and Kim ̣ cit; by working THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 154 on Kartṛ tva alone,) (yet), the Bhoktā and Bhogya are in- separate from one another. And because what is thus the barest objectivity (Sam ̣ vedya-mātra) is known (or ex- perienced) later as (or in the form of) happiness (Sukha) Sorrow (Duhkha) and delusion (Vimoha) it is therefore called the equalisation of these (three) in the beginning.” (Samameva hi bhogyam ̣ ca bhoktāram ̣ ca prasūyate kalā bhedābhisam ̣ dhānād aviyuktam ̣ parasparam ̣ . Evam ̣ sam- vedyamātram ̣ yat sukhaduhkha-vimohatah, bhotsyate yat tatah proktam ̣ tatsāmyātmakam ̣ āditah). When Māyā-Śakti first severs the “Aham ̣ ” and “Idam ̣ ” this latter is still experienced as an unlimited whole. The next step is that in which the whole is limited and broken up into parts, for our experience is not of an all-pervading homogeneous whole but of a heterogeneous universe. Kalā, as a development of Māyā-Śakti, belittles the Puruṣ a’s hitherto unlimited Agency which thus be- comes Kim ̣ cit-Kartṛ tva. Agency which exists both as to the Knowable (Jñeya) and object of action (Kārya) has two aspects, namely the qualified power of action (Viśeṣ ya- Kartṛ tva) on the part of the Puruṣ a and the object or “little” in respect of which Kartṛ tva operates, namely the “little” or universe (Kim ̣ cit or Viśeṣ ya) which is the “Idam ̣ ” as viewed by Puruṣ a after the operation of Kalā Śakti. Kalā operates on agency (Kartṛ tva) and not on the “this” which is by such operation necessarily Kim ̣ cit. For if the power and experience of the Self is limited, the object is experienced as limited; for the object is nothing but the Self as object. In other words the production of Puruṣ a is a positive operation of Kalā whereas the produc- tion of Prakṛ ti is a negative operation due to the limitation of the Puruṣ a which, as so limited, experiences the uni- verse as Kim ̣ cit. Prakṛ ti is thus nothing but the object of Kartṛ tva as it exists when the latter has been whittled THE KAÑCUKAS 155 down by Kalā. Puruṣ a and Prakṛ ti thus both emerge as the result of the action by Kalā on the Puruṣ a. For this reason Puruṣ a and Prakṛ ti are simultaneously produced and are also inseparable. The following chapters deal with Puruṣ a, and Prakṛ ti or Ham ̣ sa; the Kāmakalā or three Bindus arising on the differentiation of the Para-bindu which dfirentiation wit- nesses the birth of the Hamsa; and then with the creation of the impure Tattvas (Aśuddha-Tattva) from Prakṛ ti and the Varṇ amālā or the Garland or Rosary of Letters the evolution of which denotes the origin of speech and of Mantra. CHAPTER XVI HAM ̣ SA HAM ̣ SA is Purusa-Prakrti-Tattva. Ham ̣ is “Male” or Śiva; Sah is “Female” and Śakti. Śiva-Śakti are therefore Ham ̣ sa which combined mean the “Bird” Ham ̣ sa, the material shape of which is variously said to be that of the goose, flamingo, brāhminī duck and rightly by others to be legendary. The universe is made of, and informed by the Ham ̣ sa Pair (Ham ̣ sa-dvandva) who are Puruṣ a and Pra- kṛ ti and in all the latter’s varied forms (Pum ̣ prakṛ tyātmako ham ̣ sas tadātmakam idam ̣ jagat). Of these the Ānanda- laharī says (39) “In Thy Anāhata Lotus I salute the Wondrous Pair who are Ham ̣ and Sah, swimming in the mind of the Great who ever delight in the honey of the blooming lotus of knowledge.” That is, they manifest in the mind of the Great delighting in the honey of Conscious- ness. This Ham ̣ sah reversed is the Vedāntic “So’ham ̣ ” of which the Sammohana-Tantra (Ch. VIII) says “Hakāra is one wing. Sakāra is the other. When stripped of both wings then Tāra is Kāmakalā.” Jīva is Ham ̣ sa. The same Tantra says that the Sādhaka of Tārā is the Lord of both Kādi and Hādi Mata. The Hamsatārā-Mahāvidyā is the sovereign mistress of Yoga whom the Kādis call Kalī, the Hādis Śrīsundarī and the Ka-Hādis Ham ̣ sah. The Jñānārnva-Tantra (xxi-22) speaking of the Cit- kuṇ ḍ a as the Manḍ ala in the Mūlādhāra where Homa is done, defines as follows the four Ātmās, viz, Paramātmā, Antar- ātmā, Jñānātmā and Ātmā which forms the Cit-kuṇ ḍ a and by HAM ̣ SA 157 the knowledge whereof there is no rebirth. Ātmā is Prāṇ a- rūpī that is the Ātmā which is in all beings as their Prāṇ a. It is Ham ̣ sa-Svarūpī or Jīvātmā manifested by outer and inner breating (Śvāsa, Ucchvāsa). It is compared to the ether in a pot, which the potter’s wheel separates from the surrounding Ākāśa but from which there is no distinc- tion when the pot is broken. The individual breath is the Cosmic Breath from which it seems to be different by the forms which the latter vitalises. Jñānātmā is Sākṣ āt-sākṣ i- rūpaka. It is that which witnesses all and by which the unity of all is known. It is reflected in Buddhi and the rest, and yet in its own form distinguishable therefrom, just as the rays of the moon are reflected on water and seem to be, and yet are not, one with it. It is thus the substratum of Bhuddhi and of all the subjective or mental Tattvas derivable therefrom. By “Antar” in the term Antarātmā is meant the subtle (Rahasya-sūkṣ marūpaka) Ātmā which pervades all things; the spark of Paramātmā which indwells all bodies (Antargata). It is the Ham ̣ sa, known only by Yogīs. Its beak is Tāra (Praṇ ava or “Om ̣ ” Mantra). Nigama and Āgama are its two wings. Śiva and Śakti its two feet. The three Bindus are its three eyes. This is the Paramaham ̣ sa; that is Ham ̣ sa in its supreme aspect as the Consciousness-ground of the manifested Ham ̣ sa or Jīva. When this Parama-ham ̣ sa is spread (Vyāpta), that is, displayed, then all forms of matter (Bhūta), viz., Ākāśa, Pavana and the rest spring up in their order. Of these five the root is Citta. This Ham ̣ sa disports itself in the World-lotus sprung from the Mud of Delusion (Mohapan ̣ ka) in the Lake of Ignorance (Avidyā). When this Ham ̣ sa becomes unworldly (Nispra- pañca) and in dissolving form (Sam ̣ hārarūpī) then it makes visible the Ātmā or Self (Ātmānam ̣ pradarśayet). Then its “Birdness” (Pakṣ itva) disappears and the THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 158 So’ham Ātmā is established. “Know this” says the Jñānārṇ ava “to be the Paramātmā.” Puruṣ a is Ātmā subject to Māyā-Śakti and the other limiting Śaktis called the Kañcukas. Prakṛ ti is that state of Śakti which arises as the result of the collec- tive operation of Māyā and the Kañcukas; a transforma- tion of Sakti existing as a homogeneity and general objectivity which develops of its own power, which is the summation of the Śaktis producing it, into the hetero- geneous universe. The Puruṣ a-Prakṛ ti-Tattvas arise as a bifurcation in Consciousness on the differentiation of the Para-bindu into the three Bindus which form the Kāmakalā which again may be pictured as the triangular base of the pyramidal (Śṛ m ̣ gātaka) figure in the Śri- yantra at whose apex is the Baindava-Cakra and Para- bindu. The three Bindus represent the Śiva aspect and the Śakti aspect of the one Consciousness, and the third the mutual relation or Śiva-Śakti aspect of the two. From this differentiation arises in the Mantra line of creation Para-śabda and manifested Śabda and Artha; in the Tattva line Buddhi and the rest; and in the line of the Lords of the Tattvas (Tattveśa) Śam ̣ bhu and the rest. In its most general and philosophical sense Puruṣ a- Prakṛ ti represent that stage in the evolving Consciousness (Śakti) in which, after passing from the mere I-experience (Aham ̣ pratyaya-vimarśa), and the “I-this” or “Aham ̣ - Idam ̣ ,” experience, in which the object or Idam ̣ is still experienced as part of the self (the completed type of such experiencer being Īśvara), Consciousness emerges as the experience of duality in which the object is seen as outside of, and separate from, the self. This however is a state of mere general objectivity. The final state has yet to be described when undifferentiated objectivity and supreme Sound (Paraśabda) evolve, the first into the differentiated HAM ̣ SA 159 objects of the universe (Aśuddha-Tattva) and the second into the differentiated word (Śabda) and its meaning (Artha) which is the birth of Mantra consisting of letters (Varṇ a), syllables (Pada) and sentences (Vākya). With the differen- tiation of Prakṛ ti appear multitudinous Puruṣ as of vary- ing experience, each living in a universe of its own. Puruṣ a is not merely confined to man but is appli- cable to every Jīva who is the Enjoyer (Bhoktā) or Puruṣ a of the enjoyable (Bhogya) or Prakṛ ti. Puruṣ a again is not limited to the organic life of animals and pIants or the micro-organisms which hover between organic and inorganic matter. The term includes the latter also. For whatever may be the popular signification of the term Jīva as living organic bodies, in its philosophical sense all is Jīvātmā which is not Paramātmā. And in this, modern science bears out the notions here described. The former arbitrary partitions made between the living and non-living are being broken down. We may for practical purposes call that “living” which obviously displays certain characteristics which we call “life” such as the so-called vital phenomena manifested by plants, animals and men. But the life and consciousness displayed in organic bodies is not something wholly new which had no place in the inorganic material of which they are composed. All such vital phenomena exist in subdued or potential form in every kind of matter which contains the potentiality of all life. Life as we know it is the phenomenal aspect of Being-Itself (Sat). Feeling-Consciousness as we know it is the limited mani- festation (manifestation being limitation) of the un- differentiated Feeling-Coneoiousness which is Cit, Sat and Ananda. All which is manifested exists potentially in its ground. Each of such manifestations is such ground (Bhūimi) veiled in varying degrees; now more, now less fully displaying the nature of Spirit, the source THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 160 of all life, feeling, will, and consciousness. Superficial notions based on appearances have given rise to the notion of “dead” matter. But science has given new instruments for, and extended the range of our observation and has shown that life and consciousness, though in a subdued or veiled form, exist throughout the universe. Vedānta in its Śākta version says that all forms are the operation of Consciousness as Māyā-Śakti. As the ancient Upaniṣ ad says and modern so-called”New thought” repeats “What one thinks that one becomes.” All recognise this principle to a certain point. If man thinks inhuman thoughts he dehumanises himself. Vedānta carries the application of this principle to its logical con- clusion and affirms that not only does thought operate modifications in and within the limits of particular types or species, but actually evolves such and all other types through the cosmic or collective Thought of which the universe is a material expression. Thus every unit or atom of matter is a Puruṣ a identifying itself with the solid (Pārthiva) “crust” of matter, which is the gross expression on the sensual plane of more subtle forces emanating from that Ground Substance, which is the source both of the experiencing subject and the object experi- enced. If the operation of gross matter gives the appear- ance of rigid mechanism, this does not imply that such operation is wholly unconscious and lifeless, but that life and consciousness are veiled by the Tamas Guṇ a of Prakṛ ti in which Kalā, Niyati and other Kañcukas are operating to their fullest extent. But however intense may be their operation, life and consciousness oan never be destroyed, for being Śakti Herself they are indestructible. Thus every molecule of mineral substance is a Pumsa or Con- sciousness identifying itself with matter in its solid and apparently unconscious inert state. For Consciousness HAM ̣ SA 161 becomes that with which it identifies itself. When it com- pletely identifies itself with mineral matter it becomes that matter. What we think that we become. Nothing how- ever is absolutely unconscious or inert. Every single atom in the universe is in constant movement and hence the world is called Jagat or that which moves. This scientific doctrine is in India an ancient inheritance. And so the Mantra runs “Hrīm ̣ . The Supreme Ham ̣ sa dwells in the brilliant Heaven.” The word Ham ̣ sa is here said to be derived from the word Hanti which means Gati or motion. Sāyaṇ a says that it is called Aditya, because it is in perpetual motion. The Tattva-Sam ̣ doha (vv. 13, 14) says: “She is considered to be Prakṛ ti who is the collectivity of all the Śaktis, (Will, Knowledge and Action) who is the peaceful, that is, quiescent (Śāntā) Śakti of Him in contracted form (Sam ̣ kucadrupā); who is in the form of the equilibrium of Sattva, Rajas and Tamas Guṇ as which again are Will, Knowledge and Action gathered together (Sa m ̣ kalita); who is in the nature of general unparticularised feeling (Citta) which is in the form of the undifferen- tiated Buddhi (and other Tattvas).” Icchādi-tri-samaṣ tih śaktih śāntā’syā sa m ̣ kucadrūpā. Sa m ̣ kalitechādyātmaka- sattvādika-sāmya-rūpiṇ ī saiva. Buddhyādi-sāmarasya- svarūpacittātmikā matāprakṛ tih. “Ham ̣ ” or the male (Pum ̣ ān) or Puruṣ a is again in the same work (v. 6) described as: “He who having by Her become of limited form with all His powers contracted is this Male (Pum ̣ ān or Puruṣ a) like the sun which becoming red at eventide and His Power (of shining) contracted can scarce reveal Himself (by shin- ing abroad).” THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 162 Sa tayā parimitamūrtih sam ̣ kucita-samastaśaktir eṣ ah pumān. Raviriva sam ̣ dhyā-raktah samhṛ ta-śaktih svabhāsane’py apatuh. Again in the same work (v. 7) it is said: “His Śaktis are many consisting of complete Kar- tṛ tva (power of action) and others, but on His becoming contracted (that is, limited) they also become contracted in the forms of Kalā and the rest and make him thus manifest (as Puruṣ a).” Sam ̣ pūrṇ a-kartṛ tvādyā bahvyah santyasya śaktayas tasya. Sam ̣ kocāt sam ̣ kucitāh kalādirūpeṇ a rūdhayanty evam. Again in the Īśvara-Pratyabhijñā it is said: “He who is Experiencer commencing with Śūnya (Śivatattva) and the rest, He being clothed by the five Kañcukas, Kāla and the rest, and becoming object to Him- self, is then the Experiencer of objects as separate from Him.” Yaś ca pramātā śūnyādih prameye vyatirekim ̣ Mātā as meyah san kālādika-pañcaka-veṣ titah. (III-ii 9) That is, object is the Self appearing as such. He retains His own Self-hood and becomes at the same time the object of His own experience. Māyā is not something apart from Brahman, for it is Brahman who through Māyā, an aspect of Brahman, Himself becomes His own object. In the first act of creation He commences to become His own object, but it is only when the subject as Purusa is clothed, that is limited, by the Kañcukas, that the latter sees objects as other than and outside HAM ̣ SA 163 Himself. At this stage duality is established and exfoliates in the Vikṛ tis of Prakṛ tis as the multiple experience of the World of Mind and Matter. The Guṇ as of Prakṛ ti are inadequately translated as “qualities”, because the latter word involves some Sub- stance of which they are the qualities. But Prakṛ ti Śakti is, as Prakṛ ti, the Guṇ as and nothing else, though Her Svarūpa, as that of all Śaktis, is Sat-Cit-Ānanda. The Guṇ as Sattva, Rajas, Tamas are properly factors or con- stituents of Prakṛ ti. Of these it is commonly said that Tamas Guṇ a is the veiling prinoiple of Prakṛ ti. This is so. But nevertheless it is to be remembered that all the factors of Prakṛ ti in one way or another veil; the difference being that whereas Sattva to some degree veils (for Sattva- guṇ a is not as such the same as absolute Sat) it is in its highest degree of potenoy, that is, predominance, the least degree of veiling, and therefore it represents the tendency to unveil, that is, to reveal and manifest Being (Sat) and Consciousness (Cit); whereas Tamas is in its highest potency the greatest degree of veiling and therefore speci- fically represents the tendency to veil. Rajas is the opera- tive power in both cases. In all bodies there are the three Guṇ as (for these cannot separately exist though one or other may predominate), and it is because of this and there- fore of the presence of Sattva-Guṇ a in organic matter that it exhibits the rudiments of sentiency and conscious- ness. But in inorganic matter Tamas Guṇ a prevails. As bodies evolve, the strength of the operation of Tamas gradu- ally diminishes and that of Sattva increases until in man it becomes predominant. The whole object of Sādhana is to increase Sattva-Guṇ a until, on man becoming wholly Sāt- tvika, his body passes from the state of predominant Sattva- Guṇ a into Sat Itself. These Guṇ as represent in the Jīva or Paśu the Icchā, Kriyā, Jñāna and Māyā-Śaktis of THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 164 the Lord. As regards Māyā, the Lord (Māyin), as the Kulārṇ ava-Tantra says, wields and controls and is free of it; Jīva is controlled by it. So the Īśvara-Pratyabijñā (IV, 1, 4) says, “What are Jñāna and Kriyā (on the part) of the Lord (Pati) in all beings and things (Bhāveṣ u) which (to Him) are really of the nature of His own body (or limbs)—it is these two (that is Jñāna and Kriyā) and nothing else (eva) which together with Māyā the third are the Sattva, Rajas, and Tamas (Guṇ as in respect) of the Paśu.” Svān ̣ ga-rūpeṣ u bhāveṣ u patyurjñānam ̣ kriyā ca yā. Māyā tṛ tīyā tā eva paśoh sattva m ̣ rajas tamah. Śiva-śakti has a threefold aspect as Icchā, Jñāna, Kriyā, which are inseparably assooiated, just as the Guṇ as are, though, as in the latter case, one or other may be predominant. Of these again Icchā and Kriyā may be considered together; for as resolve is directed to action it is the preliminary of it. Icchā in the Śaiva-Śāstra is described as state of wonder (Sa camatkārā Icchā- śaktih) in the Puruṣ a. But Kriyā considered (for the purpose of analysis only) as apart from Jñāna is blind. For this reason Kriyā has been associated with Tamas. It is very clearly explained by Kṣ emarāja in his Tattva- Sandoha (vv. 13-15), that Icchā or resolve to action becomes at a lower stage Rajas Guṇ a, the principle of activity in Prakṛ ti; Jñāna becomes Sattva or the principle of manifestation in the same; and Kriyā becomes Tamas Guṇ a or the specific veiling principle of the same form of Śakti. He says, “His Will (Icchā) assumed the form of Rajas and became Aham ̣ kara which produces the notion of ‘I’ (Aham ̣ ). His knowledge (Jñāna) likewise became Sattvarūpa and Buddhi which is the determining form of experience. His Kriyā being in the nature of Tamas and productive of Vikalpa (and Sam ̣ kalpa), i.e., rejection (and HAM ̣ SA 165 selection) is called Manas” (Icchāsya rajo-rūpāham ̣ kṛ ti- rāsīd aham ̣ -pratīkikarī jñānāpi sattvarūpā nirṇ ayabodhasya kāraṇ am ̣ buddhih, Tasya kriyā tamomaya-mūrtir mana ucyate vikalpakarī.) The evolution of these Tattvas (Aśuddha) is the subject of a future chapter. But before dealing with these it is necessary, in the creative order, to further describe the Kāmakalā in which the Ham ̣ sa arises and the Rosary or Garland of letters (Varṇ amālā) which is the Mantra aspect of the Tāttvika evolution will come later. CHAPTER XVII KĀMAKALĀ IN the previous chapters it has been shown that the Para- bindu or Īśvara Tattva assumes in creation a threefold aspect as the three Bindus,—Bindu (Kārya), Nāda, Bīja. These three Points constitute symbolically a Triangle which is known as the Kāmakalā. Kāma is of course not here used in the gross sense of desire, sexual or otherwise, but of Icchā, the Divine creative Will towards the life of form, which is here explicated from Bindu, the aspect previously assumed by Śakti through Nāda (Bindutām ̣ abhyeti). The undivided supreme Cit-śakti (Akhaṇ da-paracicchakti) be- coming desirous of appearing as all the Tattvas (Samas- ta-tattvabhāvena vivarttecchāsamanvitā) assumes the Bindu aspect (Bindhubhāng paryeti) characterised by a pre- dominance of activity (Krīyā-prādhānya-lakṣ an ̣ ā). Here it may be observed that Icchā or Will is a form of Kriyā (action): in the sense that it is the preliminary to action and sets the Self in motion. Śakti passes from potency through Will to action, which through Para Bindu mani- ests. Bindu-bhāva is that state (Īśvara-tattva) in which it s fully equipped to work and does so. Its threefold aspect as it works are Bindu Śivātmaka, Bīja Śaktyātmaka and Nāda. Nāda is Sam ̣ avāya that is relationship or connection (Sam ̣ bandha) as exciter (Kṣ obhaka) and that which is excited (Kṣ obhya), which relation is the cause of creation (Sṛ ṣ tihetu). The Śāradā (I. 10) then proceeds to deal KĀMAKALĀ 167 with the appearance of the three Devīs and three Devas which are in the nature of the three Śakti (Icchā, etc.) and Fire, Moon and Sun. Having then dealt with Śabda- sṛ ṣ ti it proceeds to describe Artha-sṛ ṣ ti (I. 15), giving first the line of Devas from Śambhu who are the Lords of the Tattvas (Tattveśa) and then that part of Artha-sṛ ṣ ti which is Tattva-sṛ ṣ ti or the evolution of the Tattvas of mind and matter from Buddhi to Pṛ thivī. It is not easy in all cases to discover and set forth an accurate summary of the Devīs, Devas, Śaktis and so forth in Śabda-sṛ ṣ ti: because the Texts being in verse are not always to be read as they stand, the order of words being in some cases regulated by the metre. As the author of the Prāṇ atoṣ iṇ ī says in dealing with a citation from the Gorakṣ a-Sam ̣ hitā, the texts must not be read “Prati- śabdam ̣ ,” that is, according to the order of the words, but “Yathāsambhavam,” according to the facts. But this does not relieve us from the difficulty of ascertaining what is the fact; that is, the real order. Other elements may also enter into the calculation: for instance, as Rāghava-Bhatta points out, the order of Śaktis varies in Īśvara and Jīva. In the former it is Icchā, Jñāna, Kriyā and in Jīva, Jñāna, Icchā, Kriyā. In Īśvara’s ideation (Pratyabhijñā) when He desires to do anything, an act of volition proceeds from Him (Svecchayā kriyā) to know or to do it (Taj jñātum ̣ kartum ̣ vā); next there is the capacity for cognising such acts (Tat kārya-jñāna-darśana-śaktitā) which is Jñāna- śakti; thirdly the gross effort (Sthūlah samudyamah) is the Kriyā-śakti (Kriyāśaktitā) from which the whole world proceeds (Tatah saruam ̣ jagat param ̣ ). Rāghava also points out that there is a difference of order in Śabda- sṛ ṣ ti and Artha-sṛ ṣ ti. Thus in dealing with the Praṇ ava it is said, “ A (the letter) which is Sun is Brahmā:” but here in the Śāradā verse, “Viṣ ṇ u is Sun.” I will first THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 168 give the order as it is given in the Śāradā Text (v. 10): “From Bindu came Raudri; from Nāda Jyeṣ ṭ hā, from Bīja, Vāmā. From these came Rudra, Brahmā, Ramā- dhipa (Viṣ ṇ u).” Raudrī bindos tnto nadāj jyesththā bījād ajāyata Vāmā, tābhyah samutpannā rudrabrahmaramādhipāh. It then continues, “Who are in the nature of Jñāna, Icchā, Kriyā and Fire, Moon and Sun (v. 11) (Sam ̣ jñā- necchākriyātmāno vahnīndvarkasvarūpiṇ ah), who are in the form (Rūpa) of Nirodhikā, Arddhendu and Bindu.” These are all different states of Śakti (Śakterevāvasthā- viśeṣ āh), for it is owing to their arising from Śakti (Śaktitah utpannatvāt), that they are identified with the Śaktis Icchā and so forth. According to the Yoginī-hṛ daya-Tantra (I) the order is (a) Icchā, Vāmā, Paśyantī; (b) Jñāna, Jyeṣ ṭ hā, Madh- yamā; (c) Kriyā, Raudrī, Vaikharī. It says that when Icchā-Śakti in the form of a goad (Am ̣ kuśākārā, that is, the bent line Vakrarekhā) is about to display the universe which is in seed (Bīja) form, She is Vāmā and in the form of Paśyantī Śabda. Paśyanti “She who sees,” Īksana. Vāmā is so oalled because this Śakti vomits forth the universe (Vamamāt Vāmā). Jyeṣ ṭ hā which is in the form of a straight line (Ṛ jurekhā) attaining the state of Mātṛ kā (Mātṛ kātvam upapannā) is Madhyamā vāk. Raudrī is Kriyā in triangular or pyramidal (Śṛ n ̣ gātaka), that is, three-dimensional form, and is the manifested Vaikharī- Śabdha. According to the Kāmakalāvilāsa (Comm. v. 22), Yoginīhṛ ydaya-Tantra (Sam ̣ keta l), and the Saubhāgyasud- hodaya (cited in Sam ̣ keta (2) of the last Śāstra), the order would appear to be (a) Icchā Rajas Vāmā Brahmā Paśyantī-Śabda; (b) Jñāna Sattva Jyeṣ ṭ hā Viṣ ṇ u Mad- hyamā-Śabda; (c) Kriyā Tamas Raudrī Rudra Vaikharī- Śabda. KĀMAKALĀ 169 I will not however here attempt a discussion, which would be both lengthy and technical, of the texts on this point. For present practical purposes it is sufficient to know that the three Bindus are Śiva, Śakti, Śivaśakti; Prakāśa, Vimarśa, Prakāśa-Vimarśa; White, Red and Mixed; Bindu, Nāda, Bīja; Supreme, Subtle, Gross; the three Devis, the three Devas, and the three Śaktis of Will, Knowledge and Action. The Supreme at this point thus becomes a Trinity of Energy. The division of the Mahābindu may be memorised by writing in Sanskrit the “Fire” Bija or “Ram ̣ ”, that is Ra with Candra-bindu (रँ ). Then invert the Nāda sign which will thus represent the Moon (Indu), the Bindu, the Sun (Ravi), and the Ra, Fire (Agni). The Triangle may be formed by drawing two sides or a bent line and then completing it with a straight line. At the apex place the Ravi-bindu (Sun) and at the left and right hand corners Vahni-bindu (Fire) and Moon (Candra-bindu). Between Sun and Moon place Vāmā Vakrarekha and Brahmā; between Fire and Moon, Jyeṣ ṭ hā and Viṣ ṇ u; and between Moon and Sun, Raudrī, Ṛ jurekhā and Ṛ udra. Between each of the points are lines formed by all the letters (Mātṛ kā-varna) of the alphabet called the A-Ka-Tha triangle. The Pādukāpañcaka, a Hymn attributed to Śiva, (See Serpent Power) speaks of A-Ka-Tha in the second verse on which Kālīcarana comments as follows: Here Śakti is Kāmakalā in form aed the three Śaktis (Vāmā Jyeṣ ṭ hā, Raadri) emanating from the three Bindus are the three lines. The sixteen vowels beginning with A form the line Vāmā, the sixteen letters beginning with Ka form the line Jyeṣ ṭ hā and the sixteen letters beginning with Tha form the line Rauda. The abode of Śakti (Abalālaya) is formed by these three lines. The other three letters Ha, La, Kṣ a are in the corners of the Triangle. Kālyūrādhvām ̣ āya THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 170 says, “The Tribindu is the Supreme Tattva and em- bodies in Itself Brahmā Viṣ ṇ u, Śiva (Brahma-viṣ ṇ u- śivātmakam ̣ ). The Triangle composed of the Letters has emanated from the Bindu;” also “The letters A to Visarga make the line Brahmā, the letters Ka to Tha the line Viṣ ṇ u, and the letters Tha to Sa the Rudra. The three lines emanate from the three Bindus. The Guṇ as, as aspects of Śakti, are also represented by this threefold division. The Tantrojīvana says: “The lines Rajas, Sattva, Tamas sur- round the Yonimaṇ ḍ ala.” Also “above is the line of Sattva, the line of Rajas is on its left and the line of Tamas on its right.” The Śabda-brahman in its threefold aspect and Energies is represented in the Tantras by this triangular Kāmakalā which is the abode of Śakti (Abalālaya). The Triangle is in every way an apposite symbol, for on the material plane if there are three forms there is no other way in which they can be brought to interact except in the form of a triangle in which whilst they are each, as aspects, separate and distinct from one another, they are yet related to each other and form part of one whole. In the Agama- kalpadruma it is said that the Bindu is Ham ̣ (one point) and Visargah (two points) is Sah or Śakti. The Yāmala thus speaks of this abode, “I now speak of Kāmakalā,” and proceeding says, “She is the Eternal One who is the three Bindus, the three Śaktis and the three forms (Tri- mūrtti).” The Māheśvarī-Sam ̣ hitā says: “Sun, Moon and Fire are the three Bindus and Brahmā, Viṣ ṇ u, Rudra, the three lines.” The Lalitā-sahasranāma calls the Devī, Kāma- kalārūpā. Bhāskararāya in his commentary thereon (v. 78) says that Kāma or creative will (Icchā) is both Śiva and Devī and Kalā is their manifestation. Hence it is called Kāmakalā. This is explained in the Tripura-siddhānta: “Oh Pārvati, Kalā is the manifestation of Kāmeśvara and KĀMAKALĀ 171 Kāmeśvarī. Hence She is known as Kāsmakalā.” Or, She is the manifestation (Kalā) of Desire (Kāma), that is, of Icchā-Śakti. The Devī is the great Tripurasundarī. Bhās- kararāya’s Guru Nṛ sim ̣ hānandanātha wrote the following verse on which the disciple comments: “I hymn Tripurā, the treasure of Kula, who is red of beauty; Her limbs like unto those of Kāmarāja who is adored by the three Devatās of the three Guṇ as; who is the desire or Will of Śiva (according to the Anekārtha- dhvani-manjarī lexicon I = Manmatha = Kāma = Icchā) who dwells in the Bindu and who manifests the Universe.” She is red because She is the Vimarśa-śakti. She is called (says the Commentator cited) Tripurā as She has three (Tri) Purās (literally cities or abodes), here meaning three Bindus, lines, angles, syllables and so forth. She has three angles (in the triangular Yoni the source of the universe) as well as three circles (the three Bindus) and the Bhūpura of Her Yantra has three lines. Yoni does not here mean generative organ, but Kāraṇ a—the Cause of the universe. She has three aspects and creates the three Devatās through the three Śaktis, Vāmā and others, and manifests as Will, Knowledge and Action. Thus since She the Supreme Energy is everywhere triple, She is called Tripurasundarī. The three syllables of Her Mantra are the three divisions of the Pañcadaśi, namely Vāg- bhava, Kāmarāja and Śakti-Kūtas, which according to the Vāmakeśvara-Tantra are the Jñāna and other Śaktis. The Kāma-bīja is Klīm ̣ and Klīm ̣ -kara is Śivakāma. Here “I” is said to denote the Kāmakalā in the Turīya state through which Mokṣ a is gained, and hence the meaning of the saying that “ he who hears the Bīja without Ka and La does not reach the place of good actions”—that is he hoes not go to the region attain- able by good actions but to that (Moke) attainable by THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 172 Jñāna alone. The Bhāva-cūḍ āmaṇ i says: “Meditate on the face in the form of Bindu, and below on the twin breasts (the two other Bindus) and below them the beaute- ous form of the Hakārarddha. The commentator on the Anandalaharī says: “In the fifth sacrifice (Yajña) let the Sādhaka think of his Ātmā as in no wise different from, but as the one and only Śiva; and of the subtle thread, like Kuṇ dalinī who is all Śaktis extending from the Ādhāra Lotus to Paramaśiva. Let him think of the three Bindus as being in Her body indicating Icchā, Jñāna, Kriyā; Moon, Sun, Fire; Rajas, Sattva, Tamas; Brahmā, Viṣ ṇ u, Rudra; and then let him meditate upon the Cit-kalā who is Śakti below it.” The Bindu which is the “Face” indicates Viriñci (Brahmā) associated with the Rajas Guṇ a. The two Bindus which are the “Breasts” and upon which meditation should be done in the heart indicate Hari (Viṣ ṇ u) and Hara (Rudra) associated with the Sattva and Tamas Guṇ as. Below these meditate upon the subtle Cit-kalā which indicates all three Guṇ as and which is all these three Devatās. Similar meditation is given in Yoginī (and other) Tantras winding up with the direction, “and then let the Sādhaka think of his own body as such Kāmakalā.” As regards this it is to be observed that in the Mūlā- dhāra there is a Traipura-Trikoṇ a, so-called because of the presence of the Devi Tripura within the Ka inside the triangle. This Ka is the chief letter of the Kāma-Bīja and Kam ̣ is the Bīja of Kāminī, the aspect of Tripurasundarī in the Mūlādhāra. Here also are the three lines, Vāmā, Icchā and so forth. Thus the Traipura Trikona is the Sthūla aspect of the Sūkṣ ma-Śakti in the region of the upper Sahasrāra called Kāmakalā. It is to this Kāminī that in worship the essence of Japa (Tejo-rūpa-japa) is offered, the external Japa being given to the Devatā KĀMAKALĀ 173 worshipped in order that the Sādhaka may retain the fruits of his Japa. (Nityapūjāpaddhati 8). Man physically and psychically is a limited manifestation of this threefold Śakti which resides within himself and is the object of worship. Such worship leads to identification and so the Śritattvārṇ ava says: “Those glorious men who worship that Body in Sāmarasya are freed from the waves of poison in the untraversable sea of the universe (Sam ̣ sāra). Sāmarasya, I may here observe, is a term which is ordi- narily applied to the bliss of sexual union (Strīpum ̣ yogāt yat saukhyam ̣ tat sāmarasyam ̣ ). For the benefit however of those who are aIways reading gross meanings into parts of the Śāstra alien to them it is necessary to explain that Sāmarasya is both gross (Sthūla) and subtle (Sūkṣ ma). Here the latter is meant. An erotic symbol is employed to denote the merger of the Jīva and Supreme Consciousness in Ecstasy (Samādhi). The Tantras largely employ such imagery which is to be found in the Upaniṣ ads and in non-Indian scriptuses. Thus the highly sensual imagery of the Biblical “Song of Songs” is said (whether rightly or not, I will not here inquire) to symbolise Christ’s love for His Bride, the Church. Spiritual union is symbolised by terms borrowed from the world of man. By Mantra-yoga is sought that perfection and unity of Bhāva which leads to Jñānayoga Samādhi. “On the division of the Supreme Bindu (into the threefold Kāma-kalā) there was the Unmanifested Sound” (Bhidyamānāt parād bindor avyaktātmā ravo’bhavat, Sāradā-I-11). This is the Śabda-brahman or the Brahman as the cause of manifested Śabda and Artha and there- fore of Mantra. This causal “Sound” is the unmanifested (Avyaktātmā), undifferentiated (Akhaṇ ḍ a) principle of Śabda (Nādamātra), composed of Nāda and Bindu (Nāda- bindumaya), devoid of all particularity such as letters and THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 174 the like (Varnādiviśeṣ a-rahita). Some, as the Śāradā says (V. 12), have thought that the Śabda-brahman was Śabda and others Śabdārtha, but this cannot be, for both are unconscious (Jadatvāt). “In my opinion,” its author says (v. 13), “Śabda-brahman is the Consciousness in all beings” (Caitanyam ̣ sarvabhūtānām ̣ śabda-brah- meti me matih). For if Śabdārtha or Śabda be called Śabda-brahman then the meaning of the term Brahman is lost (Brahmapadavācyatvam ̣ nopapadyate); for the mean- ing of the term Brahman (Brahmapadārtha) is Sat-Cit- Ānanda (Saccidānandarūpa), whilst these are unconsci- ous (Jada). Rāghava-Bhatta says that Śabda-brahman is Nādabindumaya Brahman (Brahmātmaka) Sound (Śabda) unmanifested (Avyekta), undifferentiated (Akhaṇ da), all pervading (Vyāpaka), which is the first manifestation of Paramaśiva in creative mood (Sṛ ṣ tyunmukha-paramaśiva- prathamollāsamātram ̣ ). He also cites a passage from some work unnamed which says that out of Prakṛ ti in Bindu form in whom Kriyā-Śakti prevails (Kriyāśaktipradhā ṇ āyāh prakṛ ter bindu-rūpinyāh) arose the Supreme Śabda- brahman the cause of Śabda and Śabdārtha (Śabda-śabdārtha- kāraṇ am ̣ ). The Sound (Rava) here spoken of is in the form of Bindu (Bindu-rūpa), which later appears in all bodies as the Mātṛ kās and Varṇ as in their respective places. The Śāradā (I. 14) having thus dealt with Paraśabdāsṛ ṣ ṭ i con- cludes in a general way, “Consciousness which is the Svarūpa of, and appears as, Kuṇ dalī-Śakti in the bodies of all living beings manifests as Letters in prose and verse, having obtained the instruments for utterance which are the throat and so forth.” Tat prāpya kuṇ dalīrūpam ̣ prāninā m ̣ dehamadhyaga m ̣ Varṇ ātmanāvirbhavati gadyapdyādibhedatah. The subsequent Śabdasṛ ṣ ṭ i is derived from Kunda- liṇ ī. The Kāmakalā is thus cdled the root (Mūla) of all KĀMAKALĀ 175 Mantras, for it is the threefold aspect of the Śabda-brahman, the cause of all manifested Śabda and Artha and there- fore Mantra. In a future article I will continue the account of the creative process, namely, the Artha-sṛ ṣ ti in which are included the Tattvas from Buddhi to Pṛ thivī and the Lords (Tattveśa) or forms of Consciousness which preside over them. These are neoessarily dealt with in connection with the Tattvas over which they preside. In the same way Pasyantī, Madhyamā and Vaikharī states of sound are also dealt with, because Paśyantī and the others only exist in the created body. Para-śabda is un- manifested Caitanya, but the other Three Feet of the One Brahman are set in the manifested world of Mind and Matter. CHAPTER XVIII THE GROSS TATTVAS AND THEIR LORDS THE Śāradā-Tilaka (Chapter I) having first dealt with Śabda-sṛ ṣ ṭ i on account of its priority (Prādhānyadyota- nāya prathamoddiṣ ṭ am ̣ ) commences with the fifteenth verse to speak of the creation of objects (Artha-sṛ ṣ ṭ i), for Paśyantī and the other Bhāvas assume the existence of the manifested body. It says that from Śam ̣ bhu who is in the nature of Kalā (Kalātmanah) and Bindu (Bindvāt- manah) and friend of Kalā (Kālabandhu), issued (Ajāyata) the “Witness of the World” (Jagatsākṣ ī), the all pervading (Sarvavyāpī) Sadāśiva. Rāghava says Kalā is here either used generally, or as referring to the Nivṛ tti and other Kalās which Śam ̣ bhu produces. By “ friend of Kāla” is meant that Śam ̣ bhu is in the nature of Nāda (Nādātmā), because in unbeginning and unending Time. He is the helper of Kāla which is Sṛ ṣ ṭ i (Anādyamante kāle sṛ ṣ ṭ i- rūpakālasahāyāt). The connection again is one between cause and its possessor. Again “friend” indicates the causality (Nimittatvam ̣ ) of Kāla. For it has been said: “It has its beginning in Lava and ends in Pralaya and is full of Tamas Śakti.” Lava is the time taken to pierce with a needle a lotus-petal. Thirty Lavas = one Truṭ i. This Kāla is Apara, for there is also Para Kāla. Kāla or Māyā is the cause of the occurrence of birth and destruction. Rāghava concludes that Prakṛ ti and Kāla exist in even Mahāpralaya. But their permanence (Nityatā) is a dependent THE GROSS TATTVAS AND THEIR LORDS 177 one (Apekṣ aka-nityatā). For the permanence of the Puruṣ a in which all things have their goal is alone independent (Svaton-ityatvam ̣ ). From Śam ̣ bhu emanated the Sadāśiva who is the Doer of the five forms of work, namely Creation, Preserva- tion and Destruction, Favour (Anugraha) and Disfavour (Nigraha). From Sadāśiva comes Īśa, from Him Rudra, from Rudra Viṣ ṇ u, from Viṣ ṇ u Brahmā (v. 16). On this verse Rāghava says: “It has been said before how they arise in Śabda-sṛ ṣ ṭ i. Here they arise in Artha-sṛ ṣ ṭ i.” The five Śivas are known in the Tantras as the “Five great corpses” (Pañca-mahāpreta). Śiva is constantly represented in corpse-like (Śavarūpa) form. This sym- bolises that Consciousness in Itself (Svarūpa) is actionless and inert. All action is by Śakti. Hence the Devī is in pictures imaged as standing on the inert corpse-life body of Siva. The same notion is represented by Viparīta- maithuna, a prominent example of the use of erotic symbolism in the Śākta-Śāstra. These Pañca-mahāpreta form the couch on which the Devī, Wave of Conscious- ness and Bliss, rests in the house of Cintāmaṇ i adorned with a garden of Nīpa trees, which is in the Island of Gems, surrounded with a grove of celestial trees, in the midst of the ocean of nectar (Ānandalaharī). This is the well-known Tāntrika meditation on the Heart-lotus of worship below the Anāhata-cakra. The Bahurūpaṣ taka and Bhairava-yāmala say: “There is the supreme abode (Mandira) of Devī full of Cintāmapi stones (which grant all desires). The great couch is Śiva, the cushion or mattress (Kaśipu) is Sadāśiva, the pillow the great Īśāna. The four supports (Pada) are Īśāna, Rudra, Hari, and Brahmā. On that Bed reclines the supreme Tripura- sundarī.” Hence the Devī in the Lalitāsahasranāma (v. 73) is called Pañca-brahmāsanasthitā. The “Jewelled Island” THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 178 is a high state of Consciousness in that Ocean of Nectar which is the infinite all-pervading Consciousness Itself. The Devī is united with Paramaśiva in the Praṇ ava; the Nāda over the Om ̣ kāra being the couch on which is resting Paraśiva in His Bindu form. A,U,M, Nāda, Bindu the five component parts of Om and the Śri-cakra-Yantra are here referred to. The supreme Paramaśiva abides in Satyaloka beyond mind and matter. Śam ̣ bhu presides over mind and His abode is Maharloka. Ether, air, fire, water, earth are presid- ed over by Sadāśiva, Īśa, Rudra, Viṣ ṇ u, Brahmā whose abodes are Tapoloka, Janaloka, Svarloka, Bhuvarloka, Bhūrloka; and their centres in the human body are in the Ājñā, Viśuddha, Anāhata, Maṇ ipūra, Svādhiṣ ṭ hāna, and Mūlādhāra-Cakras, respectively. Kuṇ dalī-Śakti manifests as the six. But notwithstanding all Her subtle and gross manifestations She remains ever the same Cit and Ānanda; for the Ātmā in its own nature (Svarūpa) as distinguished from its Powers and their products is the same in all times and places. Turning then to the Tattvas the Śāradā says (v. 17) that from the unmanifest Mūlabhūta (Prakṛ ti or root of all creation) of the Supreme (Paravastu-Bindu) when subject to change (Vikṛ ti) issued, through inequality of the Guṇ as, the Sāttvika-Tattva Mahat in the form of the Antahkaraṇ a and Guṇ as. Mahat is the cosmic Buddhi which is said to be in the form of the Antahkaraṇ a (Buddhi, Aham ̣ kāra, Manas) for all three are, implicitly contained in the first (Upacārā- dūbhayātmakah), as also the Guṇ as which here mean the Tanmātras of sound, touch, sight, taste and smell. According to Nyāya the Guṇ as appertain each to each (Tattadviśeṣ aguṇ āh) ; or according to Sam ̣ khya Ether has one Guṇ a, Air has two, Fire three and so forth. THE GROSS TATTVAS AND THEIR LORDS 179 From Mahat was derived Aham ̣ kāra which is threefold as Vaikārika, Taijasa, and Bhūtādi or the Sāttvika, Rājasa, and Tāmasa-Aham ̣ kāras (v.18). Rāghava says that it is called Vaikārika because it issues from Parameśvara when His Sāmarasya with Śakti becomes Vikṛ ta or disturbed. The Devas also are Vaikārika because pro- duced from it. According to Sam ̣ khya the Vaikārika nature is due to its generation from Pradhāna when Vikṛ ta. The Vaikārika Devas are Dik, Vāta, Arka, Pracetā (Varuṇ a) Aśvins (two Aśvinīkumāras) Vahni, Indra, Upenara (Visṇ o- rekā-mūrtih) Mitra (the third sun) and Ka (Candra). These are the Presiding Devatās of the senses (Indriyas). From the Taijasa-Aham ̣ kāra were evolved the Indriyas. The five Tanmātras and the derived Bhūtas came from Bhūtādi-Aham ̣ kāra. The Text and Commentary speak of the derivation of Ākāśa from Śabda-tanmātra, Vāyu from Sparśa-tanmātra and so forth. But as the word Pūrva occurs, others read this as meaning that each becomes cause of what follows in association with what had gone before. Thus Śabda- tanmātra produces Ākāśa. From Śabda-tanmātra together with Sparśa-tanmātra, come Vāyu. From these two and Rūpa-tanmātra come Agni and so forth. The Sāradā then gives the colours of the Bhūtas namely transparent (Svaccha) ether, black air, red fire, white water, and yellow earth, the Ādhāras of which are the Tanmātra, and the Guṇ as of which are sound, touch, sight, taste and smell. Rāghava-Bhatta says that it is for the purpose of worship (Upāsanā-sthānam ̣ ) in pursuance of Śāstra (Svaśāstrānurodhena) that certain invisible things are here said to have colours (Atra keṣ āmcit arūpi- dravyānām ̣ varṇ akathanam). This might perhaps seem to suggest to some that the colours are not real. But if this be so is it correct? Ether is transparent which is no colour, THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 180 black is the absence of colour. With Rūpa there must be colour. For what is colourless is formless. Form is only perceived by means of colour: and the last three Bhūtas are with form. Their colours are widely adopted. Thus in China also yellow is the colour of earth, and red and white are generally assigned to fire and water, respectively. Pos- sibly what is meant is that the colours are here mentioned for the purpose of worship: that is, the mentioning is for such purpose. Else how could the Yogī perceive them? For it is said: “Tāni vastūni tānmātrādīni pratyakṣ a-viṣ a- yāṇ i” (that is to Yogīs). Elsewhere it is said that ether is hollow or pitted (Suṣ iracinam) air is moving (Calana- parah) fire is digesting (Paripākavān) water is tasteful (Rasavat) earth is solid (Ghana). All the universe is com- posed of the four Bhūtas entering into one another Paras- parānupraviṣ ṭ aih mahābhūtaiś caturvidhaih) pervaded by ether (Vyāptākāśaih). Thus Consciousness as Śakti evolves mind and matter. The principles (Tattvas) of these are not always clearly understood. They may, and indeed must be, considered from the point of view of evolution—that is according to the sequence in which the limited experience of the Jīva is evolved—or from that in which they are regarded after creation when the experience of concrete sense objects has been had. According to the former aspect, Buddhi is the state of mere presentation; consciousness of being only, without thought of “I” (Aham ̣ kāra) and unaffected by sensations (Manas, Indriya) of particular objects which ex hypothesi do not yet exist. It is thus a state of impersonal Jīva consciousness. Aham ̣ kāra of which Buddhi is the basis is the persond Consciousness which realises itself as a particular “I” the experiencer. The Jīva wakes to world experience under the influence of Māyā-Śakti. In the order of awakening he first experiences in a vague general way THE GROSS TATTVAS AND THEIR LORDS 181 without consciousness of the limited self, like the experience which is had immediately on waking after sleep. It then refers this experience to the limited self and has the con- sciousness “I am so and so.” Manas is the desire which follows on such experience, and the senses and their objects are the means whereby that enjoyment is had which is the end of all will to life. The Cosmic mind projects its content as ideas and desires on to the gross sensual plane and there the individual mind enjoys them as such. I may here observe that the same scheme exists in Buddhism where the root is given as Avidyā, from which arises Sam ̣ skāra. This gives birth to Vijñāna (which is Buddhi) and then to Nāmarūpa that is an external world at first vaguely perceived. The desire to take cognisance of this gives rise to the six sense organs (Ṣ adāyatana) namely Manas and the Indriyas. From this follows contact (Sparśa) of the sense organs with the external world giving rise to feeling (Vedana) called forth by such contact in the form of pleasure and pain. This experience produces Desire (Tṛ ṣ ṇ ā) which a recent work on the Unconscious calls Libido, for pleasant sensations resulting in attachment and enjoyment (Upādāna), and then the individual Jīva con- sciousness (Bhāva) is born (Jāta), ages and dies and is again reborn until Nirvāṇ a is attained. Throughout it is the will to life, the root of which is in Avidyā which produces the instruments namely the mind and senses whereby enjoyment is to be had and which creatively imagines the content of its experience from out of the store of past lives in past universes. True experience there- fore can only be had by destroying the root which is Avidyā. One of the tasks which yet remains to be done is to show the essential similarities of Buddhism and Hinduism instead of dwelling, as is usually done, on their differences, alleged or real. When it is fully realised that THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 182 Buddhism took its birth in India and the implications necessary therein truer notions will be entertained of it than generally prevails. An example from science has been given which illus- trates the process stated. In some animals there are no specialised sense organs but when stimulus is often given to a particular part of a body that part gets specially sensitive to it and a particuIar organ is developed. The illustration of course assumes that objects have been already created. But in the evolution of the world similar principles come into play as those which exist after it has been evolved. The effect exists in its cause. Conscious- ness awakening to world-experiences reaches forth and forth and as it seeks to come by recollection to its limited self, its desire evolves the instruments of enjoyment and projects the objects of enjoyment into the sensual world. This is the action of the Sam ̣ skāra operating in and upon consciousness. Whilst however in the order of evolution Buddhi is the first principle, in the actual working of the Antah- karaṇ a after creation has taken place it comes last. It is more convenient therefore for ordinary exposition to com- mence with the sense objects and the sensations they evoke. Matter as the objective cause of perception is not, in its character, as such, under the cognisance of the senses. All that can be predicated of it is its effect upon these senses which is realised by the instrumentality of mind in its character ss Manas. In science the notion of indestructible matter in atomic form is no longer held, for all matter it is now shown can be dissociated and the atom is dematerialised. The old duality of Force and Matter disappears, these two being held to be differing forms of the same thing. The ultimate basis is now re- cognised as Māyā or Prakṛ ti-Śakti. Matter is a stable form THE GROSS TATTVAS AND THEIR LORDS 183 of force into which on disturbance of its equilibrium it disappears. Sensible matter (Bhūta) affects the experiencer in five different ways giving rise to the sensations of hear- ing (Ākāśa), touch and feel (Vāyu: not in the sense of all forms of contact, for form and solidity are not yet developed) colour and form and sight (Rūpa) taste (Rasa) and smeIl (Gandha). Sensible perception however exists only in re- spect of particular objects. But there exist also general elements of the particulars of sense-perception. There is an abstract quality by which sensible matter (Mahābhūta) is perceived. This abstract quality is Tanmātra the “mere thatness” or abstract quality of an object. These are the general e;ements of sense perception which necessarily come into existence when the senses (Indriyas) are produced. This is supersensible (Atīndriya) matter, the existence of which is ordinarily only mediately perceived through the gross particular objects of which they are the generals and which proceed from them. Sensations aroused by sense objects are experienced by the outer instruments (Bāhya-karaṇ a) or senses (Indriyas) whether of cognition (Jñānendriya) or ac- tion (Karmendriya) which are the afferent and efferent impulses respectively. The Indriyas are not however suf- ficient in themselves. In the first place unless attention co-operates there is no sensation (Ālocana) at all. Nextly as the experiencer is at every moment besieged by count- less sensations from all sides; if any of these is to be brought into the field of consciousness it must be selected to the exclusion of others. Lastly the manifold of sense or “points of sensation” must be gathered together and made into a whole. These three functions are those of Manas the function of which is said to be Sam ̣ kalpa-vikalpa that is selection and rejection of material provided by the Jñānendriya. These sensations, to affect the experiencer, must be made his own and this is done by Aham ̣ kāra or THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 184 “Self-arrogation.” It is then passed on to Buddhi which determines either by way of forming percepts and concepts or resolutions (Kartavyam ̣ etat mayā). Thus all the Tattvas work for the enjoyment of the Self or Puruṣ a. They are not to be regarded as things existing independently by themseIves but as endowments of the Spirit (Ātmā). They do not work arbitrarily as they will but represent an organised co-operative effort in the service of the Enjoyer, the Experiencer or Puruṣ a. The Tantras speak of three Tattvas namely of Ātmā, Vidyā, Śiva. The first includes those Tattvas of the Thirty- six which are called impure (Aśuddha) namely Pṛ thivi to Prakṛ ti; the second the pure-impure (Śuddha-Aśuddha) or Māyā, the Kañcukas and Puruṣ a; and the third the pure Tattvas (Śuddha) from Śuddha-vidyā to Śiva-Tattva. I have dealt with the last two in previous Chapters and deal with the first in the present one. It is also said (see Jñānārṇ ava-Tantra XXI-1-22) that there are four Ātmās constituting the Citkuṇ da or Maṇ dala in the Mūlādhāra where the inner Homa is made. By knowledge thereof there is no rebirth. These are Ātmā, Jñānātmā, Antarātmā and Paramātmā. The Ātmā (Prāṇ arūpī) which is in all creatures (Jantu) as the basis of their Prāṇ a or vital principle is their Ātmā. It is Ham ̣ sāsvarūpi and is manifested in individual bodies by inspiration and expiration (Śvasa, Ucchvāsa). This is Jīvātmā. It is like the Ākāśa separated in a pot which when broken becomes mingled with the total Ākāśa. Jñān- ātmā is said to be Sakṣ āt-sākṣ irūpaka. That is, it is that aspect of Ātmā which witnesses all and by which the unity of all is known. It is thus the basis of Buddhi and all mental Tattvas derived therefrom. By “Antar” in Antarātmā is meant the subtle Ātmā of atomic dimension (Rahasya-sūkṣ ma-rūpaka-paramāṇ u) which pervades every THE GROSS TATTVAS AND THEIR LORDS 185 object. It is the “inner bodiness” (Antarangatā) the spark of Paramātma. It is Ham ̣ sa known only by Yogīs. Its beak is Tāra (Mantra Om ̣ ); Its two wings are Āgama and Nigama. Its two feet are Śiva and Śakti. The three Bindus are Its three eyes. When this Paramaham ̣ sa is spread (Vyāpta throughout Creation then all Bhūtas spring up in their order Ākāśa, Pavana, etc.). Of these five the root is Citta. This Ham ̣ sa Bird disports Itself in the Lake of Ignorance (Avidyā) in the mud of illusion and infatua- tion (Mohapan ̣ gka) which is the world. When this Ham ̣ sa becomes other-worldly (Nisprapañca) and dissolving (Sam ̣ - hārarūpī) then It reveals the Self (Ātmānam ̣ pradarśayet). Then Its “Birdness” (Pakṣ itva) ceases. Then the Śoha- mātmā is established which is the Supreme Experience or Pararmātmā. To complete the creative process it is now necessary to resume the creation of Śabda (Śabda-sṛ ṣ ṭ i) from its supreme state (Para-śabda or Parabrahman) through its three Bhāvas, Paśyantī, Madhyamā and Vaikharī mani- festing in bodies composed of the Tattvas above described; for in this way the birth of the letters composing Mantras is shown. I will deal with this in Chapter XXI under the title “Garland of Letters” (Varṇ amālā), a subject of primary importance in the Tantras, after a description of the Causal Śaktis of the Praṇ ava or Mantra Om ̣ and an explanation of the Kalās. CHAPTER XIX CAUSAL ŚAKTIS OF THE PRAṆ AVA THE present Chapter is but a short summary of the result of some enquiries recently pursued in Kashmir with a view to ascertain the notices of the Northern Śaiva school on several matters which I have been studying in connection with my work on the wakening of the spiraline energy or Serpent Power. I was already aware, as the Kulārṇ ava- Tantra (one of the foremost Tantras of the “Bengal” school) indicates, that the Śavia-Śākta-Darśana and not Śamkara’s exposition of Vedānta is the original philosophi- cal basis of the Śākta faith, though some who call them- selves Śāktas seem now-a-days to have forgotten, if they were ever aware of, that fact. In Kashmir, Kula-Śāstra is, I believe, another name for the Trika. But amongst several other objects in view I wished to link up the con- nection of certain Śaktis mentioned in the Kriyā portion of the Śāstras with the thiry-six Tattvas of the Śavia-Śākta school, their position in the scheme not being in all cases clear to me according to the information previously at my disposal. I have worked the matter in more detail and the present Chapter will summarise conclusions on cer- tain points. Being (Sattā) is of two kinds, formless (Arūpa) and with form (Rūpa). In the first the “I” (Aham ̣ ) and the “This” (Idam ̣ ) or univere representing the Prakāśa and Vimarśa aspects of experience are one. Śiva and Śakti exist in all the planes. But they are here undistinguishably CAUSAL ŚAKTIS OF THE PRA Ṇ AVA 187 one in the embrace of the Lord (Śiva) and “the Heart of the Lord” (Śakti). Śvia is Cit. Śakti is Cidrūpiṇ i. He is Para and She, Parā. This is the Perfect Experience which is Ānanda or “Resting in the Self” (Svarūpa- viśrānti). Śiva then experiences the universe as Parā- śakti, that is, Paranāda and Parā-vāk. This is the Love of the Self for the Self. The Supreme experience is the bliss of unalloyed Love. The Idam ̣ then exists as Parā-śakti. The two aspects are as it were one (Ekam ̣ tattvam ̣ iva), to use a phrase in the Ahirbudhnya-Sam ̣ hitā of the Pāñcarātra- Āgama. The “Supreme Sound” and “Supreme Speech” are thus the perfect Universe which is the supreme Kailāśa. This is the supreme unitary experience in which, though the “I” and the “This” do not cease to exist, they are both in their Svarūpa and thus mysteriously coalesce in one unity of Being which is the “Two in one.” The whole process then of creation, that is the rise of imperfect or dual experience, is the establishment through the negation of Śakti (Niṣ edha-vyāpāra-rūpā-Śakti) of a diremption in the one unitary consciousness whereby the Aham ̣ and the Idam ̣ , which had then existed, coalesced in one, diverge in consciousness, until in our own experience the “I” is separated from the “This” seen as objects outside ourselves. The process of manifestation of Mantra is that of cosmic ideation (Srsti-kalpanā) in which Jñāna-Śaki first merely forumlates as thought the outlines of the limit- ed universe which is about to emerge from, and for, consciousness, and which is called the “thinkable” (Man- tavya), which through Nāda which is Kriyāśakti-rūpa moves towards the “speakable” (Vācya), with which again consciousness identifies itself as Bindu which is characterised by a predominance of activity (Kriyāprā- dhānyalakśaṇ ā). Diversity (Pṛ thaghbhāva) is then produced THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 188 by Bindu as Ma-kāra in the Māyā-Tattva. Śakti as U- kāra creates objects (Prameya) as separate exis- tences and by the completion of the Tattvas objectivity is completely revealed as A-kāra. To describe however adequately this grand system of Ābhāsa, as it is called, would require a full exposition of the Northern or monistic Śavia and the allied Śākta-Darśana on which the Śākta doctrine and practice of the Āgamas is based. I can here only indicate shortly the Śaktis of the Mūla-Mantra or Pranava, which are the correspondences from the Śakti aspect of the Śaiva-Śākta-Tattvas. The accounts of the Śaktis vary, but such variance is rather due to the fact that some accounts are fuller than others than to any substantial difference in principle. The gist of the matter may be shortly stated as fol- lows: In creation, the three Śaktis, Jñāna, Icchā, Kriyā, manifest. These are manifested powers of the supreme Bindu. “ What is here is there,” and these Śaktis of the Lord (Pati) appear as the Guṇ as of Prakṛ ti in the Paśu; or as it has also been said, Jñāna and Kriyā with Māyā as the third appear as Sattva, Rajas, and Tamas of the Puruṣ a-Prakṛ ti stage which is the immediate source of the consciousness of the Paśu. Svānga-rūpeṣ u bhāveṣ u patyur jñānam ̣ kriyā cha yā Māyā tritīyā tā eva paśoh sattvam ̣ rajas tamah. (Īśvara-Pratyabhijnā, IV 1, 4) The creative consciousness (Śakti) projects the uni- verse as all-diffusive Consciousness (Sadākya-Tattva), which considered from the Mantra aspect is all-diffusive “Sound,” that is movement or Nida. Here the emphasis is on the Aha m ̣ , which is yet ooloured by the Idam ̣ as the universe faintly rises into the field of the changeless CAUSAL ŚAKTIS OF THE PRA Ṇ AVA 189 consciousness. Consciousness then identifies itself with the clearly perceived Idam ̣ and becomes Bindu. Here the emphasis is on the Idam ̣ with which consciousness becomes a point (Bindu). Then the evolving conscious- ness holds the “I” and the “This” in equal balance (Samānādhikaraṇ a), at which point Māyā Śakti, which is the sense of difference (Bhedabuddhi), intervenes to separate the Aham ̣ (as Puruṣ a) and Idam ̣ (as Prakṛ ti) hitherto held as parts of the one Consciousness, and the divisive power of Kalā-Śakti breaks up the universe so separated from the Self into that plurality of objects which is our ordinary worldly experience. The universe which in the Puruṣ a Prakṛ ti stage was seen as a whole, though different from the Self, is now also seen as separate but as a multitude of mutually exclusive beings. There is first a fivefold division of the “five rays” of Om ̣ , namely, A, U, M, Nāda Bindu, Śānta. The Prapañca- sāra-Tantra says that Jāgrat is Bīja, Svapna is Bindu, Suṣ upti is Nāda, Turīya is Śakti and the Laya beyond is Śānta. This is the simplest form of statement setting forth one Śakti for each of the Varṇ as, and the Candra- Bindu. In other words from Śiva-Śakti (which includes all the Tattvas down to the appearance of the three Devatās) these latter are produced. There is next a sevenfold division. Parā-sam ̣ vit or Paramaśiva is not technically accounted a Tattva, for the Supreme Experience is Tattātīta. But if we include it as the transcendental aspect of the Śaiva- tattva from which the Ākāśa proceeds, we get the number seven counting Puruṣ a and Prakṛ ti as two. The number seven is of frequent occurrence; as in the case of the seven Śivas, namely, Paraśiva, Śambhu and the five Mahā- pretas; the seven Śaktis of the Om ̣ kārā as given in the Śāradā-Tilaka; the seven Śaktis Unmani and the rest as given in the Commentary of Kālicaraṇ a on the THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 190 Ṣ atcakra-nirūpṇ a chapter of Pūrnānanda-Svāmi’s work entitled Śrītattva-cintāmaṇ i (The Serpent Power); and the three and a half coils of Kuṇ dalinī of which the Kubjikā- Tantra speaks, namely Puruṣ a, Prakṛ ti, Vikṛ ti, which it may be observed when uncoiled and divided by its diameter gives seven divisions. The Śāradā speaks of six Śaktis which with Para- meśvara who is Saccidānanda make seven namely: Śiva, Śakti, Nāda, Bindu (Kāraṇ a) Bindu (Kārya), Nāda (Kārya) and Bīja. The other seven Śaktis above mentioned are Unmanī (or Unmanā), Samanī (or Samanā), Āñjī, Mahā- nāda (or Nādānta), Nāda, Ardhacandra and Bindu. If in the first series we take Kārya-Nāda which is described as the Mithah-samavāya (mutual relation) of Śivarūpa-kārya- Bindu and Bīja, which is Śaktirūpa, as the correspondence in this scheme of the Śaiva Śuddhavidya-Tattva with its Samānādhikaraṇ a, then this series represents all the Śaiva Tattvas up to and including Puruṣ a-Prakṛ ti. The same remarks apply to the second series of Śaktis or causal forms (Kāranarūpa). The first is described by Kālicaraṇ a as the state in which all mindness (Manastva), that is, ideation ceases. Here there is neither Kalā nor Kāla, for it is “the sweet pure mouth of Rudra” Śivapada. The second is the cause of all causes (Sarvakāraṇ akāraṇ am ̣ ). The third which is also called by him Vyāpikā-Śakti appears in the beginning of creation. Mahānāda is the Kāraṇ a-Nāda which is Kriyā-Śakti and the first appearance of Nāda. Śakti as Nāda is a development of the latter which is transformed into Ardhacandra and then Bindu. These Śaktis (as well as two others with A U M, making together twelve) are explained according to Śaiva views in an account extracted from the Netra-Tantra with Kṣ emarāja’s Commentary and from the Tantrāloka. There the Śaktis are given as Unmanā, Samanā, Vyāpikā (or CAUSAL ŚAKTIS OF THE PRA Ṇ AVA 191 Vyāpinī), Añjanī, Mahānada, Nāda, Nirodhinī, Ardhacandra, Bindu, Ma-kāra, U-kāra, A-kāra. The Sanskrit passages here given are the summmy in his own language made for me by the Kashmirian Pandit Harabhatta Śāstrī of Srinagar. “When the Supreme Śiva beyond whom there is nought, who is in the nature of unchanged and unchange- able illumination moves forth by His will, such (willing movement as) Śakti though in fact, inseparable from Him, is called Unmanā; Her place is the Śiva-Tattva” (Anut- tara-paramaśiva avicalaprakāśātmā yadā svecchayā pra- sarati sa śaktih śivād abhinnaiva Unmanā ityucyate; tat- sthānam ̣ śiva-tattvam ̣ iti). “When the Unmanā-Śakti displays Herself in the form of the universe beginning with the Śūnya and ending with Dharā, formulates as mere thought the thinkable, then She is called Samanā as well as Śakti-tattva.” (Yadā unmanā-śaktir ātmām ̣ a, ksobhayati śūnyadinā dha- rātena jagad ātmanā sphurati mantavyam ̣ nanaamā- treṇ a āsūtrayati, tadā Samanā ityucyate Śakti-tattvam iti ca). “This Samanā-Śakti Herself is called Vyāpinī when She operates as the Power which withdraws into Herself all thinkables which are Her creation. She resides in the Śakti-tattva” (Samanā śaktir eva svamantavye sam ̣ hārapradhānatvena Vyāpinī ityucyate, eṣ ā Śakti- tattve-tiṣ ṭ hati), “It is again the Same Samanā Herself who is called Śakti when Her operation is chiefly creative in regard to her own thinkables. She resides in the Śakti- tattva and is also calledĀñjani because of Her being associated with the thinkable” (Samanaiva svamantavye sṛ ṭ ṣ ṭ ipradhānatvena śaktirityucyate eṣ ā Śakti-tattve ti- ṣ ṭ hati mantavyoparaktatvāc ca Āñjanī ityapi ucyate). “When Śabda-brahman moves forth with great strength from Its Śiva form then the very first sound (produced THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 192 thereby) like the vibration produced by a sounding bell is called Nādanta (i.e., Mahānāda). It resides in the Sadā- śiva-tattva.” (Yadā śabdabrahma śva-rūpād ativegena prasarati tadā prathamataram ̣ ghaṇ tānuraṇ ātmā śabdo Nādānta ityucyate, sa Sadā-śiva-tattve tiṣ ṭ hati). When Śakti fills up the whole universe with Nādānta then She is called Nāda. And this also is the Sadāśiva-Tattva because of the equality therein of the “I” and the “This” (Nādān- tena yadā viśvam ̣ āpūrayati tadā Nāda ityucyate, sa ca aham ̣ te-dam ̣ tayoh sāmānādhiharaṇ yena Sadāśi’va-tattca- miti). Samānādhikaraṇ a in its technical sense is the function of the later developed Śuddhavidyā-Tattva. Ap- parently its original is here represented to be the function of the earlier Sadāśiva-Tattva in which the duality of the Aham ̣ and Idam ̣ first manifests. “When Nāda, after having ceased to operate in its universal scope, does so limitedly (or particularly), then it is called Nirodhinī. This Śakti rests in the Sadāśiva- Tattva” (Nādo yadā aśeṣ avyāptim ̣ nimajjya adharam vyāptim unmajjayati tadā Nirodhinī ityucyate sā Sadā śivatattvah ālambate). “When Nāda is slightly operative towards the creation of the “speakable,” it is called Ardha- candra which is Īśvara-Tattva.” (Nādo yadā īṣ advācyon- meṣ am ̣ śrayati tadā Ardhacandra ityucate Īśvara-tattve). Then “Parā-Śakti Herself is caIled Bindu when She is in the nature of inseparate illumination in regard to the whole range of the speakable” (Paraiva śaktih yadā samastavācye abheda-pragāśa-rūpatam ̣ gṛ hṇ āti tadā Bindur ityucyate, sa Īśvaratattve tiṣ ṭ hati). Ma-kāra or Rudra-Devatā is defined: “When Bindu causes diversity to manifest it is called Ma-kāra and It moves in Māyā-Tattva” (Yadā binduh pṛ thag-bhāvam ̣ ābhāsayati tadā Ma-kāra ityucyate, sa ca Māyātattve) “When Śakti creates objects as separate existences then CAUSAL ŚAKTIS OF THE PRA Ṇ AVA 193 She is called U-kāra. It resides in the Prakrti-Tattva” (Yadā prameyam ̣ pṛ thag-bhāvena-unmṣ sayati, tadā U-kāra ityucyate, sa ca Prakṛ ti-tattve tiṣ ṭ hati). “When the crea- tion of the Tattvas has come to an end, then because objectivity is completely revealed, (Śakti as) Māntri-Kalā (that is the creative art or process considered as “Sound” or Mantra) is called A-kāra” (Tattva-sargasya nivṛ ttir yadā jāyate, tadā prameyasya pūrṇ atayā prakāśanāt A-kāra iti Māntrī-kalā ucyate). The extra five Śaktis enumerated in this account are due firstly to the inclusion of A U M ; secondly to counting Vyāpini and Āñjanī separately instead of as being the Nimeṣ a and Unmeṣ a aspect of one Śakti; and thirdly the sevenfold series would appear to include Nirodhinī, also called Nirodhikā, in Nāda of which it is a more parti- cularised development. Nāda would appear in the fuller series to represent Sāmānya-spanda of the sound emanation. For just as in the region of ideation the evolution is from infinite consciousness to the general and thence to parti- cular ideas; so from the corresponding objective or Mantra aspect, which is that of Śāktopāyayoga, motion commences from the unextended point first as general, then as parti- cular movement, at length developing into the clearly defined particularity of speech and of the objects which speech denotes. The rhythmic vibration of objects is the same as that of the mind which perceives them, since both are aspects of the one Śakti which thus divides itself. Namaste ravatvena tativābhidhāne. CHAPTER XX THE KALĀS KALĀ is a common term in Tāntrik literature for which it is difficult to find an appropriate English rendering. Śiva has two aspects Niṣ kala (Nirguṇ a) and Sakala (Saguṇ a). The former is therefore without Kalā. The latter is with Kalā. Śiva is never without Śakti, for the two are one and the same, and Śakti in Herself, according to Her proper nature (Śakti-Svarūpa), is Consciousness or Caitanya (Caitanyarūpiṇ i). Thus there are said to be no Kalās in Unmani which is in the Śiva-Tattva. There- after with Samanī in Śakti-Tatva the Kalās appear. Thus in Śri-Netra-Tantra (Ch. 22) seven Kalās are assigned to Samanī. The Śakti of a Devatā is divided into six- teen Kalās or “parts” of Power. That aspect of the Devatā which has full power is called Pūrṇ a-Kalāmūrti. One sixteenth of that or any part of the whole (Pūrṇ a) is Kalāmūrti. A fraction again of that is Amśam ̣ ūrti and a fraction of Amśam ̣ ūrti is Amśāmśa-m ̣ ūrti. Śiva is part- less. Śakti has parts (Kalā). But parts as we know them do not exist until after the universe has evolved from Prakṛ ti: that is, parts in the literal sense of the Māyik world. When therefore mention is made of Kalā in connection with so high a Śakti as Samanī or any other Śakti which precedes Prakṛ ti, what is meant is some- thing which may be best expressed by modes or aspects of THE KALĀS 195 Śakti. Kalā, in short, is a particular display of Power or Vibhūti. Kalā is also one of the Kañcukas which go to the making of the Puruṣ a consciousness and is the product of higher Śaktis and Kalās. The Kañcukas or enveloping Śaktis cut down the natural perfections as they exist in the Supreme Self and thus constitute the evolved Self or Puruṣ a. The four Kalās called Nivṛ tti, Pratiṣ ṭ hā, Vidyā, Śānti are specific modes of Śakti well defined. These are explained later. As regards the other Kalās there is greater difliculty. In the first place the texts are not consonant. This may be either due to inaccuracy in the MSS. or real variances or to both. Then explanations of the terms are in general wanting, though sometimes they are given by the commentators. The Sanskritist will however perceive that these latter Kalās are variant aspects (like Āvaraṇ a-Devatās of worship), descriptive of the nature and functions of the Śakti whose Kalās they are and as suoh may have been set forth for Upāsanā; the lengthy lists being in conformity with the taste of the age in which these Śāstras were promulgated. Thus Kalās have been called Jyotsnā (moonlight) and the ;ike on account of their Sarvajñatā-dharma, that is, Prakāśa-rūpatā-dharma; that which being in the nature of manifestation is white and brilliant as moonlight. So again Indhikā (kindling) Kalā is so called because it is Jñānarūpā or in the nature of knowledge; and Rundhanī is so called because of its oppos- ing or staying quality as explained later. This great elaboration of Śaktis is also in conformity with a psycho- logical principle on which Tāntrik Upāsanā is based into which I cannot enter here. The above remarks are illustrated by the lengthy list of Kalās of the Varṇ as and Praṇ ava given in Ch. III of the Prapañcasāra-Tantra. The Kalās of Nāda, Bindu, A U M are there given and I will not repeat them here; but I will relate THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 196 instead an account obtained from the Eashmirian Pandit Hara-Bhatta-Śāstri and taken by him from Śri-Netra-Tantra which has not been published. The reader of the Pra- pañcasāra will observe that the accounts vary both as to the names and numbers of the Kalās. In Śri-Netra-Tantra seven Kalās are given of Samani-Śakti, viz., Sarvajñā, Sarvagā, Durgā, Savarṇ ā, Spṛ hṇ ā, Dhrti, Samanā; five of Āñjanī, viz., Sūkṣ ma, Susūkṣ mā, Amṛ tā, Amṛ ta-sam ̣ - bhavā, Vyāpinī; one of Mahānāda viz., Ūrddhva-gāminī; four of Nāda, viz., Indhikā, Dīpikā, Rocikā, Mocikā. Some texts speak of Recikā. Nirodhinī-Śakti has five Kalās called Rundhinī, Rodhinī, Raudrī, Jñānabodhā, Tamo’- pahā. The Ṣ atcakra-nirūpaṇ a (V. 38) speaks of Bandhatī, Bodhinī, Bodhā. Rodhinī and Rundhanī, which mean “opposing,” indicate the opposition encountered by lower Experiencers such as Brahmā and other Devas attempt- ing to enter into the higher state of Nāda. These Śaktis (like the “Dwellers on the threshold” of Western occult literature) oppose all those to whom they do not extend their grace (Anugraha) by the Kalās Jñāna-bodhā (Wisdom) and Tamo’pahā (Dispeller of darkness). These Kalās are therefore called Sarvadeva-nirodhikā, that is, they oppose entrance into the higher state of consciousness and they oppose the fall therefrom of such Devas as have attained thereto. Of Ardha-candra there are five Kalās viz., Joytanā, Jyotsnātatī, Kānti, Suprabhā, and Vimalā, which are said to be Sarvajña-pada-sam ̣ sthitā. For She is Knower of all. If one can remain in Ardha-candrapada then all things are known—past, present and future. I am informed that according to Śri-Netra-Tantra (Ch. 22) and Svacchanda-Tantra (Ch. 201) the four Kalās of Bindu are the very important ones Nivṛ tti, Pratiṣ ṭ hā, Vidyā, Śānti; which however are said in Prapañcasāra to be Kalās of Nāda, the four Kalās of Bindu being there given THE KALĀS 197 as Pitā Śvetā, Aruṇ ā and Asitā. These five modes of Śakti are described later. The number and names of the Kalis of A U M differ in these several texts. According to the former the Kalās of the Destructive Rudra are Tamo- mohā, Kṣ udhā, Nidrā, Mṛ ityu, Māyā, Bhayā, Jadā; of the Protective Viṣ ṇ u the Kalās are Rajas, Rakṣ ā, Rati, Pālyā, Kāmya, Buddhi, Māyā, Nādī, Bhrāmani, Mohiṇ ī, Tṛ ṣ ṇ ā, Mati, Kriyā; and of the Creative Brahmā there are Siddhi, Ṛ ddhi, Dyuti, Lakṣ mi, Medhā, Kānti, Dhṛ ti, Sudhā. The three Bindus of the differentiating Parabindu form the Kāmakalā. The Kalās Nivṛ tti and the rest are the generalities (Sāmānya) of the Tattvas issuing from Prakṛ ti; that is the Tattvas are sub-divisions or differentiations of these four Kalās. Nivṛ tti-Kalā is the working force and essential element in the Pṛ thivi-Tattva or Solidity; and is so called because here the stream of tendency is stopped and the manifesting energy turned upwards. When Pṛ thivi has been reached by process of evolution, Śakti becomes Kuṇ dalī (coiled; at rest). Her next movement which is that of Yoga is upwards by involution retracing the steps of descent. The Pṛ thivi Anu or point of solidity is in- exhaustible potentiality in, and as a physical, that is, sensible manifestation of, the Spiraline Power welling up from and coiling round the Śiva-bindu. This aspect of the Power supplies (as a friend learned in Śaiva literature informs me) the curving and circular motion which mani- fests as the rounding and spherical skin and flesh with which all Prāṇ is are supplied. According to the same view Pratiṣ thā which is the same force in all the Tattvas from Ap to Prakṛ ti (Tantrāloka Ahn. 10) is so called, because whilst Nivṛ tti supplies the outer covering, Pra- tiṣ ṭ ā, as its name indicates supplies the basis and inner framework on which the outer physical universe is laid. Vidyā-Kalā, which is so called because it is limited THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 198 knowledge, is the dominant Kalā in the Tattvas from Puruṣ a upwards together with, five Kañcukas to Māyā. These are related to the Śaktis Vāmā, Jyeṣ ṭ hā and Raudrī, which manifest as the three motions which go to make the universe, which in terms of consciousness are the move- ments of the Antahkaraṇ a towards the objects (Viṣ aya) of its experience; such objects being the combination of lines on various planes, in curves and circles. The three dimensional framework affords the basis (Pratiṣ ṭ hā) for the outer solid covering (Nivṛ tti) supplied by the spiraline Śakti as the manifested sensible and physical. Beyond Māyā there is the consciousnsss which is peace (Śānti), for it is free of the duality which is the source of sorrow. The last Kalā is therefore called Śāntā and is dominant in the glorious experience of the Tattvas from Sadvidyā to Śakti-Tattva. Thus the Tattvas are only the manifestations of Śakti as three typical forms of move- ment starting from the kinetic state. It is these moving forces as the Kalās which are the inner life and secret of them. The Kalās are not dead forces; for the universe does not proceed from such. They are realised in direct experience as Devatās in and beyond all natural manifesta- tions and may be made to serve the purpose of Sādhana. As Divine Beings they are modes of the one Divine Mother worshipped diagrammatically in Yantras. As the inner forces in the Tattvas the Kalās group together the latter into four great “Eggs” (Aṇ ḍ a), that is, Spheroids oomprising those Tattvas only of which a Kalā is the oommon domi- nant feature and inner force. These are the Brahmāṇ ḍ a comprising Pṛ thivi-Tattva in which all others are involved, the bounding principle or envelope of which is ether (Ākāśa); Prakṛ tyaṇ ḍ a or Mūlāṇ ḍ a; Māyāṇ ḍ a; and Śakt- yaṇ ḍ a of which the envelopes are Pṛ akrti, Māyā and Śakti respectively. Beyond all these in the centre thereof and THE KALĀS 199 pervading all is the Śiva-Tattva in regard to which the Divine Śakti as a Kalā is an utter negation (Śūnyāti- śūnya), an empty space-giving or vacuity-producing power (Avakā- śadā), which is the negative pole of the conjoint Śiva-Śakti- Tattvas. The Śiva-Tattva is thus the Paramaśiva or Parā- sam ̣ vit, the great Bhairava experience with its supreme experience of the universe negatived. Regarding then this ultimate Śakti also, in so far as it is a manifestation, as a Kalā or moving Power, the thirty- six Tattvas of which the universe consists are but mani- festations of five forces (Śakti) or Kalās into which the one partless Divine Śakti differentiates Herself in an in- finite variety of permutations so as to produce the universe with parts: namely, Śāntātītā or Avakāśadā, Śāntā, Vidyā, Pratiṣ ṭ hā, Nivṛ tti. According to the account given in the Ṣ atcakra-ni- rūpaṇ a (Serpent Power) and the Commentaries of Kālī- caraṇ a and Viśvanātha, there is a Śakti called Nir- vāṇ a-Śakti with two Kalās, which are Nirvāṇ a-Kalā and Amā-Kalā, known as the seventeenth and sixteenth Kalās respectively. Unmanī is Śivapada which is beyond Kāla and Kalā. In Śakti-Tattva these have their source. The highest Śakti in this Tattva is Samanī; Nirvāṇ a-Śakti is, according to Viśvanātha, Samanāpada or Samanī, the life and origin of all being (Sarveṣ ām ̣ yonirūpiṇ i). Accord- ing to Kālīcarana, Nirvāṇ a-Śakti is Unmanī. Śakti as seventeenth Kalā is Cinmātrā and is called Nirvāṇ a-Kalā. Viśvanātha identifies it with Vyāpinī-Tattva which is Śakti-svarūpa and above (Parātparā) the sixteenth Kalā. It is Antargatā of, that is, included within, Amākalā, just as Nirvā ṇ a-Śakti is Antargatā of Nirvā ṇ a-Kalā. Kalicara ṇ a identifies it with Samanāpada. Amā is the sixteenth Kalā. She is the receptacle of the neatar which flows from the union of Parā (Bindurūpa, Śiva) and Parā (Śakti). THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 200 Viśvanātha cites the Yoginīhṛ daya-Tantra to show that Amā is Vyāpikā-Śakti. Kālīcaraṇ a agrees as to this. But it has been said by Viśvanātha that Nirvāṇ a-Kalā is Vyāpinī- Tattva. We must take it then that according to this view Nirvāṇ a and Amā-Kalā are the two aspects, supreme and creative, of Vyāpini-Tattva as Vyāpikā and Āñjanī. Beyond or more excellent than Amā-Kalā is Nirvāṇ a-Kalā, and then this last, Nirvāṇ a-Śakti or Samanī in Śakti- Tattva wherein is bondage (Pāśajāla). Thus Nirvāṇ a- Kalā is the Cinmātra-svabhāvā or pure consciousness as- pect of what in the creative aspect is called Amā, the receptacle of nectar, that is, the blissful current which flows from the union of Śiva and Śakti. This is the rapture of creation which is known to us also. The same Śakti is in differing aspect Amṛ tākāra-rūpiṇ i as the seven- teenth and the receptacle of Amṛ ta as the sixteenth Kalā. Amā is both Sṛ ṣ ṭ yunmukhī (looking towards creation) and Ūrddhva-śaktirūpā (looking upwards, that is, towards Liber- ation.) The former is the meaning of the expression “downward-turned-mouth” (Adhornukhī). This is the posi- tion of the Petals before Kuṇ dalinī ascends. This is my reading of Texts which are not devoid of discussion. Thus apart from difficulties in the Texts cited I was informed in Kashmir that Śakti is called the seven- teenth Kalā or Amā when Cinmātrasvabhāvā; and Amṛ ta- Kalā when Puruṣ a is with the sixteen Kalās, which in this case are said to be the Jñānendriya, Karmendriya, Tanmātra and Manas (which includes Aham ̣ kāra and Bud- dhi). This may be a difference of terminology only. What seems clear is that in Śakti-Tattva (of the thirty-six Tattvas) there are two Kalās which represent the supreme and creative modes of Śakti, whether we call them Nirvāṇ a and Amā or Amṛ tākārā and Amṛ ta-Kalā. The sixteenth is the creative Śakti and the Kalā which is in the nature THE KALĀS 201 of ever existent changeless Cit (Cinmātrasvabhāvā) is the seventeenth. To sum up. Paramaśiva (Parā-sam ̣ vit) in His aspects as Śiva-Tattvas is the Śūnyāti-śūnya, so called because in His experience there is not the slightest trace of objectivi- ty whatever. Both these aspects are Śāntātīta. Śakti then gradually unveils again the universe for the conscious- ness of Śiva who is Prakāśa or the Illuminating Con- sciousness which is the subjective aspect of things; and the experience which is summed up as Śāntā-Kalā arises, extending from Śakti-Tattva to Śadvidya, with the Śaktis, Saminī, Vyāpinī, Āñjanī and their Kalās; and the Śaktis of the Nāda and Bindu groups with their Kalās. This is the Spheroid of Śakti (Śaktyaṇ ḍ a) which is the abode of those glorious Beings who are called Mantra- māheśvara, Mantreśvara, Mantra and Vidyeśvara. The Vijñāna-kalās who are below Śuddha-vidyā are also above Māyā. From the unfolding of Bindu the other Spheroids emanate, which manifest the three principal forms of move- ment which go to the making of the universe. Next, in concentric circles arise the Spheroid of (Māyānḍ a), the field of operation of Vidyā-kalā, which is the Śakti pro- ducing the limited dual consciousness of all experiencers (Pralayākala, Sakala) below Sad-vidyā and in or below Māyā. Lastly, the Spheroids of Prakṛ ti and Brahmā provide the vehicles in which the Experiencer called Sakala functions. These Experiencers comprise all things from Brahmā down- wards who are not liberated. Brahmā, Viṣ ṇ u and Rudra are the Lords of the spheres from Pṛ thivi to Māyā; Īśa and Anāśṛ ta Śiva of higher Tattvas; and lastly, Śiva of Śiva-Tattva, which is the ultimate source of, but is Itself beyond, all Kalās. CHAPTER XXI THE GARLAND OF LETTERS OR VARṆ AMĀLĀ WE now speak of “Vāk”—“The Word”—a great concept of the Śāstras. Śruti says: “Four are the steps measured by Vāk. The wise Brāhmana knows them. Three being hidden in the cave do not issue. The fourth is spoken by men in their speech.” The Para-bindu is the Śabda-brahman: for on its differentiation arises the “unmanifest sound” (Avyakta- rava), the Hidden Word from which all manifest speech and the objects which it denotes are derived. This is the state of Supreme Śabda (Para-śabda), the evolution of which (Para-śabda-sṛ ṣ ṭ i) has been shown in the previous Chapters. In its futher development the existence of mind and body is assumed. This has been discussed in the account of the evolution of the objects (Artha-sṛ ṣ ṭ i) which man thinks and in uttered speech names. This Śabdabrahman as appearing in bodies is Kundaliṇ ī-Śakti (Kundaliṇ ī śabdabrahmanayī). The Śāradā-Tilaka says (1-108, 109): Sā prasūte Kundalinī śabdabrahmamayī vibuh. Śaktim ̣ tato dhvanis tasmān nādas tasmān nirodhikā. Tato’ rdhendus tato bindus tasmād āsīt parā tatah. “She who is Kuṇ dalinī, pervading all Śabdabrahman, produces Śakti. From this came Dhvani; from Dhvanī, THE GARLAND OF LETTERS OR VAR Ṇ AMĀLĀ 203 Nāda; from Nāda, Nirodhikā; from Nirodhikā, Ardhendu; from Ardhendu, Bindu; and thence comes Parā.” It will be observed that just as there is a sevenfold cosmic development, it is repeated here in the case of indi- vidual bodies. Kuṇ dalinī is Śabdabrahman, an aspect of Caitanya or Consciousness (Cit). By Śakti is here meant Cit entered into by Sattva (Sattva-praviṣ ṭ ā), which is the Paramākāsāvasthā. By Dhvani is meant that same Cit when entered into by Sattva (Sattvapra- viṣ ṭ ā), penetrated by Rajas (Rajo’nuviddhā), which is Akṣ arāvasthā. By Nāda is meatnt the same Cit pene- trated by Tamas (Tamo’nuviddhā) or Avyaktāvasthā. By Nirodhikā is denoted that same Cit with abundance of Tamas (Tamah-prācuryā); by Ardhendu the same with abundance of Sattva (Sattva-prācuryā). By the term Bindu is denoted that same Cit when in it there is a oombi- nation of the two (Tadubhaya-sam ̣ yogāt). This develop- ment appears to indicate the gradual process whereby Śakti passes through subtle to more gross forms of potency until it reaches that full potency for manifestation which is the Ghanāvasthā State or Bindu in which Kriyā exists in full creative perfection. So it is said, “Moved by the strength of Icchā-śakti (Icchā-śakti-balākṛ ṣ ṭ ah), illumined by Jñāna-śakti (Jñānaśakti-pradipitah),” that Śakti (Sā śaktih) in male form (Pum ̣ rūpiṇ ī) who is the Lord (Prabhu) puts forth Her who is called Action (Kriyākhyā), that is, Kriyā-śakti. The Śāradā then continues: Paśyantī madhyamā vāci vaikharī śabda-janmabhūh. Icchājñanakriyātmā’sau tejo rūpā guṇ ātmikā. Krameṇ āneṇ a srjati Kuṇ dalī varṇ amālikām. “(Then Parā) and then came Paśyantī, Madhyamā and Vaikharī-Śabda. In this order Kuṇ dalī who is Will THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 204 (Icchā), Knowledge (Jñāna) and Action (Kriyā), who is both Light (Tejorūpā, and Cidrūpā; in Herself consciousness) and in the form of the Guṇ as (Guṇ ātmikā, that is, Prakṛ ti) creates the Garland of Letters.” Parā is Śabda as Para-bindu and is motionless (Niṣ - panda). This as already explained becomes threefold and the threefold aspects from the Śabda standpoint are Paśyanti, Madhyamā, Vaikharī. Each of these are manifested forms of the Unmanifested Para-bindu or Śabdabrahman. It is, as Rāghava says, by shifting to an- other place in Her (Asyām ̣ eva binduh sthānāntaragatah) that Bindu which is Parā when unmanifested and motion- less is called Paśyantī, Madbyamā and Vaikharī speech (Vāk). Parā is in the Mūlādhāra cakra, Paśyanti in Svādhiṣ ṭ hāna (and upwards), Madhyamā in Anāhata (and upwards), and Vaikharī in the throat. In Kundalī, Śakti is subtle (Sūkṣ mā) and in the form of mere Light (Jyotir- mātrātmarūpi) and not an object of hearing (Aśrotra- viṣ ayā). Thence She goes upward (Urddhva-gāmiṇ i) and becomes Paśyantī, self-manifesting (Svayam ̣ prakāśā) in the Suṣ u m ̣ nā-Nāḍ ī (Suṣ um ̣ nām ̣ āśritā). She again becomes Madhyamā as a form of Nāda (Nādarūpiṇ ī) when reach- ing the Heart Lotus (Anāhata). Then She goes upward as a mere undifferentiated “hum” (Sam ̣ jalpamātrā avi- bhaktā). It is She who appearing at the chest, throat, teeth, nose, palate and head assumes the form of all letters (Varṇ a) issuing from the root of the tongue and lips, and thus beoomes Vaikharī, the Mother of all sounds, audible to the sense of hearing (Rāghava-Bhatta). The same Com- mentator then says, citing the Kādimata section of Tantra- rāja, “Under the influence of one’s own will (Svātmecchā- śaktighātena) a high (Uttama) form of the Nāda called Para generates in the Mūlādhāra as Prāṇ avāyu (Prāṇ avāyu- svarūpatah). This when carried up by will (Icchā) and THE GARLAND OF LETTERS OR VAR Ṇ AMĀLĀ 205 made to appear in the Svādhiṣ ṭ hāna is called Paśantī associated with Manas. Graaually led up by Her it is called Madhyamā associated with Buddhi in the Anāhata. Carried still further upward it is called Vaikhari in the Viśuddha in the region of the throat. Thence it is generated as the Letters from A to Kṣ a through its presence at the head, throat, palate, lips, teeth, tongue (root, tip and back), nose, palate and throat (together), lips and teeth (together), and throat and lips (together). Their letter-hood (Akṣ aratva) is said to be due to their being divided into different parts beginning with the letter A and ending with Kṣ a.” It is Cit-Śakti which is called Parā, that is to say, it is Parā-Vāk not moved to vibration by the Māyā which reveals (Parāprakāśikā Māyā niṣ pandā) on account of its bearing the reflection of Caitanya (Caitanyābhāsa- viśiṣ tayā). The vibratory states are Paśyantī and the other two (Saspandāvasthāh paśyamtyādyāh). Paśyantī which is in the nature of Bindu (Bindu-tattvātmikā) is the form of a general (that is, not particularised) motion (Sāmānya-praspanda-prakāśarūpiṇ ī), which is manifested in the region between the Mūlādhāra and the Navel (Mūlā- dhārādi-nābhyantara-vyaktisthānā). It is called Paśyantī because of its being Jñāna (Jñānātmakatvāt). It is asso- ciated with Manas. Madhyamā is in the form of the internal and external instruments (Bāhyāntahkaraṇ ātmikā) and manifests as Nādabindu (Nādabindumayī). Hiraṇ ya- garbha sound (Hiraṇ yagarbharūpiṇ ī) is in the region ex- tending from the navel to the heart (Nābhyādi-hṛ dayāntā- bhivyaktisthānā). It is associated with the Tattvas of specific ideation and so forth (Viśeṣ am ̣ kalpādisatattvā.) She is Madhyamā when Buddhi is Madhyamā. Madhyamā is middle, that is, “in the midst” between Paśyantī which is “Seeing” (Īlṣ aṇ a) and Vaikharī which is utterance. She is neither like Paśyantī nor does She proceed outward THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 206 like Vaikharī with articulation fully developed. But She is in the middle between these two. Vaikharī is a form of Bīja (Bījātmikā) as Madhyamā is of Nāda (Nādarūpiṇ ī), and as Paśyantī is of Bindu (Bindvātmikā). Vaikharī is manifested in the region from the heart to the mouth (Hṛ dayādyāsyāntābhivyaktisthānā). It is called Vaikhari according to Rāghava on account of its particular (Viśeṣ a) hardness (Kharatva). Bhāskararāya (Lalitā v. 81) derives it from Vi = very; Khara = hard. According to the Saubhāgya-Sudhodaya, Vai = certainly; Kha = cavity (of the ear): Ra = to go or enter. But according to the Yogaśāstras the Devī who is in the form of Vaikharī (Vaikharīrūpā) is so called because She was produced by the Prāṇ a called Vikhara. This is Virāt-śabda, that is, the manifested letters which singly, or in combination, make certain sounds which are called Mantras. Strictly speaking all uttered sounds are Mantras, all uttered speech having a common origin or development: but in the more usual sense, Mantra means those letters or combination of letters which are used in Upāsanā and Mantrayoga and are the Mantras of the Devatās of Śāstrik worship. The Artha sṛ ṣ ṭ i of Kundaliṇ ī are the Kalās which arise from the letters such as the Rudra and Viṣ ṇ u Mūrtis, their Śaktis and so forth. The root “Man” means “to think” and the suffix “tra” indicates the saving character of Mantra. I have elsewhere spoken of Mantra as “thought-movement vehicled by and expressed in speech” and as being a “power in the form of idea, clothed with sound.” I find that this has led to misunderstanding. I will therefore make my mean- ing clearer. The one supreme Śakti appears in dual aspect as the Word, the Sense by which as uttered sound it is heard, and as the Object or Artha which the word denotes. The cbiId is taught the meaning of words. Such THE GARLAND OF LETTERS OR VAR Ṇ AMĀLĀ 207 and such an object is pointed out as being indicated by a word. But a Mantra is the Devatā. The Sādhaka is taught who that Devatā is. He does not however at once see that Devatā. At this stage the Devatā exists for him clothed with or as an audible sound, which evokes a parti- cular thought-movement or transformation of mental sub- stance. The next stage is by Mantra-Sādhanā to realise that Devatā; to know it not only as a word and its mental counterpart, but as a form of that Power of which they are but a faint reflection in the world of mind and matter. That Power is infinitely greater than either, and the Mantra is a particular form of Devatā vehicled as all else in the world by mind and matter. The power by which the Devatā is realised is also Śakti, that is, Sādhana-Śakti, that is again the power of the individual Sādhaka to realise by Sādhana. The Devatā whom he is taught to realise is infinitely greater than that. All is Śakti, but what is sought to be realised is Śakti Herself presented to the Sādhaka in the Mantra form. Brahman is of course in all things as their substance and all forms of becoming are without exception Śakti. But these forms are only Śakti as such. As such limited forms we realise them at once. For this we require mind, senses, and attention only in their functioning. But the Devatā, which the Mantra is, cannot be realised in this way only, since in Itself (that is other than as the sound heard, and the idea it evokes) it is not an object in the ordinary material universe. The Sādhaka has to pierce through the vehicle of the audible Śabda and realise the Devatā whose form the Mantra is. He is enabled to do this by the co-operation of the Mantra- Śakti with his own Sādhana-Śakti. The latter gives to those who exert their own power (Sādhana-Śakti) the ability to achieve. At length and by striving, the Con- sciousness which manifests as Sādhana-Śakti unites both, THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 208 and the Consciousness, which is the Devatā, is thus realis- ed and in this sense appears to the Sādhaka. This is the Saguṇ a, or Vācaka form of Devatā, and this when realised at length procures for the Sādhaka a realisation of the Vācyā-Śakti which the Saguṇ a-Devatā indicates. In short the Devī or Supreme Śakti has two “forms,” Her gross (Sthūla) Saguṇ a form as Mantra (Mantramayī) and Her subtle (Sūkṣ ma) form as “light” (Jyotirmayī). Realisation is the passage from that indirect knowing, through word and its mental counterpart, to that direct knowledge which is union with the Devatā whose form a particular Mantra is. Śabdabrahman is all-pervading, undifferentiated Śakti, and Mantra is Its particular manifestation. It is Varṇ āt- maka-śabda (Lettered sound) manifested by Ākāśa caused by the contact of the surrounding air with the vocal organs, the formation of which in speech is in response to the mental movement or idea, which by the will thus seeks outward expression as audible sound. All Śabda has its corresponding Artha, for neither can be dissociated from the other. The word “Artha” comes from the root “Ri” which means to get, to know, to enjoy. Artha is that which is denoted by Śabda and is that which is known and enjoyed. This Artha is either subtle (Sūkṣ ma) or gross (Sthūla). The latter is the outer physical object which speech denotes and the former is the Vṛ tti (modification) of the mind which corresponds to the gross Artha: for as an object is perceived the mind forms itself into a Vṛ tti which is the exact mental counterpart of the object perceived. The mind has thus two aspects, in one of which it is the per- ceiver (Grāhaka) and in the other the perceived (Grāhya) in the shape of the mental impression. That aspect of the mind which cognises is called Śabda or Nāma (name) and that aspect in which it is its own object or cognised is called Artha or Rūpa (Form), Śabda being associated with all THE GARLAND OF LETTERS OR VAR Ṇ AMĀLĀ 209 mental operation. In the evolution of the universe the undifferentiated Śabda divides itself into subtle Śabda and subtle Artha which then evolve into gross Śabda and gross Artha. For the Cosmic Mind projects its subtle Artha on to the sensuous plane which is then a physical gross Artha named in spoken speech. Thus the subtle Śabda associated with cognition is called Mātṛ kā and the subtle Artha is the mental impression; whilst the gross Śabdas are the uttered letters (Varṇ a) denoting the gross ouher physical object (Sthūla-Artha). Just as the body is causal, subtle, gross, and as there are three cosmic and individual states, dreamless sleep, dreaming, waking; Prājña, Taijasa, Viśva; Īśvara, Hiraṇ ya- garbha, Vaiśvānasa or Virāt; and a fourth transcendent state or Turīya; so there are three states (Bhāva) of sound Paśyantī, Madhyamā, Vaikharī developed from a fourth supreme and undifferentiated state (Parā). This last and Paśyantī represent the causal aspect of Śabda, for Paśyantī is the actual moving aspect of the unmoving Parā. Madhyamā is Hiraṇ yagarbhaśabda. This Sūksma-śabda and its corresponding Artha belong to the subtle body (Lin ̣ ga-Śarīra). In creation the Cosmic Mind first develops Paśyanti-śabda and Artha, and then projects this subtle Artha into the world of sensuous experience and names it in spoken speech developed in the throat and issuing from the mouth. Vaikharī is Virāt-śabda belonging, as well as the physical objects it denotes, to the gross body (Sthūla- Śarīrā). This last Gross Śabda is language, that is, sen- tences (Vākya), words (Pada) and letters (Varṇ a) which are the expressions of ideas and Mantra. Paśyanti is charac- terised by non-particular general movement (Sāmāya- spanda), the first undefined push of the Vāyu towards manifestation; Madhyamā is speoifio movement (Viśeṣ - spanda), the Vāyu commencing to differentiate; and Vaikharī THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 210 is Spaṣ tatara-spanda, that is, the clear separate movements of artioulate speech. Mental Artha is a Sam ̣ skāra, an im- pression left on the subtle body by previous experience and which is recalled when the Jīva re-awakes to world-experi- ence and re-collects the experience temporarily lost in the cosmic dreamless state (Suṣ upti) which is dissolution (Pralaya). The Cause (Kāraṇ a) which arouses this Sam ̣ s- kāra is the Śabda or Nāma, subtle or gross, corresponding to that particular Artha. There is thus a double line of creation from the Śabda-brahman, namely, language expres- sive of ideas and the objects which these denote. Uttered speech is a manifestation of the inner “naming” or thought which is similar in men of all races. Possibly for this reason a thought-reader whose cerebral centre is en rapport with that of another may read the hidden “speech,” that is, the thought of one whose spoken speech he cannot under- stand. Vaikharī-śabda however differs in various races owing to racial and climatic conditions, the physical for- mation of the vocal organs and so forth. But for each particular man speaking any particular language, the uttered name of any object is the gross expression of his inner thought movement. It evokes that movement and again expresses it. It evokes the idea and that idea is conscious- ness as mental operation. That operation can be so in- tensified as to make itself creative. This is Mantra-caitanya when thought is not only in the outer husk but is vitalised through its conscious centre. The above is but the Mantra way of saying that the homogeneous Consciousness differentiates as Śakti and ap- pears as subject (Śabda) and object (Artha), at first in the subtle form of mind and its contents generated by the Sam ̣ skāra and then in the gross form of language as the expression of ideas and of physical objects (Artha), which the creative or Cosmic Mind projects into the world of THE GARLAND OF LETTERS OR VAR Ṇ AMĀLĀ 211 sensuous experience to be the source of impressions to the individual experiencer therein. The natural name of any thing is the sound which is produced by the action of the moving forces which constitute it. He therefore, it is said, who mentally or vocally utters with creative force the natural name of anything brings into being the thing which bears that name. Thus “Ram ̣ ” is the Bīja of fire; and is said to be the expression in gross sound (Vaikharī-śabda) of the subtle sound produced by the activity of, and which is, the subtle fire-force. The mere utterance however of “Ram ̣ ” or any other Mantra is nothing but a movement of the two lips. When however the Mantra is awakened (Prabuddha), that is, when there is Mantra-caitanya, then the Sādhaka can make the Mantra work. However this may be, in all cases it is the creative thought which ensouls the uttered sound which works now in man’s small magic, just as it first worked in the grand magical display of the World-Creator. His thought was the aggregate, with crea- tive power, of all thought. Each man is Śiva and can attain His power to the degree of his ability to consciously realise himself as such. Mantra and Devatā are one and the same. By Japa the presence of the latter is invoked. Japa or repetition of Mantra is compared to the action of a man shaking a sleeper to wake him up. The two lips are Śiva and Śakti. Their movement is the coition (Maithuna) of the two. Śabda which issues herefrom is in the nature of Bindu. The Devatā thus produced is as it were the son of the Sādhaka. It is not the Supreme Devatā (who is actionless) who appears, but in all cases an emanation produced by the Sādhaka for his benefit only. The Boy-Śiva (Bāla-Śiva) who thus appears is then made strong by the nurture which the Sādhaka gives to his crea- tion. The occultist will understand all such symbolism to mean that the Devatā is a form of the consciousness of THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 212 the pure Sādhaka, which the latter arouses and strengthens and gains good thereby. It is his consciousness which becomes Bāla-Śiva and which when strengthened is the full-grown Divine Power Itself. All Mantras are in the body as forms of consciousness (Vijñānarūpa). When the Mantra, is fully practised, it enlivens the Sam ̣ skāra and the Artha appears to the mind. Mantras are thus a form of the Sam ̣ skaras of Jīvas—the Artha of which appears to the consciousness which is pure. The essence of all this is—concentrate and vitalise thought and will-power. But for such a purpose a method is necessary, namely, language and determined varieties of practice according to the end sought. These Mantra-vidyā (which explains what Mantra is) also enjoins. For thought in the sense previously stated, words (gross or subtle) are necessary. Mantra-vidyā is the science of thought and of its expres- sion in language as evolved from. the Logos or Śabda- brahman Itself. It is in this sense that the universe is said to be com- posed of the Letters. It is the fifty (or as some count them fifty-one) Letters of the Sanskrit alphabet which are denoted by the Garland of severed heads which the naked Mother Kālī, dark like a threatening rain cloud, wears as She stands amidst bones and carrion, beasts and birds, in the burning ground, on the white corpse-like (Śavarūpa) body of Śiva. For it is She who “slaughters,” that is, withdraws all speeoh and its objects into Herself at the time of the dissolution of all things (Mahā-pralaya). From Her in Her aspect of Mahā-kuṇ dalī coiled round the Śiva-bindu they are derived. Mahā-kuṇ dalī when with one coil is Bindu; with two Prakṛ ti-Puruṣ a; with three the three Śaktis (Icchā, Jñāna, Kriyā and the three Guṇ as, Rajas, Sattva, Tamas); with three and a half She is then actually creative (Sṛ ṣ ṭ yunmukhi) with Vikṛ ti. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS OR VAR Ṇ AMĀLĀ 213 Then with four coils and so on up to 51. She is according to the Śakti-sam ̣ gama-Tantra (Utpatti-Khanda, Ullāsa 1), Ekajatā, Ugratārā, Siddhakālī, Kālasundarī, Bhūvaneśvarī, Caṇ dikeśavrī, Daśamahāvidyā (ten coils), Smaśāna-kālikā, Candabhairavī, Kāmatārā, Vaśikaraṇ akālikā, Pañcadaśī, Ṣ oḍ aśī, Chinnamastā, Mahāmadhumatī, Mahāpadmāvatī, Ramā, Kāmasundarī, Dakṣ iṇ akālīkā, Vidyeśī, Gāyatri (24 coils), Pañcamī, Ṣ aṣ ṭ hī, Mahāratneśvarī, Mūlasañjīvanī, Paramākalā, Mahānīlasarasvatī, Vasudhārā, Trailokya- mohinī, Trailokyavijayā, Mahākāmatāriṇ ī, Aghorā, Samita- mohinī, Bagalā, Arundhatī, Annapūrṇ ā, Nakulī, Trikaṇ - takī, Rājeśvarī, Trailokyākarśinī, Rājarājeśvarī, Kukkutī, Siddhavidyā, Mṛ tyuhāriṇ i, Mahābhagavatī, Vāsavī, Phet- kārī, Mahāśrīmātṛ sundarī, and Śrimātṛ kotpattisundari (coils 51) respectively. Each coil is said to represent the Mātṛ kā or subtle form of the letters (Varṇ a) and to denote the number of Kūtas or divisons in the Mantras of each of these Devatās. Mahākuṇ dali coiled round the Śiva-bindu, as it were a mathematical line without magnitude, makes with it one point. When the time for creation comes She uncoils Herself and creates the whole universe in the form of the Letters and the objects which they denote. Having so created it, She again rests as Kuṇ dalī in the root centre of the body (Mūlādhāra) of all living creatures from which She issues as Paśyantī, Madhyamā, and Vaikharī Śabda. Man’s body is called in the Tantras a microcosm (Kṣ udra-brah- mānda), containing within itself all which is in the uni- verse (Mahā-brahmāṇ da) of which it is a part. The Yoginī- hṛ daya-Tantra (Chap. I. 36) says that, when Śakti first “sees” (that is, ideates), She is Paramā-Kalā in the Mother form (Am ̣ bikārūpa) which is both supreme Peace (Paramā-Śāntā) and Supreme Speech (Parā-vāk). She sees the manifested Śabda from Paśyantī to Vaikharī. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 214 The Paśyantī state is that in which Will (Icchā-śakti) is about to display the universe then in seed (Bīja) form. This is the Śakti-Vāmā. Madhyamā-Vāk which is know- ledge (Jñāna) is Jyeṣ thā. Here there is the first assumption of form as the Mātṛ kā (Mātṛ kātvam ̣ -āpanna), for here is particular motion (Viśeṣ a-spanda). The Vaikharī state is that of Kriyā-Śakti (action) whose form is that of the gross universe. As the former Śakti produces the subtle letters or Mātṛ kā which are the Vāsanā, so the latter is the Śakti of the gross letters (Varṇ a) of words and their objects. These letters form the Garland of the Mother (Varṇamālā), issuing from Her as Kuṇ dali and absorbed by Her in the Yoga, which bears Her name. As the Yoga-kuṇ dalī-Upaniṣ ad says: “That Vāk (Power of speech or Logos) which sprouts in Parā, gives forth leaves in Paśyantī, buds in Madhyamā, and blossoms in Vaikharī. By reversing the above order sound is absorbed. Whoever realises the great Lord of Vāk, the undifferentiated illumining Self is unaffected by any word (Śabda), be it what it may.” As the Haṭ ha-yoga-pradīpikā (IV. 101-102) concisely says: “Whatever is heard in the form of sound is Śakti. The absorbed state (Laya) of the Tattvas (Prakṛ ti’s evolutes) is that in which no sound exists. So long as there is the notion of Ether, so long is the sound (that is, vibration) heard. The soundless is called Parabrahman or Paramātmā.” Śabda-brahman is thus the Brahman in its aspect as the cause of the mani- fested Śabdārtha. It is the ideating kinetic aspect of the undifferentiated Ether of Consciousness, the Cidākāśa of Philosophy and the Saguṇ a-Brahman of worship. It is Cit-Śakti vehioled by undifferentiated Mayā-Śakti or the manifesting Godhead untreated, unborn, eternal, evol- ving the changing worlds of name and form (Nāma-rūpa) by its wondrous and unscrutable Māyā. Therefore, as Caṇ di THE GARLAND OF LETTERS OR VAR Ṇ AMĀLĀ 215 says, “Reverence to Her Who is eterndy Raudrī, Gaurī, Dhātrī, reverence and again reverence; to Her who is the Consciousness in all beings, reverence and again reverence.” CHAPTER XXII OM ̣ THE ancient Hindus had an aptitude, much to be appre- ciated in these often verbose days, of saying a great deal in a few words. The Mantra “Om ̣ ” is an instance. For this short syllable contains a whole philosophy which many volumes would not suffice to state—an Eastern philosophy, I may add, which is gaining increased support from Western science. These two will be before long reconciled when the latter has cast aside what a friend calls its “habit blinkers.” The beneficial result will, it is hoped, be a science which is religious, and a religion which is scientific. The Mantra “Oṃ ” is composed of three letters— A, U, M,—of which the first two vowels coalesce into O. Over the Om ̣ is written the sign Candra-bindu or Nāda and Bindu, shown as a crescent with a dot or point over it. Nāda and Bindu are two of many aspects of That which in India is called the Mother, or great Power, (Mahāśakti), as it was by the near East called Magna Mater and by the Gnostics Megale Dunamis. This is both the efficient and material Cause of the universe which is Its form or body. Nāda, is the Mantra name for the first going forth of Power which gathers itself together in massive strength (Ghanī- bhūta) as Bindu to create the universe, and which Bindu, as so creating, differentiates into a Trinity of Energies which are symbolised by A, U, M. Nāda and Bindu thus repre- sent the unmanifested “fourth” (Turīya) state, immediately OM ̣ 217 before the manifestion of the world, in which animate life exists in the three conditions of dreamless sleep, dream, and waking. Man always anthropomorphises. In the West he calls the Creator the Father. More aptly Supreme Crea- tive Being in the East and by the Śāktas is called the Mother, for this Power conceives in Its Wombs, which is Consciousness, gives birth to and nourishes, the Universe. The first Mantra into which a child is initiated is Mā or Mother, for that is its first word, and Mother is often the last word on the lips of the dying. Reverence to the natural Mother is reverence to the Mother of all and they who in life and at death drink the milk of that Mother attain to Her. Moreover in the world the Mother-aspect of Her who is Brahman is alone fully manifested. What She is in Herself (Svarūpa) is not known to mind or senses. The Yogini-hṛ daya-Tantra says: “What man knows the heart of a woman? Only Śiva knows the Heart of Yoginī.” This is the Cosmic Heart of the universe whose systole and diastole is the going forth and return of millions of worlds. This process Brāhmanism calls Pravṛ tti and Nivṛ tti and Taoism (which is perhaps a Chinese adaptation of the doctrine of the Upaniṣ ads) names it Yang and Yinn. Rela- tively to man’s knowledge the Supreme Power is said to be in Itself Being (Sat), Consciousness (Cit) and Bliss (Ānanda). The Primordial Power or Ādyā Śakti is incon- ceivably beyond manifested personality, for this is limited experience hedged in by mind and matter. Though not in Itself a Person as we understand that term, It is ever personalizing in the form of all individual (Vyaṣ ti) things in the world. It is also a Person as the aggregate (Samaṣ ti) of all such personalities. Whilst infinite, it con- tains in Itself the sum of all human and other experience. Whilst the Power (Mahā-śakti) is in Itself beyond mind and senses in that darkness (as man thinks it to be) THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 218 which is the body of Mahākālī, its manifestations are seen. It is with reference to such manifestation inferred to be the Radical Vital Potential which is, as it were, the thread (Sūtrātmā) of the whole series of beings, which form one Vital Continuity, a principle on which Indian Monistic philosophy is based. Nothing has an absolute commence- ment or end. All is transformed. Birth and death are modes thereof. Each existence is as it were a knot tied in an infinite rope which knot is made at birth and untied at death. Something does not come from nothing, and something never becomes nothing. An absolute beginning or end is inconceivable. Particular universes come into being and go. Birth, life and death are modes of the universal transformahion governing all organic life “from a blade of grass to Brahmā Himself.” The divine infini- tude is ever such, but appears as limited function and its effects, and as apparently discontinuous, because of the limitation of the senees which perceive its workings. The whole Fact is never present to consciousness, but only that section to which pragmatic attention is for the moment given, and which therefore appears localised and in suocession of time. Nevertheless there is an infinite Vital Continuity stretching from the Radical Potential to its actualisation as the crust of matter, which is but an infinitesimal portion of the effect produced by the function of Substance relative to the whole universal efficiency. For ether (Ākāśa) is more continuous than matter which is but the outer crust of the Central Power. Ether is continuous and all pervading and is said to be more than a thousand times denser than gross ponderable matter. The visible earth is therefore but a microscopic point evolved by the Vital Power (Śakti) of substance (Śiva) in the midst of the invisible, perpetually active, but in its own nature (Svarūpa) unaffected Divine Substance pervading all OM ̣ 219 space. Therein nothing truly exists independently of an- other but all are transformations of the one Power. And as that Power is Itself vital and creative, its products or rather transformations of Itself are that. As It is Being with the potentialities of all life in form, none of its manifestations are “dead,” though in common parlance we concede “life” only to that which displays evolutionary growth. The search therefore for the origin of life is futile, since life is eternal and had no beginning. All things are part of the one Mother who is Life itself. It displays itself in innumerabIe forms, but the vastest generalisation of Its working discloses three movements of creative upbuilding, of destructive disintegration and the holding of these two opposing forces in equilibrium. Nāda- bindu differentiates into the Trinity of Will (Icchā), Knowledge (Jñāna) and Action (Kriyā), “Sun,” “Moon,” and “Fire,” and this self-explicating Power manifests in matter in the threefold manner described. These three Powers are A. U. M. or the Devatās Brahmā, Viṣ ṇ u, Rudra. These are not “Gods.” There is only one God. They are Devas or “Shining ones,” being aspects and specific mani- festations of the One Divine Power whose Feet (in the words of Śāstra) even Brahmā, Viṣ ṇ u and Rudra worship. They are scientific concepts deified, and rightly so, for their content refers to aspects of the Supreme Power which is God. Scientifically they stand for the three functions of Vital Substance. It is incorrect to suppose that God in His aspect as Brahmā created the world some millions of years ago and has since done nothing, or that He in His form as Rudra has as yet had no opportunity of displaying His power of dissolution. Brahmā is always creating and recreating the elements of manifested substance which Rudra is ever breaking down. Throughout Nature there are these twin forces upbuilding and destroying forms, THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 220 integrating and disintegrating, anabolism and catabolism tending to change and conservation of tissues and so on. The three aspects A, U, M, of the Primordial Power (Nāda- bindu) are always operating. Whilst Rudra is, by chemical destruction, breaking down the combinations of matter and thus working towards the final dissolution of things, that is the disintegration of forms into either its more general elements (Mahābhūta) or into the formless substance (Prakṛ ti) the material Cause of all, Brahmā creates it anew by His ever rejuvenescent molecular activity, thus rescuing organised vitality from the processes which are ever at work to consume its forms. Viṣ ṇ u again is the power which stabilises matter in the midst of these conflicting forces and thus maintains all Existences. Things only possess relative stability. So it is that the Power of Rudra works its purpose at the end. Matter itself is only a relatively stable form of Energy from which as Supreme Will it appears and into which, on the attainment of its terminal state, it again merges. It is Viṣ ṇ u who holds it together in equilibrium. Again leaving individual existences and looking at the sum total of manifested Energy, Viṣ ṇ u, the Maintainer, throughout Space and Time, is a theological statement of the general Conservation of Energy. To these intuited laws and truths objective science is giving increas- ing support. In this sense “Om ̣ ” is the Pratika or repre- sentative of the Radical Vital Potential of the Universe and of the Trinity of Energies by which It actualises and materialises Itself as the five forms of “matter” (though Ether is not ponderable matter), namely ethereal (Ākāśa), aerial (Vāyu), fiery (Agni), liquid (Ap) and solid (Pṛ thivī). Through worship of and meditation on this Pratika, with all its implications, man, according to Advaita-Vedānta, realises himself as the one vital Śakti who is the Mother of all. CHAPTER XXIII THE NECKLACE OF KĀLĪ THE world has never been altogether without the Wisdom— the Mūla Veda nor its teachers. The degree and manner in which it has been imparted have, however, necessarily varied according to the capabilities of men to receive it. So also have the symbols by which it has been conveyed. These symbols further have varying significance according to the spiritual advancement of the worshipper. This question of degree and variaty of presentation have led to the superficial view that difference in beliefs negatives the existence of any commonly established Truth. But if the matter be regarded more deeply, it will be seen that whilst there is one essential Wisdom its revelation has been more or less complete according to the symbols evolved by, and therefore, fitting to, particular racial temperaments and characters. Symbols are naturally misunderstood by those to whom the beliefs they typifiy are unfamiliar, and who differ in temperament from those who have evolved them. To the ordinary Western mind the symbols of Hinduims are often repulsive and absurd. It must not, however, be forgotten that some of the symbols of Western Faiths have the same effect on the Hindu. From the picture of the “Slain Lamb,” and other symbols in terms of blood and death, he naturally shrinks in disgust. The same effect on the other hand is not seldom produced in the Western at the sight of the terrible forms in which India has embodied THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 222 Her vision of the undoubted Terrors which exist in and around us. All is not smiling in this world. Even amongst persons of the same race and indeed of the same faith we may observe such differences. Before the Catholic Cultus of the “Sacred Heart” had overcome the opposition which it at first encountered, and for a considerable time after, its imagery was regarded with aversion by some who spoke of it in terms which would to-day be counted as shocking irreverence. These differences are likely to exist so long as men vary in mental attitude and temperament, and until they reach the stage in which, having discovered the essen- tial truths, they become indifferent to the mode in which they are presented. We must also in such matters distin- guish between what a symbol may have meant and what it now means. Until quite recent times the English peasant folk and others danced around the flower-wreathed Maypole. That the pole originally (like other similar forms) repre- sented the great Linga admits of as little doubt as that these folk, who in recent ages danced around it, were ignorant of that fact. The Bishop’s mitre is said to be the head of a fish worn by ancient near-eastern hierophants. But what of that? It has no such associations now. Let us illustrate these general remarks by a short study of one portion of the Kālī symbolism which affects so many, who are not Hindus, with disgust or horror. Kālī is the Deity in that aspect in which It withdraws all things which It had created into Itself. Kālī is so called because She devours Kāla (Time) and then resumes Her own dark formlessness. The Mahānirvāṇ a-Tantra says (IV. 30-34) of the Supreme Mother: “Thou the supreme Yoginī: moved by His mere will doth create, maintain and withdraw the world with all that moves and is motionless therein, Mahā-kāla (Great Time) the Dissolver of the universe is THE NECKLACE OF KĀLĪ 223 Thy form. At the dissolution of things it is Kāla (Time) who will devour all and by reason of this He is called Mahā-kāla and since Thou devourest Mahā-kāla Himself it is Thou who art called the Supreme Primordial Kālīkā. “Because Thou devourest Kāla, Thou art called Kālī and because Thou art the origin of and devourest all things Thou art called the Ādyā-Kālī. Resuming after Dissolution Thine own nature dark and formless, Thou alone remainest as One, Ineffable, and Inconceivable. Though appearing in form Thou art yet formless; though Thyself without beginning, multiform by the Power of Māyā, Thou art the beginning of all, Creatrix, Protectress and Destructress that Thou art .” From Her then, in Her nature one with Śiva—the state which is Aśabda, issue all letters and words (Śabda) and the world of things (Artha) which they denote. Into Her as Kālī they are dissolved. The scene is laid in the cremation ground (Śmaśāna) amidst white sun-dried bones and fragments of flesh, gnawed and pecked at by carrion beasts and birds. Here the “heroic” (Vira) worshipper (Sādhaka) performs at dead of night his awe-inspiring rituals. Kālī is set in such a scene for She is that aspect of the Great Power which withdraws all things into Herself at, and by, the dissolution of the universe. He alone worships withou fear, who has abandoned all worldly desires, and seeks union with Her as the One Blissful and Perfect Experience. On the burning ground all worldly desires are burnt away. She is naked and dark like a threatening rain-cloud. She is dark, for She who is Herself beyond mind and speech, reduces all things into that worldly “nothingness,” which as the Void (Śūnya) of all which we now know, is at the same time the All (Pūrṇ a) which is Light and Peace. She is naked, being clothed in space alone (Digam ̣ barī), because THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 224 the Great Power is unlimited; further She is in Herself beyond Māyā (Māyātītā); that Power of Herself with which She covers Her own nature and so creates all universes. She stands upon the white corpse-like (Śavarūpa) body of Śiva. He is white, because He is the illuminating (Pra- kāśa) transcendental aspect of Consciousness. He is inert because He is the changeless aspect of the Supreme, and She the apparently changing aspect of the same. In truth She and He are one and the same, being twin aspects of the One who is changelessness in, and exists as, change. Much might be said in explanation of these and other symbols such as Her loosened hair, the lolling tongue, the thin stream of blood which trickles from the corners of the mouth, the position of Her feet, the apron of dead men’s hands around Her waist, Her implements and so forth. Here I take only the garland of freshly-severed heads which hangs like a Varṇ amālā low from Her neck. Some have conjectured that Kālī was originally the Goddess of the dark-skinned inhabitants of the Vindhya Hills taken over by the Brāhmanas into their worship. One of them has thought that She was a deified Prin- cess of these folk, who fought against the white incoming Aryans. He pointed to the significant fact that the severed heads are those of white men. The Western may say that Kālī was an objectification of the Indian mind, making a Divinity of the Power of Death. An Eastern may reply that She is the Sam ̣ keta (symbol) which is the effect of the impress of a Spiritual Power on the Indian mind. I do not pause to consider these matters here. The question before us is, what does this imagery mean now, and what has it meant for centuries past to the initiate in Her symbolism? An esoteric explanation describes this Garland as made up of the heads of Demons, which She as a power of righteousness, has conquered. THE NECKLACE OF KĀLĪ 225 According to an inner explanation given in the Indian Tantra-Śāstra this string of heads is the Garland of Letters (Varṇ amālā), that is the fifty, and as some count it, fifty-one letters, of the Sanskrit Alphabet. The same interpretation is given in the Buddhist Demchog Tantra in respect of the Garland worn by the great Heruka. (See Śri Cakra Sambhara—A Buddhist Tantra). These letters represent the universe of names and forms (Nāma-rūpa) that is Speech (Śabda) and its meaning or object (Artha). She, the Devourer of all, “slaughters,” that is, withdraws, both into Her undivided Consciousness at the Great dis- solution of the Universe. She wears the letters which She as Creatrix, bore. She wears the Letters which, She, as the Dissolving Power, takes to Herself again. A very profound doctrine is connected with these Letters, which space prevents me from fully entering into here. I have set it out elsewhere in greater detail. The movements of Her creative projection are indicated by the Letters subtile and gross which exist on the Petals of the inner bodily centres or Lotuses. Very shortly stated, Śabda which literally means Sound—here lettered sound—is in its causal state (Para- śabda) known as “Supreme Speech” (Parā-Vāk). This is the Śabda-brahman or Logos; that aspect of Reality or Consciousness (Cit) in which It is the immediate cause of creation; that is of the dichotomy in Conscious- ness which is “I” and “This,” subject and object, mind and matter. This condition of causal Śabda is the Cosmic Dreamless State (Suṣ upti). This Logos awakening from Its Causal Sleep “sees” that is, creatively ideates the universe, and is then known as Paslyanti-Śabda. As Consciousness “sees” or ideates, forms arise in the Crea- tive Mind, which are themselves impressions (Sam ̣ skāra) carried over from previous worlds, which ceased to exist THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 226 as such when the universe entered the state of causal dreamless sleep on the previous dissolution. These rearise as the formless Consciousness awakes to enjoy once again sensuous life in the world of forms. The Cosmic Mind is at first itself both cognising sub- ject (Grāhaka) and cognised object (Grāhya); for it has not yet projected its thought into the plane of Matter: the mind as subject-cogniser is Śabda and the mind as the object cognised, that is the mind in the form of ob- ject is subtle Artha. This Śabda called Madhyamā-Śabda is an “Inner Naming” or “Hidden Speech.” At this stage, that which answers to the spoken letters (Varṇ a) are the “Little Mothers” or Mātrikā, the subtle forms of gross speech. There is at this stage a differentiation of Consciousness into subject and object but the latter is now within and forms part of the self. This is the state of Cosmic Dreaming (Svapna). The Cosmic Mind then projects these mental images on to the material plane and there they become materialised as gross physical objects (Sthūla Artha) which make impressions from without on the mind of the created consoiousness. This is the cosmic waking stage (Jagrat). At this last stage the thought- movement expresses itself through the vocal organs in con- tact with the air as uttered speech (Vaikhari-Śabda) made up of letters, syllables and sentences. This lettered sound is manifested Śabda or Name (Nāma) and the physical objects denoted by speech are the gross Artha or Form (Rūpa). This manifested speech varies in men, for their indi- vidual and racial characteristics and the conditions, such as country and climate in which they live differ. There is a tradition that there was once a universal speech before the building of the Tower of Babel, signifying the con- fusion of tongues. Of these letters and names and their THE NECKLACE OF KĀLĪ 227 meaning or objects, that is concepts and concepts objecti- fied the whole Universe is composed. When Kālī withdraws the world, that is the names and forms which the Letters signify, the dualism in consciousness, which is creation, vanishes. There is neither “I” (Aham ̣ ) nor “This” (Idam ̣ ) but the one non-dual Perfect Experience which Kālī in Her own true nature (Svarūpa) is. In this way Her Garland is understood. “Surely” I hear it said “not by all. Does every Hindu worshipper think such profundities when he sees the figure of Mother Kālī?” Of course not, no more than, (say) an ordinary Italian peasant knows of, or can understand, the subtleties of either the Catholic mystics or Doctors of theology. When, however, the Western undertakes to depict and explain Indian symbolism, he should, in the interest both of knowledge and fairness, understand what it means both to the high as well as to the humble wor- shipper. Salutation is thus made to Her from whom the mind and its thoughts proceed and the language (Vāk) in which they are expressed. Vāk is Prakāśa, the illu- minating consciousness, and Artha is Vimarśa its object. Vāk is in the form of Varṇ a (letters), Pada (syllables) Mantra. Artha is Kalā, Tattva, and Bhuvana the other so called Adhvās. (See Ch. XXVII). Out of Vāk and Artha the whole world, consisting of six Adhāvas (Ṣ adadhvāt- maka) originated. Round the neck of Kālī the Letters (Varṇ a) which make the syllables (Pada) and Mantra are hung. In Her they are dissolved in the fiery ending of the worlds. CHAPTER XXIV DHVANI MOTION may be either produced or unproduced. The latter is the causal stress itself, and the former the effect of it. In the world, sound is produced by the contact of one thing with another—of (say) the hand and the drum in case of unlettered sound and the vocal organs and air in the case of uttered speech. Causal stress itself is uncreate, is self- produced and not caused by the striking of one thing against another. For this reason it is called Anāhata. This Anāhata- Śabda which is Brahman-movement is heard in the heart which It has produced and which It causes to pulse, a movement which we can feel and hear. This uncreated self-existing Śabda as causal stress manifests in double form as unlettered sound or Dhvani and is thus called Dhvanyātmaka-Śabda and as lettered sound or Varna which is Varṇ ātmaka-Śabda. And so the Bhāṣ āpariccheda says (164, 165): Śabdo dhavanisca varṇ asca mṛ dan ̣ gādibhavo dhvanih. Kaṇ ṭ ha-sam ̣ yoga-janmāno varṇ āste kādayo matāh. That is Śabda is of two kinds—Dhvani and Varna. The first is illustrated in the south given forth by a drum and the like. In the production of the second the throat organ is exercised and it is manifested as Ka, Kha and the other letters of the Alphabet. That is in certain sounds such as the beating of a drum, the roar of thunder, the DHVANI 229 sounds of laughing, crying and so forth no letters appear to be manifested (Varṇ aviśeṣ ānabhivyañjaka) but that in certain others, letters or Varṇ as are manifested as in the case of sounds of articulate speech. The former class are called Dhvanis and the latter Varṇ as. In both cases it is to be observed that sound is produced by the clashing (Abhigāta) of two created things, viz., the drum and the hand or drumstick and the vocal organs in contact with the ciroumambient air. The distinction therefore between the two classes does not depend upon this—(1) that whilst Varṇ as are produced by the mutual impact of the throat, air, and the ear, the Dhvanis are produced by an assemblage of conditions of which the throat is not one. In other words the Vyāpāra or functioning of the vocal organ does not constitute the distinction between Dhvanyātmaka and Varṇ ātmaka-Śabda. For the vocal organ is exercised in laughing, crying and so forth and also in the cries of animals, but in them we hear no Varṇ ātmaka-Śabda or srticulate speech. Thus Dhvanis may be produced by the vocal organs. (2) Nor can it be said that the exercise of the vocal organs is the sinie qua non of the Varṇ ātmaka-Śabda. Thus when we hear arti- culate sounds over the telephone or from the gramophone, the immediate cause of the sound is not the Vyāpāra of the vocal organ; though the non-immediate cause may be so. (3) Nor again can we say that the Varnātmaka-Śabdas are in all cases significant or expressive of meanings and that the Dhvanyātmakas are in all cases insignificant. In a general sense this is so, and thus, in common parlance, we speak of Varṇ ātmaka-Śabda as having a meaning and Dhvani as being without it. But this is not necessarily and always so. Doubtless to Īśvara every Dhvani has a meaning, and even to us unlettered sound may express a meaning. Again some Varṇ ātmaka-Śabdas may not. For THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 230 even to a man who knows a particular language any combi- nation of letters or any combinations of words will not be expressive language—but only letters in certain order and combination. Thus the sound of laughter or crying is Dhvanyātmaka yet the sound may express a meaning in the sense that it is recognised at once from the sound that a particular person is happy or in trouble. Many of the Dhvanis of animals may be significant in this sense. The sound of a bell, bugle, or drum may be suggestive of mean- ing as in the case of the midday gun. On the other hand many Var ṇ ātmakas may not express a meaning. Thus the combination M, A, N has a meaning and spells “man” in English but M, N, A and other combinations (except N, A, M which may have some sort of meaning) do not express meaning. Each letter separately may have a mean- ing. According to the Vyāsa-Bhāsya on Yoga, each Varṇ ā is capable of expressing all Arthas or meanings. But any arbitrary combination of separate letters will not give a meaning. A special comhinstion of Varṇ as is necessary to express a special meaning. Electricity may be latent in all material objects but we require to make special combi- nations of such objects (e.g., zinc, copper and sulphuric acid in a cell) to make such electricity patent. Any arbitrary combinations (e.g., of wood, water, and oil) will not effect this. In an unsuitable combination of Varṇ as, their Śaktis check the one the other. The distinction between the two classes is therefore a distinction between sounds which manifest themselves as letters and others which do not. The former are usually produced by the throat (Kaṇ ṭ ha-sam ̣ yoga-janmānah) but not invariably. On the other hand, as we have seen, Dhvanis too may be so produced. Both Varṇ as and Dhvanis again are momentary (Kṣ aṇ ika). Both therefore are produced by the contact (Abhighāta) of two or more created things. Let the DHVANI 231 letter ‘Ka’ be uttered a hundred times. Each time it is a different sound which is uttered. Again one person says ‘Ka’ and then another say Ka. The sounds again are different. The sounds produced and heard in these cases are indeed different. Nevertheless we may still recognise that one Varṇ a sound, e.g., ‘Ka’ is being uttered by oneself all those hundred times and by oneself and the other person. We recognise here oneness in the midst of all differences of the individual sounds produced and heard. The recogni- tion (Pratyabhijñāna) takes this form: “It is the same ‘Ka’ that I utter now and that I uttered a moment before. It is the same Ka that you have uttered and I have uttered.” Western psychology may attempt an explanation of this recognition of Varṇ a- identity by comparison, abstraction and assimilation. Thus if Ka is uttered by one person ten times, actually different sounds are produced varying in pitch, softness, harshness and so on. If another person utters the same letter ten times, then each of them is a different sound and the sounds are also, different from the sounds produced by the first person. But though all these Dhvanis are different in pitch, timbre and the like, it will be admitted that both persons have uttered the same letter. Western psychology would explain this as follows : The Dhvanis are different but we make a rapid com- parison of them and find that though they have differences in pitch, timbre, etc., still they have a great deal of simi- larity. The differences are then thought away or abstract- ed and then the twenty sounds are assimilated so as to give us a generic sound which we recognise as the Varṇ a sound “Ka.” It is in this way also we form the generic notion of “Man” or “Book.” The generic sound Ka is not something that actually exists apart from the twenty variations which either of the two persons mentioned have THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 232 heard. On the contrary the variations are the actual phenomena. The type (the generic sound) is simply our mental construction through comparison, abstraction and assimilation. To a mind which cannot compare, abstract and assimilate, the sounds are different sounds and it cannot recognise any typal sound in their midst. The Indian theory on the subject is, on the other hand, as follows: The Varṇ as or letters have imperishable and invariable (Nitya) forms. As the Paramāṇ us or prime “atoms” of matter are imperishable so are the Varṇ a-śabdas. “Nitya” however here means “imperishable” so long as the cosmic order itself lasts. (Natu madhye varṇ ānām ̣ , utpatti-vinā- śau.—Vedānta-Paribhāṣ ā). That is in the period of cosmic life beginning with Creation (Sṛ ṣ ṭ i) and ending with Dissolution (Laya) the Varṇ a sounds persist. They are compared to a jar in a dark room which cannot by reason of darkness be seen. (Andhakārastha-ghatānupalam ̣ bha- bat— Vedānta-Paribhāśā). Just as the jar existing in the dark may not be seen with the eyes, so the prime Śabdas or Varṇ as, though always given, may not be always mani- fested as acoustic phenomena. To be thus manifested they require a manifestor (Abhivyañjaka) or vehicle of expres- sion. This vehicle (Abhivyañjaka) through which an eternal existing letter becomes an acoustic phenomenon now and then is called Dhvani. The period of cosmic life (Madhye) is a 100 years of Brahmā when the world dissolves (Laya). The Varṇ as persist during all these years of Brahmā—a time which is called Kalpa. In Laya they enter the germinal state as aeeds of potency. This view is thus essentially different from that of ordinary western psychology. Plato’s doctrine of ideal archetypes and their sensible variations comes nearer the Vedānta doctrine. According to this the Varṇ a-śabdas are alwaya (i.e., during a Kalpa) actually going on (Nitya and Anāhata, DHVANI 233 i.e., continuous and uninterrupted)—produced by artificial means. But they are often unmanifest (Avyakta) to the gross perceptive organs. They become manifest (Vyakta) to gross sensibility through certain manifestors (Abhivyañ- jaka) which are the Dhvanis. Thus the Śabda “Om ̣ ” is uninterruptedly going on, but this it is said, one can only hear in certain stages of Sādhanā or in a quiet place particularly during night time when there is little promis- cuous interference of the sound-waves. The Kālī-Mūrti is an eternal symbol of the world-process (involving Cit and the play of Śakti) and the Garland of Letters (Mātri- kās) on the breast of the Mother is also an eternal posses- sion. Whether the Varṇ as are uttered and heard or not, they are Anāhata sound-forms and according to Indian ideas they are more real and more actual than the variations (differing in pitch, timbre and so forth) which are uttered and heard. Thus the variations alone are not the actual phenomena as the ordinary western empiricist would hold. Therefore a Dhvani as an acoustic manifestation of a, Nitga Śabda is subject to all conditions of place, time and circumstance and is non-permanent (Anitya) and variable (Vikāiri). This variableness and transitoriness which really pertain to the Abhivyañjaka-Dhvani are transferred by us (through association) to the manifested letter (Varṇ a). Thus we say “Ka is now produced and is no more.” But really that which comes to be or ceases to be is the vehicle (Dhvani) and not the Varṇ a-Śabda. As the Vedānta-Paribhāśā (Ch. IV) says: Utpanno gakāra ityādipratyakṣ atu so’yam ̣ gakāra ityādipratyabhijñā-virodhād apramānam ̣ . Varṇ ābhivyañ- jaka - dhvanigatotpatti - nirūpita - param ̣ para - sambandha- viṣ hayatvena pramāṇ am ̣ vā. “The apprehension (Pratyakṣ a) that “Ga” is now produced is not right apprehension because it conflicts with the recognition (Pratyabhijñā) THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 234 of the present ‘Ga’ (i.e., at present uttered and heard by me) being identical with all other ‘Ga’, (i.e., those uttered and heard in the past). Or we may take it as a correct apprehension if we ascribe the idea of production to the Varṇ as (which are manifested but not produced) seeing that the Dhvanis which manifest them are produced and using a characteristic which really belongs to the manifestor for the manifested.'” Śam ̣ karācārya discusses the theory of Varṇ a and Sphota in his Śariraka-Bhagya (1-3-28). He describes Dhvani in these words: “Kah punarayam ̣ dhvanir nāma, yo dūrād ākarṇ ayato varṇ avivekam apratipadyamānasya karṇ aphatam ̣ avata- rati, pratyasīdataśca mandatvapatutvādibhedam ̣ varṇ es- vāsañjayati, tannibandhanāścodāttādayo viśeṣ ā na varṇ a- svarūpanibandhanāh. Varṇ ānām ̣ pratyuccāranam ̣ pratya- bhijñāyamānatvāt, etc.” By Dhvani is to be understood that which is heard by a person listening from a distance without distinguishing the separate letters and which in the case of a person standing near by affects the letters with its own distinctions of high and low pitch and so forth. It is in this Dhvani that all the distinctions of Udātta, Anudātta and the like depend and not on the intrinsic nature of the letters which are recognised to be the same whenever pronounced. When a man is heard shouting from a great distance we do not catch his actual words and yet we can hear the pitch, modulation and so forth of his voice. When he speaks close to us we catch his words as well as the modulation, pitch, sweetness or otherwise and so forth of his voice. In both cases the pitch, etc., of the sound constitute its Dhvani. These qualities of pitch, sweetness and the like do not inhere in the Varṇ as themselves but belong to their acoustic expression, the Dhvanis. Thus DHVANI 235 Dhvanis are (1) gross embodiments (Anitya, Vikāri) of Nitya, Avikāri Varṇ a-Śabdas; (2) other gross sounds (either produced in nature such as the sound of the storm or produced by ourselves such as laughter or the sound of musical instruments) which do not appear to us as em- bodying Varṇ a-Śabdas. Those who believe (such as the Grammarians) in Sphota regard Dhvani as its Abhivyañ- jaka. Śam ̣ kara however contests the necessity of assum- ing Sphota or that which causes the apprehension of the sense of a word. Dhvani however is used also in a sense different from that in which it is defined in Nyāya or Vedānta as ex- pounded by Śam ̣ kara and different from Dhvani as con- ceived by those Grammarians who regard Dhvani as the manifestor (Vyañjaka) of the ideal sound called ‘Sphota.’ In the Tantras Dhvani is a form of Causal Śabda. Thus we hear of the “sweet murmuring Dhvani of Kuṇ dalinī,” the Creatrix of all Śabdas and Arthas. The Śārāda-Tilaka to which I have repeatedly referred (I, 108-109) says: Sā prasūte Kuṇ dalinī śabda-brahmamayī vibhuh. Śaktim tato Dhvanis tasmān Nādas tasmān Nirodhikā. Tato’rdhendus tato bindus tarmādāsīt parātatah. Paśyantī Madhyamā vāci Vaikharī śabdajanmabhūh. The words in roman type are various form of Śakti, producing one another in the order in which they are mentioned in the verse. From Kuṇ dalinī issued Śakti, from Śakti, Dhvani and so on. From the order of evolu- tion it will appear that Dhvani in such Śāstra is a subtle causal principle and not a gross manifestation of Śabda which is its ordinary sense. It is Vaikharī which is the gross manifestation of Śabda. Here the Śabda mani- fests from its subtle state as Madhysmā, which issued THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 236 from the causal state as Parā, Paśyantī, through the Dhvani caused by the contact of the vocal organs and air. Parā and the rest are located in various Cakras and tracts of the bodily organism. Rāghava-Bhatta quoted by (page 60) Vācaspatya says— Saivorah-kāntha-tālusthā śiro-ghrāṇ a-radasthitā. Jihvā-mūloṣ ṭ ha-nisyūta-sarva-Varna-parigrahā. Śabda-prapañca-jananī śrota-grāhyā tu vaikharī. “She (Kuṇ dalinī) being in the heart, throat and palate and going through the passages of the head and nose and teeth and coming out from the base of the tongue and the lips becomes audible Vaikharī—the Kuṇ dalinī who has invested Herself with the Varṇ as and is the Mother of all varieties of Śabda.” Śakti, Dhvani, Nāda and the rest are described as various aspects of Cit due to its varied association with the Guṇ as—Sattva, Rajas and Tamas. Thus Śakti is defined as the Sattva-predominant (Sāttvika) condition of Cit; Dhvani as the Rājasik-Sāttvik condition (Rajo’nu- viddha Sātttvika) of Cit, that is, a Sāttvik condition in which there is also a trace of Rajas; and Nāda a state of Causal Śabda, in which there is a trace of Tamae (Tamo’nuviddha). These are called Paramākāśāvasthā. Akśarāvasthā, Avyaktāvasthā. Whether then we have to deal with Dhvani in the sense of a form of causal Śabda or as a gross manifestation of Śabda depends upon the context. CHAPTER XXV SUN, MOON AND FIRE THESE words do not refer to the heavenly luminaries or Fire in the three worlds of Birth and Death, but are technical terms of the Manstra-śāstra denoting the creative Trinity. In the Brahmasvarūpa is merged Vimarśa (Antar- līna-vimarśa). Śruti says that there was first merely One without a second or Brahman. It became inclined towards Creation (Sṛ ṣ ṭ i-mukha). The material cause out of which the world is made is, according to the Vaikik Text, “May I be many.” Vimarśa is that which is the object of experience as “This” (Idam ̣ ) and this Idam ̣ is the Universe. The ‘Idam ̣ ’ is thus the world as object of experience (Prapañca-parāmarśa). Vimarśa-Śakti is thus the Power which produces and exists in the form of the universe. Before the world existed it was in the Brahman in the form of Brahma-Śakti. Then alone was the Light which is beyond Sun, Moon and Stars which in the Āgama is known as the imperishable Supreme Word (Anapāyinī, Parā-Vāk). She the supreme Vimarśa-Śakti is our Supreme Lady (Parā-bhattārikā) Mahā-tripura-Sundarī, in whom are all the 36 Tattavas beginning with Śiva and ending with Kṣ iti, who is in the form of all worlds (Sarva-prapañcātmikā) and also transcends them (Taduttirnā). She is beyond THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 238 the three Śaktis who are Sun, Moon and Fire. She is the causal seed of all, with whom Śiva unseparately is. For Śiva cannot create without Śakti nor Śakti without Śiva. As between moon and moonbeam there is no difference so there is none between Śiva and Śakti. The Svarūpa of Śiva is “I” (Aham ̣ ), for it is said in the Kāma- kalā-vilāsa from which this account is, in general, taken (Sivasya svarūpam ̣ aham ̣ -ityevamākāram ̣ ). The Vimarśa of that is the experience of “I-ness.” She the primordial Vimarśa-Śakti is the pure mirror which manifests that Experience (Tasya prakāśane nirmalādarśah). The work cited illustrates this as follows: A handsome King looking at his reflection in a mirror which is before him knows “I am he who is thus reflected.” So the Supreme Lord looking at His own Power within Himself knows His own Self as “I am all (Paripūrṇ o’ham ̣ )”, that is, the whole or Perfect “I.” This is the union of A = Śiva and Ha = Śakti. A + Ha = Aham ̣ or “I.” Śiva indicates Jñāna-Śakti, and Śakti, Kriyā-Śakti—Know- ledge and Action. Śiva is Illumination (Prakāśa). The Vimarśa mirror is composed of a mass of His rays and Vimarśa-Śakti is impulse (Visphuraṇ a-Śakti) maturing in action. The Rays being reflected back on the foundation of Consciousness there is the Mahābindu. So when the Supreme Lord who is Illumination (Prakāśa) is connected with the mirror-like Vimarśa there shines forth the Para- meśvara as Pūrno’ham ̣ (The Lord Experience as “I am all.”) The Supreme “I” is thus the massing together of Śiva and Śakti. This “I-ness” (Ahambhāva) arises upon the gaze of Śiva upon His own luminous Śakti or Power. So it has been said that in the notion of ‘I’ Illumination rests in itself (Ātmā-viśrānti). So Śruti (Svet. 4-1) says, “That which is letterless (Avarṇ a) generates many letters (Varṇ a).” This supreme “I” is Cittamaytt. SUN, MOON AND FIRE 239 We have spoken of the Aham ̣ or “I” and Idam ̣ or “This.” The first is known as the white (Sita) Bindu or “Moon” and represents the Śiva aspect of this supreme “I,” and the second is the red (Śoṇ a) Bindu or “Fire,” the Śakti aspect. They are in conjunction known as the Divine Husband and Wife (Kāmeśvara and Kāme- śvarī). The union of both is the Mixed (Miśra) Bindu or “Sun.” The “Sun” is Kāma and Kalā is “Moon” and “Fire,” the three Bindus being known as the Kāmakalā. This mixed Bindu becomes creative and is the cause of the manifested Word (Vāk) and its meaning (Artha). From this Bindu issues Nāda-Śaktin seed form. The Bindu is the union of the letters A and Ha, which denote the union of Prakāśa and Vimarśa, that is, white and red Bindus. Kāma is that which is desired (Kāmyate) by the great Yogīs who knew the Paramārtha as their self. Mahā-tri- pura-sundarī, inseparable from Kāmeśvara, is the collecti- vity of the Bindus and Kāmakalā. The Bindu above is Her Face (Sun) and the two Bindus below are Her two breasts (Moon and Fire) and the Kalā below it, which is half of Ha, is Her womb (Yoni). Nāda which comes forth is the cause of the origjn of all sounds. This Nāda is eventually divided into all the particular letters and words, their com- pounds and the subtle elements and all objects, their compounds. For both the world of speech and of objects have ultimately the same origin. A letter or word is the Brahman as such, just as an object denoted by the word is the Brahman as such object. The two Bindus are in- separate, that is, Prakāśa and Vimarśa. For this reason it is said that Śiva and Śakti are one Tattva. In the same way there is no difference between Vidya or Mantra as in- dicator (Vedaka, Vacaka) and the Devatā thereby denoted (Vedya, Vācya). Vāk and Artha are always united. This THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 240 is realised in Sadhana when the Devatā, the Artha of the Mantra, appears and leads the Sāhaka to a realization of the Vācyā-Śakti, the Brahma-Svarūpa. So Natanānanda- nātha in his Commentary on Punyūnanda’s Kāma-kalā-vilāsa, (VV. 6, 7) says that great Yogis worship the Mother Mahā- tripura-sundarī, who is Kāmakalā, the collectivity of the three Bindus. (For “Pura” here means Bindu; the three (Tri) which are Sun, Moon and Fire, which are Illumina- tion and Bliss: within whom is the Power (Vīrya), which is the endless mass of letters (Anantāksararāśi) and great Mantras. In the worship of the great Śrīcakra-Yantra (figured in my Edition of the Kāma-kalā-vilasa) the gross letters, in Vaikharī form, are in the outer Maṇ dalas, and passing through the subtler forms of Śabda, the Śabda- brahman and the Śūnya are attained. He therefore cites the Vijñāna-bhattsraka as saying: “By passing through the different Maṇ dalas (of the Śrīcakra) where the gross (Sthūla) letters (Varṇ a) are, and rising up to Ardhendu, Bindu, Nadanta and to the Śūnya in the Bindurūpacakra, one becomes Śiva.” This is the worship which a Mission- ary author describes as worship of the pudendum muliebre. The Yantra is composed of intersecting triangles, some upright and some inverted. The latter only are symbolic of the Yoni, which is here not the Yoni of any woman. Here it is the womb of the Divine Mother of the world. Here is the seat of the secret play of Śiva and Śakti as “Moon,” “Fire” and as the “Sun” which is the union of both—the Divine Energy, whence proceeds the world of Name (Nāma = Śabda) and Forms (Rūpa = Artha). CHAPTER XXVI BĪJA-MANTRA ACTION necessarily implies movement. Whenever there- force, there is action, there is Spanda or movement and therefore what to the perceiving subject (when heard) is called Sound. This may or may not be heard. One person may have a sharpened natural faculty of hearing; so that he may hear what escapes the ear of another. There is Sound, though the latter may not hear it. Similarly, there is Sound which is not heard by any natural ear until assisted by the extension of faculty procured by a material scientific instrument. Similarly again, there is Sound which is apprehended by the Yogic Mind as part of its experience. In the beginning of things the natural Princi- pal (Prakṛ ti) was in a state of equilibrium (Sāmyāvasthā). Then there was no Sound, for there was no movement of the objective world. The first Vibration which took plaoe at the commencement of creation, that is, on the distur- bance of equilibrium (Vaiṣ amyāvasthā) was a general move- ment (Sāmānya-Spanda) in the whole mass of Prakṛ ti. This was the Praṇ ava-Dhvani of Om ̣ Sound. It is not that the Sound is represented as it is by the Sound of the letters Om ̣ . Om ̣ is only the approximate representa- tion or gross utterance to gross ear of the Subtle Sound which is heard in Yoga experience of the first movement which is continually taking place, for at each moment the creative movement is present. From out of this general THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 242 movement and Sound special movements (Viśeṣ a-Spanda) and Sounds arise. The following apt illustration has been given (see “World’s Eternal Religion”). If a vessel of water is shaken, there is first a general movement of the whole water in the vessel. Next, there are particular movements in every part of the water, now this way, now that. So the evenly balanced Guṇ as or factors of Prakṛ ti equally vibrate throughout their whole mass, and as the movement continues, the equilibrium is disturbed and the Guṇ as act and re-act on one another as in the second state of the water in the illustration. Diverse vibratory conditions being set up, diverse Sounds are given forth. The first equally distributed motion throughout the mass is Om ̣ , which is the great seed-mantra (Maha-bīja), for it is the source of all others and of all compounded Sounds. Just as Om ̣   is the general Sound, the other Bīja-Mantras are the particular Sounds which are the letters of the alphabet. These are evolved out of the general Sound which underlies all particular Sounds. Both the Om ̣ kara or Praṇ ava and the Bīja-Mantras as pronounced by the mouth are thus the articulate equiva- lents of the inarticulate primal Dhvani. They become articulate at the last stage called Vaikharī or Spaṣ tatara- Spanda of the four stages, known as Parā (Rest passing into movement), Paśyantī (general movement), Madhyamā or speaial movement of subtle character heard by the subtle ear, and Vaikharī or special movement which as speech is the fully articulated Sound heard by the gross ear. The Praṇ ava-Mantra is thus the Sound Equivalent of Brahman and the Bīja-Mantras are the various forms with attribute (Saguṇ ariipa) of the Devas and Devīs. It is true that the approximate Sound Om ̣ is said to be constitu- ted of the letters a, u, m. This is not to say that the primor- dial Dhvani was these letters or their combination. For BĪJA-MANTRA 243 these letters are the product of the primordial Dhvani which precedes them. What is meant is that Om ̣ as a gross Sound heard by the gross ear is the Sam ̣ dhi or combina- tion of these letters. A European Sanskritist told a friend of mine that Om ̣ said before a Mantra is simply the “clear- ing of the throat” before utterance; and I suppose he would have said—the clearing of the throat after utterance, for Om ̣ both precedes and follows a Mantra. Why however should one clear the throat then? Om ̣ has nothing to do with hawking sounds, or the throat. Om ̣ is, according to Indian belief, a sound actually heard by Yogīs as above described. If, moreover, the learned man had ever heard the Mantra recited he would have felt that it could not be explained in so shallow and materialistic a way. For Om ̣ is sounded as from the navel with a deep rolling and con- tinuous Sound ending at the upper part of the nostrils where the Candra-bindu is sounded. Moreover, how are we to account for the other Bīja Sounds on this hypothesis, such as Ām, Ām ̣ , Em ̣ and so forth, except by supposing that the unpleasant and unmannerly act of clearing the throat had undergone an unaccountably varied development? Be the doctrine true or false, it is more profound than that. Mantras are given various names according to the number of their syllables. A Bīja or Seed-mantra, is strictly speaking, a Mantra of a single letter such as Kam ̣ , which is composed of the letter K (Ka) together with Candra- bindu ( ) which terminates all Mantras. Even here there is in a sense another letter. The reason is that the vowel cannot be interminably pronounced and is therefore termi- nated by a consonant. In fact, as Pāṇ ini says, the function of a consonant is to interrupt a vowel sound. The consonant cannot be pronounced without a vowel, which is hence known as the Śakti of a consonant. Here the termina- tion is M in the form of the nasal breathing called THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 244 Candrabindu ( ) which is Nāda and Bindu. The M which ends the Bīja is sounded nasally, high up in the bridge of the nose, and never reaches the lips. In all the other letters one or other of the five Bhūtas or forms of sensible matter (Ākāśa, Vāyu, Agni, Ap, Pṛ thivi) predominates. For this reason, in the selection by the Guru of the Mantra for his disciple the letters are chosen according as an examination shows that there is an excess or deficiency of any particular Bhūta. Where there is excess of a Bhūta, the letter in which it is predominant is said with the outbreathing. Where there is deficiency it is said with the inbreathing. M is chosen to end the Bīja because here the Bhūtas are said to be in equipoise. Though strictly the Bīja is of one letter as the seed from which the Mantra springs, popularly other short unetymological vocables suoh as Hrīm ̣ , Śrīm ̣ , Krīm ̣ , Hūm ̣ , Aim ̣ , Phat are called Bījas. In these there are two or more letters, such as in the first H, R, I and Candra-bindu. Thus a Mantra may, or may not, convey on its face its meaning. Bījas have no meaning according to the ordinary use of language and for this reason they have formed the subject of ridicule to those ignorant of the Mantra-śāstra. The initiated however know that their meaning is the own form (Svarūpa) of the particular Devatās whose Mantra they are, and that they are a form of the Subtle Power as creative Dhvani which makes all letters sound and which exists in all that we say or hear. Each Devatā has His or Her Bīja. Thus the Devatās of Krīm ̣ , Hrīm ̣ and Ram ̣ are Kālī, Māyā and Agni respectively. The primary Mantra in the worship of any Deva or Devī is known as the Root Mantra (Mūlamantra). Every letter, syllable and Mantra is then a form (Rūpa) af the Brahman, and so is the image and are the lines of the Yantra and all objects in the universe. And so the Śāstra says that they BĪJA-MANTRA 245 go to Hell who think that the image is merely stone and that the Mantra is merely a letter of the alphabet. All letters are forms of Śakti as Sound-powers. The Śakti, of which they are a manifestation, is the living Energy which projects itself into the form of the universe. The Mantra of a Devatā is the Devatā. The rhythmical vib- rations of its sounds not merely regulate the unsteady vib- rations of the sheaths of the worshipper, thus transforming him, but through the power of striving (Sādhana-śakti) of the worshipper, there arises the form of the Devatā which it is. And thus the Bṛ had-gandharva-Tantra (Ch. V) says: Śṛ ṇ u devi pravakṣ āmi bījānām deva-rūpatām. Mantroccārṇ amatrena deva-rūpam prajāyatte. The Bījas thus have a meaning. They indicate the Artha or Devatā which they are. What that Devatā is, is taught to the Sādhaka, just as the child learns that rose means a particular flower, and that rice and milk are the names for particular forms of food and drink which he takes. The Bījas of the five Bhūtas, that is, of the Devatās of the four forms of sensible matter, are Ha, Ya, Ra, La, Va with Candra-bindu. Where there is more than one letter, each has its meaning. As examples I here select twelve Bīja-mantras (in their popular sense), the meanings of which are given in the 6th Chapter of the Varadā-Tantra as quoted in the well known Bengali compendium known as the Prānatoṣ iṇ ī. I may here observe that the meaning of individual letters is given in the Bījakośas, such as the Tantrābhidhāna. The Varsdā-Tantra, Ch. 6, says: Haum ̣ (rl ) Śivavācī hakārastu aukārah syāt Sadāśivah. Śūnya m ̣ dunkhaharārtha m ̣ tu tasmāttena Śivam ̣ yajet. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 246 That is, Ha means Siva. Au is Sadāśiva. The Śūnya ( ) is that which dispels sorrow. Hence with that Śiva should be worshipped. Dum ̣ (7 ) Da durgāvācaka m ̣ devī ukāraścāpi rakṣ aṇ e. Vislvamata nādarūpā kurvartho bindurūpakah. That is, Da, O Devī, means Durga. U also means to save. Nāda is the mother of the Universe. Bindu means (pray) do. Krī m ̣ (4l ) Ka Kāli brahma ra proktam ̣ Mahāmāyāthakaśca ī. Viśvamātārthako nādo bindurduhkhaharāthakah. Tenaiva Kālikādevi m ̣ pūjayedduhkhaśāntye. That is, Ka is Kālī. Ra is said to be Brahma. Ī means Mahā- māyā. Nāda means Mother of the universe. Bindu means Dispeller of sorrow. With that Devī Kālika should be worshipped for cessation of sorrow. Hrim ̣ (ñl ) Hakārāh śivavāci syād rephah prakṛ tincyate. Mahāmāyārtha ī-śabdo nādo viśvaprasūh smṛ tah. Duhkhaharārthako bindurbhuvanā m ̣ tena pūjayet. That is, Ka means Śiva. Ra is said to be Prakṛ ti. Ī means Mahāmāyā. Nādā is said to be the mother of the universe. Bindu means dlspeller of sorrow. With that Bhuvaneśvarī should be worshipped, Śrīm (~l ) Mahālakṣ myarthakah Śah syād dhanārtho repha ucyate. BĪJA-MANTRA 247 Ī tustyartho’ paro nādo bindurduhkhaharārthakah. Lakṣ mīdevyā bījam etat tena devīm prapūjayet. That is, Sa means Mahālakṣ mi. Ra is said to mean wealth. Ī means satisfaction. Nāda is Apara (which may mean Aparabrahma or Īśvara). Bindu means Dispeller of sorrow. This is the Bija of Devi Lakṣ mī. With it the Devī should be worshipped. Aim ̣ (9 ) Sarāsvatyartha ai-śabdo bindurduhkhaharādhakah. SarasvatyEi bijam etat tena Vāṇ īm ̣ prapajayet. That is, Ai means Sarasvati. Bindu means Dispeller of sorrow. This is the Bīja of Sarasvatī. With it Vānī or Sarasvati should be worshipped. Klīm ̣ (Tl ) Kah Kāmadeva uddiṣ ṭ o’ pyathavā Kṛ ṣ ṇ a ucyate. La Indra ī tuṣ ṭ ivāci sukhaduhkhapradā ca am ̣ . Kāmabījārtha uktaste tava snehān maheśvari. That is, Ka refers to Kāmadeva, or according to some to Kṛ ṣ ṇ a. La means Indra. Ī means contentment. Am ̣ is that which grants happiness and sorrow. Thus, O Maheśvari, the meaning of Kāmabīja is spoken unto Thee out of my love for Thee. Hūm ̣ (r ) Ha śivah kathito devi ū Bhairava ihocyate. Parārtho nāda śabdastu Bindurduhkhaharārthakah. Varmabījatrayo hyatra kathitas tava yatnatah. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 248 That is, Ha, O Devī, is said to be Śiva. U is said to be Bhairava. Nāda means Para, Supreme. Bindu means Dispeller of sorrow. Here the three composing the Varma- bīja (armour-bīja) are spoken unto Thee owing to Thy solicitation. Gam ̣ (¬ ) Ganeśārthe ga uktas te Bindurduhkhaharārthakah. Gam ̣ bījartham tu kathitam ̣ tava snehān maheśvarī. That is, Ga, I speak unto Thee, means Ganeśa. Bindu means Dispeller of sorrow. Thus, O Maheśvarī, the meaning of Gam ̣ -bīja is spoken unto Thee out of love for Thee. Glaum ̣ (¹¬l ) Ga Ganeśo vyāpakārtho lakārasteja au matah. Duhkhaharārthako bindurganeśam ̣ tena pūjayet. That is, Ga is Ganeśa, La means what pervades. Au means tejas. Birndu means Dispeller of sorrow. With it Ganeśa should be worshipped. Kṣ rau m ̣ (¬l ) Kṣ a, Nṛ ṣ im ̣ ho Brahma raśca ūrdhvadantārthakaśca au. Duhkhaharārthako bindurNṛ ṣ im ̣ ham ̣ tena pūjayet. That is, Kṣ a is Nṛ ṣ im ̣ ha and Ra is Brahma. Au means teeth pointing upwards, Bindu means Dispeller of sorrow. With it Nṛ ṣ im ̣ ha should be worshipped. Strīm ̣ (Nl ) Durgottārnavācyah sa tārakārthastakārakah. Muktyartho repha ukto’tra mahāmāyārthakaśca ī. BĪJA-MANTRA 249 Viśvamātārtako nādo Bindurduhkhaharāthakah. Vadhūbījārtha ukto’tra tava snehān maheśvari. That is, Sa means deliverance from difficulties. Ta means Saviour. Ra here means salvation or liberation. Ī means Mahāmāyā. Nāda means Mother of the universe. Bindu means Dispeller of sorrow. Thus the meaning of Vadhūbīja is spoken unto Thee, O Maheśvari, out of love for Thee. A close examination of the above may raise some difficulties, but must, in connection with what is else- where written, remove the charge that the Bija is a mean- ingless saying to the worshipper. It is full of meaning to him. CHAPTER XXVII Ṣ ADADHVĀS ADHVĀ means a path, and Matrādhvā is all knowledge relating to Mantra. The Six (Ṣ at) Adhvās are, on the Śabda side, the three Varṇ a (letter) Pada (syllable) and Mantra (combination of syllables), each being dependent on one another, Pada on Varna, and Mantra on Pada, which are said, in the work from which I take the following table, to be 51, 81, 11 respectively. On the Artha side the three other Adhvās are Kalā (5), Tattva (36) and Bhuvana (224), each similarly dependent. The science of the Ṣ adadhvās is referred to in both Śaiva and Śakta works, but seems peculiarly characteristic of the Śām ̣ bhava-Darśana in which Śaiva and Śaktā Darśanas are synthesised. The Śakta doubt- less worships Śiva as well as Śakti with emphasis on the latter aspect. The ordinary Śaiva worships Śakti as well as Śiva with emphasis on the latter aspect. In Śām ̣ bhava Darśana both are raised into a higher synthesis. In the same way Kula = Śakti and Akula = Śiva, and therefore Kulīna means one who worships the two in one. Kalā means Śakti either generally in its higher aspect, and more commonly some specific aspect and function of Śakti. The five chief Kalās which sum up in themselves groups of Tattvas are Śāntyātītā-kalā, Śāntikalā, Vidyā- kalā, Pratiṣ ṭ ā-kalā, Nivṛ tti-kalā. These have been already referred to. These are the Powers of certain Tattvas or Principles, and two stages in the emanative process. They Ṣ ADAHVĀS 251 (the Tattvas) are 36 in number and are divided into 3 classes, viz., Pure (Śuddha-tattva), Pure-Impure (Śuddhā- śuddha-tattva) and Impure (Aśuddha-tattva). Three groups of Tattvas are also called Śiva, Vidyā, Ātma Tattvas. The first as stated in the Siddānta-Sārāvalī and other works comprise the Śiva-Tattva and Śakti Tattva; the second the Tattvas from Sadāśiva-Tattva to Śuddhavidya-Tattva; and the third the Tattvas from Māyā to Pṛ thivī. The Word Bhuvana means world or region. Bhuvana = Asmāt bhavati iti bhuvanam ̣ , or “what comes from this,” that is, “what is produced” is Bhuvana. These Bhuvana or Regional Bodies are also Pure, Pure-Impure, and Impure. These are shown with the corresponding Kalā are Tattva in the accompanying table which I have extracted with the permission of the owner of the copyrights from pp. 392-397 of Part II, Vol. II, of the late T. A. Gopīnātha Rao’s “Elements of Hindu Iconography” where they are con- veniently tabulated. I have made one or two verbal corrections. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 252 KALĀS TATTVAS NO. OF BHUVANAS NAMES OF THE BHUVANAS i. Śuddha-tattvas 1. Śiva-tattva … 10 Anāśrita, Anātha, Ananta, Vyomārū- pinī, Vyāpinī, Ūrdhvagāmini, Mōci- kā, Rocikā, Dipikā, and Indhikā— (Five of these are śākta-bhuvanas and the remaining five Nādorddhva- bhuvanas.) { 2. Śakti-tattva … 5 ( a ) Ś ā n t y - ā t i t a - k a l ā Total … 15 Śantyātītā, Śānti, Vidyā, Pratiṣ thā and Nivrtti—(These are called the Baindavāpuras). 3. Sadaśiva-tattva. 1 Sadāśivabhuvana. 4. Īśvara-tattva … 8 Śikhandi, Śrikanthā, Trimūrti, Ekanétra, Śivottama, Sūkṣ ma and Ananta. { 5. Śuddhvidyā- tattvas. … 9 ( b ) Ś ā n t a - k a l ā Total 18 ii. Śuddhāśuddha- tattvas. … Manomanī, Sarvabhūta-damanī, Bala- pramathanī, Balavikaranī, Kalavī- karani, Kālī, Raudrī, Jyeṣ thā and Vāmā. 6. Maya … 8 Anyuṣ thamātra, Īśāna, Ekekṣ ena, Ekapin ̣ gala, Udbhava, Bhava, Vāma- deva and Mahādyuti. 7. Kāla … 2 Śikheśa and Ekavira 8. Kalā … 2 Pancāntka and Śūra. 9. Vidyā … 2 Pin ̣ ga and Jyoti. 10. Niyati … 2 Samvarta and Krodha. 11. Rāga … 5 Ekaśva, Amanta, Aja, Umāpati and Pracanda. 12. Puruṣ a … 6 ( a ) V i d y ā - k a l ā Total … 27 Ekavira, Īśāna, Bhava, Īśa, Ugra, Bhima and Vāma. iii. Aśudda-tattvas. 13. Prakṛ ti … 8 Śrikaṇ tha, Auma, Kanmāra, Vaiṣ - nava, Brahma, Bhairava, Kṛ ta and Akṛ ta. 14. Buddhi … 8 Brahma, Prajeśa, Saumya, Aindra, Gandharva, Yakṣ a, Rāksaṣ a and Piśāca. 15. Aham ̣ kara … 1 Sthaleśvara. 16. Manas 17. Śrotra 18. Tvak 19. Cakṣ us 20. Jihvā 21. Nāsā } 1 Sthūleśvara. 22. Vāk 23. Pāni 24. Pāda 25. Pāyu ( d ) P r a t i s ̣ t h ā - k a l ā . 26. Upastha } 1 Śan ̣ kukurṇ a. Ṣ ADAHVĀS 253 KALĀS TATTVAS NO. OF BHUVANAS NAMES OF THE BHUVANAS 27. Śabda 28. Śarśa 29. Rūpa 30. Rasa 31. Gandha } 5 Kalañjara, Mandaleśvara, Mākota, Drāvinda and Chakalāṇ da. 32. Ākāśa … 8 Sthānu, Svarnākṣ a, Bhadrankarṇ a, Gokarṇ a, Mahālaya, Avimukta, Rudrakoti and Vastrapāda. 33. Vāyu … 8 Bhīmeśvara, Mahendra, Attahāsa, Vimaleśa, Nala, Nākala, Kuruk- ṣ etra and Gayā. 34. Tejas … 8 Bhairava, Kedāra, Mahākāla, Madh- yameśa, Amrātaka, Jalpeśa, Śri- śaila and Hariścandra. ( d ) P r a t i s ̣ t h ā - k a l ā . 35. Jala … 8 Lakuliśa, Pārabhūti, Dindi, Mundi, Vidhī, Puskara, Naimisa, Prabhāsa, and Amareśa. Total … 56 { 36. Prthivī … 108 From Bhadrakālī to Kālāgni. ( e ) N i v r ̣ t t i - k a l ā . Grand Total … 234 Thus to take the first and highest or Śiva-tattva and the assosciated Śakti-tattva, the Bhuvanas are Anāśrita, the Region or Bhuvana without support and self-sustaining, Anātha or Lordless because there is no higher Lord here, Anatha or endless, Vyomarūpiṇ ī in the form of the all- spreading Ether, Vyāpinī all-spreading, Ūrddhva-gāminī upward going, Mocikā freed of all bonds, Rocikā Beautiful or source of Beauty, Dīpikā illuminating, Indhikā destroyer of all impurity. Such are the Bhuvanas of the Kalā Śānt- yatītā (Beyond even the high abode of Peace) and the conjoined Śiva and Śakti-Tattvas. Five of these are called Śākta and the remaining five Nādorddhva (above Nāda) Bhuvanas. The rest are various other divine bodies named after their divine residents. All these regions have been created by Parama-śiva for the enjoyment of the THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 254 Beings therein; there being an immense variety of beings in an ascending hierarchy from man up to the supreme Lord and Lady of all. The beings in the Purge Regions are wholly Pure and the others Pure-Impure or Impure. Im- purity or Mala is ignorance and is of three kinds, namely, Mala, Māyā and Kārma. There are thus three classes of Paśus or created beings, namely, Vijñāna-kalas enveloped by that ignorance which is called Mala, Pralaya-kalas enve- loped in both Mala and Māyā, and Sakala or those surrounded by the three forms of ignorance Mala, Māyā and Kārma. Above the Vijñāna-kala are the beings called Mantras. The Mala envelope when in the stage at which it is about to leave the being is said to have undergone Paripāka. The Vijñāna-kalas, whose Mala is in a high state of Paripāka, are the eight Vidyeśvaras. They are eight in number and are variously coloured as in the following table, for which I am indebted to the same work. NO. NAME COLOUR 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Ananteśa Sūkṣ ma Śivottama Ekanetra Ekarudra Trimūrti Śrīkaṇ ṭ ha Śikhandī Blood-red White Blue Yellow Black Crimson Red Dark-brown The author cited refers to several southern Āgamas, such as Pūrva-Kāraṇ a, Am ̣ śumad-bhedāgama, Kāmika and other works for their Dhyāna. From these it would appear Ṣ ADAHVĀS 255 PARAS MVIT Ā SHIVATATTVA (UMMANÎ SHAKTI) SHAKTITATTVA (SAMANÎ SHAKTI) SHUDDHA TATTVA SHUDDHÂ- SHUDHA- TATTVA ASHUDDHA TATTVA S H I V A T A T T V A V I D Y A T A T T V A A T M A T A T T V A AHAM IDAM MANTRAMAHESHVARA MANTRESHVARA BADĀKHYA TATTVA (NĀDA SHAKTI) ISHVARA TATTVA (BINDU SHAKTI) AHAM IDAM AHAM IDAM SADVIDYA TATTVA MANTRAS & EIGHT VIDYESHVARAS AHAM IDAM THE TATTVAS FROM BUDDHI TO PRITHIVI VIJNAN AND ABOVE M Y ĀKALA BELOW SADVIDYĀ Ā Ā SAKALA ALL BEINGS FROM BRAHMA DOWNWARDS WHO ARE NOT MUKTA PRALAYĀKALA IN Ā Ā M Y HERE MAYA AND THE KANCHUKAS INTERVENE TO PRODUCE PURUSHA- TATTVA PRAKRITI- TATTVA THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 256 that the colours and so forth are not always given in the same way. These Vidyeśvaras are higher spiritual Entities, by whose aid the lower orders of beings attain the higher stages of spiritual evolution. Next to the Vidyeśvaras come the Mantreśvaras. Having been given pure bodies (Tanu), instrument (Karaṇ a), regions (Bhuvana) and enjoy- ment (Bhoga), these gradually get rid of all Mala. Above the Mantreśvaras are the Mantra-māheśvaras and beyond these are the Eternal and unproduced Śiva-Tattva and Śakti-Tattva. In the Vimarśinī on Īśvara-pratyabhijñā (III) Sadā- śiva-Tattva is described as that particular specialisation (Cid-viśeṣ atvam ̣ ) which consists in the experience of that Bhāvarāśi or mass of ideation belonging to the collecti- vity (Varga) of Caitanya called Mantra-māheśvara. Of the Vidyeśvaras it is said (cf. III, 1-6) that whilst the Ego-side is pure, yet unlike the experience of higher states they perceive the object as different from themselves in the same way as the Īśvaras, as recognised by the Dvaitavā- dins, perceive theirs. The various locations of the Jīvas in the various Tattvas is given as follows: Mantramāheś- vara in Sadākhya-Tattva, Maheśvara in Īśvara-Tattva, Mantras in Śuddhavidyā-Tattva (the eight Vidyeśvaras Ananta and the rest are different from the Mantras), Vijñā- nakalas below Śuddhavidyā but above Maya, Pralaya-kalas in Māyā and Sakalas include all other beings from Brahmā downwards who are not Mukta. The whole of the Śam ̣ bhava-Darśana rests on a principle of the specialisation of Consciousness, stages of descent from Pure Cit to the consciousness of the gross material world. Each stage is more bound in ignorance than the former until gross matter is reached. The Śāstra speaks of the eight called Cit, Citi, Citta, Caitanya, Ṣ ADAHVĀS 257 Cetanā, Indriya-karma, Deha and Kalā. The first is con- sciousness in the pointed or Bindu state, the second out- spreading (Vyāpini,) the third with inwara and outward activity, the fourth the Bodha or experience which is from outwards inwards, the fifth is the retention (Dhāraṇ ā) of that Bodha, the sixth is experience through action of the senses, and the seventh and eighth are the Body and its inherent subtle moving forces such as the 38 Kalās of Moon, Sun and Fire. In moon Sattva is dominant and in Fire Tamas. The Rājasik activity of the Sun mediates between these opposites. The Lords of the Tattvas proceed- ing from “Earth” (Pṛ thivī) upwards are Brahmā from Prthivi to Pradhāna (Prakṛ ti), Viṣ ṇ u from Puruṣ a to Kalā, Rudra in Māyā, Īśa in the regions extending to Sādākhya-Tattva. Then follow Anāśrita śiva and Paraśiva. CHAPTER XXVIII MANTRA-SĀDHANA IN the Gāyatrī-Tantra is is said—“that is called Mantra, by the meditation (Manana) on which the Jīva acquires freedom from sin, enjoyment of heaven and Liberation and by the aid of which he attains in full the four-fold fruit (Caturvarga).” Elsewhere it is said “Mantra is so called because it is achieved by mental process.” “Man” of “Mantra” comes from the first syllable of Manana or thinking and “tra” from Trāṇ a or liberation from the bondage of the Sam ̣ sāra or phenomenal world. By the combination of “man” and “tra” that is called Mantra which “calls forth” (Āmantraṇ a) the four aims of being (Caturvarga). A Mantra is composed of letters. Letters and their combinations as syllables and words are all forms of mani- fested Śabda, that is, Brahman-forms. They are each and all forms of the Creative Stress, as uttered by the mouth, heard by the ear, and apprehended by the mind; but what are ordinarily called Mantras are those particular sounds which are used in worship and practice (Sādhana) which consist of certai letters, or letters arranged in a definite sequence of sounds of which the letters are the representative signs. The relations of Varṇ a, Nāda, Bindu, vowel and consonant in a Mantra constitute the Devetā in varying forms. Certain Vibhūti or aspects of the Devatā are inherent in certain Varṇ as. The Mantra of a Devatā MANTRA-SĀDHANA 259 is that letter of combination of letters which reveals the Devatā to the consciousness of the Sādhaka, who has evoked it by Sādhana-śakti. The form of a particular Devatā therefore appears out of the particular Mantra of which that Devatā is the Adhiṣ ṭ hātri-Devatā. This Mantra is intoned in the proper way according to letter (Varṇ a) and rhythm (Svara). For these reasons a Mantra, when translated ceases to be a Mantra, that is, the sounds heard and uttered in the translation are not the body of, and do not evoke, the Devatā. We are then not dealing with the same sound, but with a translation in another lan- guage, with other sounds giving the meaning to the in- tellect of the Sanskrit Mantra. This shows that Mantra is not mere individual thinking but a particular sound-body of consciousness. A particular Mantra therefore (such as the Gāyatrī) is not a mere collocation of words. Though to a non- believer it may seem but a string of mere letters bearing on their face a particular meaning or in the case of Bīja Matras apparently no meaning at all, to the Sādhaka it is a very mass of radiant Tejas or energy. An ordinary collection of words is something gross. These,as all else, are forms of Śakti. But the Mantra of which we speak is the Devatā Himself or Herself in Mantra-body. Mantra is thus a mass of radiant Energy. Saying give informa- tion and advice to men of the world, while Mantras awaken superhuman power or Śakti. A mere saying is therefore, like a Jīva, subject to birth and death, whilst a Mantra is directly Brahman in sound-body, unwasting and undecaying. A Mantra again is not the same thing as prayer or self-dedication (Ātma-nivedana). Prayer is con- veyed in what words the worshipper chooses and bears its meaning on its face. It is only ignorance of Śāstrik prin- ciples (See Arthur Avalon’s “Tantra-Tattva or Principles THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 260 of Tantra” as to what precedes and follows) which sup- poses that Mantra is merely the name for the words in which one expresses what one has to say to the Divinity. If it were, the Śādhaka might choose his own language without recourse to the eternal and determined sounds of Śāstra. Śabda is Śakti. The Viśvasitra-Tantra (Ch. II) says that Śabda-brahman which is Mantra (Mantramaya) exists in the body of Jīva and is the subtle aspect of the Jīva's vital Śakti. As the Prapañcasāra-Tantra states, the Brahmānda, or Spheroid (universe) is pervaded by Śakti as Dhvani, called Nāda, Prāṇ a and the like. The manifestation of the gross (Sthūla) form of Śabda would not be possible, unless Śabda existed also in a subtle (Sūkṣ ma) form. Śabda is the Guṇ a of Ākāśa, but is not produced by it. It manifests in it; and Śabda-svarūpa is the Brah- man. In the same way however as in outer space waves of sound are produced by movements of air (Vāyu), so in the space within the Jīva’s body, waves of sound are produced according to the movements of the vital air (Prāṇ avāyu) and the process of inhalation and exhalation. The Śabda which first appears in the Mūlādhāra (See A. Avalon’s “Serpent Power”) is in fact the Śakti which gives life to the Jīva. The Jīva who inbreathes and outbreathes utters a great Mantra. This is the Ajapā-Mantra or Ham ̣ sah, called “Ajapā,” because it repeats itself naturally without any effort on the part of the Jīva. It is the heaving of the Dhvani which causes alternate inspiration and expira- tion. Śakti it is who is the Cause of the sweet, indistinct and murmuring Dhvani (See Ch. XXIV) which sounds like the humming of black bees. This sound is Parā, and then Paśyantī, which becomes subtle as Madhyamā and gross as Vaikharī. Kuṇ dalinī, who is Varṇ amayī and Dhvanimayī, MANTRA-SĀDHANA 261 is the manifestation in bodies of the Paramātmā. So the substance of all Mantra is Cit, manifested as letters, sylla- bles, words and their sentences. In fact the letters of the alphabet which are known as Akṣ ara are nothing but the Yantra of the Akṣ ara or imperishable Brahman. It is the gross or Sthūla form of Kuṇ dalinī, appearing in different aspects as different Devatās, which is the presiding Devatā (Adhiṣ ṭ hātri) of all Mantra, though it is the subtle (Sūk- ṣ ma) form at which all Sādhakas aim. For in every Mantra there are two Śaktis. The Vācya-Śakti and the Vācaka-Śakti. The Devatā who is indicated (Pratipādya- Devatā) as the ultimate Svarūpa is the Vācya-Śakti, and the Devatā who is that Mantra (Mantramayī-Devatā) is the Vācaka-Śakti. Thus if Durgā is the Devatā of a Mantra, then Mahāmāyā is the Vācyā-Śakti. The latter is without attribute and Vācakā-Śakti with attribute. The latter is the object of worship and is a support and means whereby the Vācya-Śakti is realised. For worship assumes as its object some form. When the Śakti with attribute, resident in and as the Mantra, is by dint of Sādhana awakened, then She opens the gate of monistic truth, revealing the true nature and essence of the universe. There are thus two Śaktis, viz., the Mantra-Śakti and the Sādhana-Śakti, that is the Śakti of the Sādhaka generated by Sādhanā. It is the uniting of these two Śaktis which accomplishes the fruit of Mantra-sādhana. How? The Saguṇ a-Śakti is awakened by S ādhanā and worshipped. This Saguṇ a-Devatā is the Presiding Deity (Adhiṣ ṭ hātri-Devatā) of the Mantra as the Nirguṇ a (form- less) Īśrvara or Īśvarī is the Vācya-Śakti. Both are one; but the Jīva by the laws of his nature and its three guṇ as must first meditate on the gross (Sthūla) form before he can realise the subtle (Sūkṣ ma) form which is liberation. THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 262 The utterance of a Mantra without knowledge of its meaning or of the Mantra method is a mere movement of the lips and nothing more. The Mantra sleeps. There are various processes preliminary to, and involved in, its right utterance, which processes again consist of purification of the mouth (Mukha-śodhana), (See Chapter X, Śārada- Tilaka. Japa of praṇ ava or the mantra Om ̣ varies with the Devatā—e.g., Om ̣ Hsau for Bhairava), purification of the tongue, Jihvā-śodhana, (seven Japa of one-lettered Bīja triplicated, Praṇ ava triplicated, then one-lettered Bīja tripli- cated) and of Aśauca-bhan ̣ ga, Japa of Mūla-mantra pre- ceded and foIlowed by Praṇ ava. As to the “birth” and “death” defilements of a mantra, see Tantra-sāra 75, et seq., Kulluka, see Śāradā, loc. cit. Thus Kulluka, which is done over the head, of Kālikā is Māyā, see Puraścaraṇ a Bodhinī, p. 48, and Tantra-sāra; Nirvāṇ a (Japa of Mūla- and Mātṛ kā-bīja in the Maṇ ipūra), Setu (Generally the Mahāmantra Om ̣ or Māyābīja Hrīm ̣ , but it also varies. Thus Setu of Kālī is her own Bīja Krim ̣ , of Tārā, Kūrca, etc.), Nidrā-bhan ̣ ga, awakening of mantra (Japa of the Mantra preceded and followed by Im ̣ seven times), Mantra- caitanya, or giving of life or vitality to the mantra (Japa of Mūlamantra in Maṇ i-pūra preceded and followed by Mātṛ kā-bīja. Meditating on the Mūla-mantra in the Sahasrāra, Anāhāta, Mūlādhāra, with Hūm ̣ , and again in Sahasrāra. The Mūla is the principal mantra, such as the Pañcadaṣ ī), mantrārtha-bhāvanā, forming a mental image of the Divinity (Lit., thinking of meaning of mantra or thinking of the mātṛ kā in the mantra which constitutes the Devatā from foot to head). There are also ten Sam ̣ s- kāras of the rnantru (See Tantra-sāra, p. 90). Dīpanī is seven Japa’ of the bīja, preceded and followed by Om ̣ . Where Hrim ̣ is employed instead of Om ̣ , it is Prāṇ a-yoga. Yoni-mudra is meditation on the Guru in the head and on MANTRA-SĀDHANA 263 the Iṣ ta-devatā in the heart, and then on the Yoni-rūpā- Bhāgavatī from the head to the Mūlādhāra, and from the Mūlādhāra to the head, making japa of the Yonī Bīja (Em ̣ ) ten times (See Purohitadarpaṇ am ̣ ). The Mantra itself is Devatā, that is, the Supreme Consciousness (Cit-śakti) manifesting in that form. The Mantra is awakened from its sleep (Mantra-caitanya) through the Sādhana Śakti of the mantrin. It is at base one and the same Śakti which appears as Sādhana-Śakti and Mantra-śakti, the latter however being the more power- ful manifestation. The consciousness of the Sādhaka be- comes en rapport and in union with the Consciousness in the form of the Mantra; and the Devatā who is the Artha of the Mantra appears to the Sadhaka, whose mind has been cleansed and illumined by devotion. Though the substance of the Mantra is Consciousness, that fact is not realised without the union of the Sādhaka’s Śakti derived from Sādhana with Mantra-śakti. The Devatā is then revealed. In the case of Pūjā, Dhyāna and other Sādhanās, it is only the Sādhaka’s Sādhanā-Śakti which operates, whilst in the case of Mantra-sādhanā, Sādhanā-śakti works in conjunction with Mantra-śakti which is all powerful and re-inforces Sādhanā-śakti which is imperfect and meets with obstacles. The individual Śakti is like fire. Just as waves of air, when struck and restruck by flames of fire, set up a blaze with redoubled force, so the Sādhaka’s individual Śakti when struck by Mantra-śakti is rapidly developed, and then a strong active individual Śakti unites with Mantra-śakti to make the latter doubly powerful. It is because Mantra possesses this wonderful power that a Jīva can, it is said accomplish that which appears im- possible. Otherwise a Jīva could not achieve by his own effort the treasure which is worshipped even by Śiva. The Jaivī-Śakti or Śakti of a Jīva (as such) is transformed THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 264 by the aid of Mantra into the Daivī-Śakti or the Śakti of a Deva (as such). With this Śakti he can accomplish that which a Deva can. Mantra is thus an aspect of the Divine Mother appearing through Mantra-sādhanā with devotion to Her. It has been thus said (Tantra-Tattva II, 45): “The string of fifty letters from A to Kṣ a which are the Mātṛ kās is Eternal, unbeginning and unending and Brahman itself.” This great saying is the first of all Tantras. The realization of this Mantra-consciousness is Mantra-siddhi. If a Sādhaka attains perfect Siddhi in even a single Mantra he becomes possessed of the spiritual knowledge which is acquired by learning all Vedas. For Veda is the Pariṇ āma or evolution of the Dhvani of Kūla- Kuṇ dalinī in the body of Īśvara, and the Pariṇ āma of the same in the body of the Jīva is Śabda. For Veda is Dhvani uttered by Brahmā and Śabda is Dhvani uttered by the Jīva. In that Śabda is every form of Mantra which is that which gives vitality to the Jīva. It is this Dhvani too which evolves into gross Śabda as uttered sound, the body of the Devatā. Siddhi in such Mantra is not gained so long as such Mantra is not awakened. It may be that the appearance of the Devatā is a fact or it is not a fact. But it vannot be said that the mere utterance of a Mantra is superstitiously supposed to effect any result, or that Japa of the Mantra is done with no other object than a mere vain and senseless repetition. The particular Mantra suitable for a Sādhaka is a matter determined by Cakra and other calculations. CHAPTER XXIX THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA THE Gāyatrī is the most sacred of al Vaidiki mantras. In it the Veda lies embodied as in its seed. It runs: Om ̣ . Bhūr bhuvah svah: tat savitur vareṇ yam ̣ bhargo devasya dhīmahi: dhiyo yo nah pracodayāt. Om ̣ . “Om ̣ . The earthly, atmospheric and celestial spheres. Let us con- template the wondrous Solar Spirit of the Divine Creator (Sāvitri). May He direct our minds (that is, towards the attainment of Dharma, Artha, Kāma, and Mokṣ a). Om ̣ .” The Gāyatrī-Vyākarṇ a of Yogī Yājñavalkhya thus ex- plains the following words: Tat, means that. (Tat is ap- parently here treated as in the objective case, agreeing with varenyam, etc., but others holding that the vyāhṛ ti —Bhūr bhuvah svah—forms part of, and should be linked with, the rest of the Gāyatrī treat that as part of a genitive compound connected with the previous vyāhṛ ti, in which case it is teshām). The word yat, “which,” is to be under- stood. (It may, however, be said that yay is there in Yo nah). Savituh is the possessive case of Sāvitri, derived from the root sū, “to bring forth.” Sāvitri is, therefore, the Bringer-forth of all that exists. The Sun (Sūrya) is the cause of all that exists, and of the state in which it exists. Bringing forth and creating all things, it is called Sāvitri. The Bhaviṣ ya-Purāṇ a says: “Sūrya is the visible Devatā. He is the eye of the world and the Maker of the day. There is no other Devatā eternal THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 266 like unto Him. This universe has emanated from, and will be again absorbed into Him. Time is of and in Him. The planets, stars, the Vasus, Rudras, Vāyu, Agni, and the rest are but parts of Him.” By Bhargah is meant the Āditya-devatā, dwelling in the region of the Sun (Sūrya-maṇ dala) in all His might and glory. He is to the Sun what our spirit (Ātmā) is to our body. Though He is in the region of the Sun, in the outer or material sphere, He also dwells in our inner selves. He is the light of the light in the solar cirole, and is the light of the lives of all beings. As He is in the outer ether, so also is He in the ethereal region of the heart. In the outer ether He is the Sun (Sūrya), and in the inner ether He is the wonderful Light which is the Smokeless Fire. In short, that Being whom the Sādhaka realizes in the region of his heart is the Āditya in the heavenly firmament. The two are one. The word is derived in two ways: (1) from the root Bhrij, “to ripen, mature, destroy, reveal, shine.” In this derivation Sūrya is He who matures and transforms all things. He Himself shines and reveals all things by His Light. And it is He who at the final Dissolution (Pralaya) will in His form of destruotive Fire (Kālāgni) destroy all things. (2) From bha = dividing all things into different classes; ra = colour, for He produces the colour of all created objects; ga = constantly going and returning. The Sun divides all things, produces the different colours of all things and is constantly going and returning. As the Brāhmaṇ a-sarvasva says: “The Bharga is the Ātmā of all that exists, whether moving or motionless, in the three Lokas (Bhūr Bhuvah Svah). There is nothing which exists apart from it.” Devasya is the genitive of Deva, agreeing with Savituh. Deva is the radiant and playful (Līlāmaya) one. Sūrya is in constant play with creation (Sṛ ṣ ṭ i), existence (Sthiti), THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA 267 and destruotion (Pralaya), and by His radiance pleases all. (Līlā, as applied to the Brahman, is the equivalent of Māyā). Vareṇ yam ̣ = varaṇ īyam ̣ or adorable. He should be mediated upon and adored that we may be relieved of the misery of birth and death. Those who fear rebirth, who desire freedom from death and seek Liberation, and who strive to escape the three kinds of pain (tāpa-traya), which are Ādhyātmika, Ādhidaivika, and Ādhibhautika meditate upon and adore the Bharga, who, dwelling in the region of the Sun, has in Himself the three regions called Bhūr-loka, Bhuvar-loka and Svar-loka. Dhīmahi = dhyāyema (from the root dhyai), we meditate upon, or let us meditate upon. Pracodayāt = may He direct. The Gāyatrī does not so expressly state, but it is understood that such direction is along the Catur-varga, or four-fold path, which is Dharma, Artha, Kāma, and Mokṣ a (piety, wealth, desire and its fulfilment, and Liberation). The Bhargah is ever directing our inner faculties (Buddhi-vṛ tti) along these paths. The above is the Vaidikī-Gāyatrī, which, according to the Vaidika system, none but the twice-born may utter. To the Śūdra, whether man or woman, and to women of all other castes it is forbidden. The Tantra-Śāstra, which has a Gāyatrī-Mantra of its own, shows no such exclisiveness; Chapter III, verses 109-111, of the Mahā- nirvāṇ a-Tantra gives the Brahma-gāyatrī for worshippers of the Brahman: “Parameṣ varāya vidmahe-para-tattvāya dhīmahi: tan no Brahma pracodayāti” (May we know the Supreme Lord. Let us contemplate the Supreme Reality. And may that Brahman direct us.) CHAPTER XXX THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA AS AN EXERCISE OF REASONING. THE Society 1 is called “Rationalistic.” If its formation was meant to be merely a homage to one form of modern western thought, the title may be fairly correct. I think however that you had no intention of adding to the volume of imitativeness in this country, but by your action you wished to affirm the necessity of such reasonable thinking and practice as is characteristic of the Arya-Dharma, rightly understood and cleansed of all bad and useless accre- tion. There is always a difficulty, when English verbal labels are used to describe Indian philosophical and religious theories and practices. In fact such labels are a fertile source of confusion. I hear of a good suggestion to call it Satyajñāna-Sabha or a similar name. Rationalism, in the sense of its technical opposition to Sensationalism, has no meaning in this country for those who believe a child is born with his Sam ̣ skāras. “Rationalism” in its more general sense involves, it has been said, the following beliefs: (1) Reason is the chief source and final criterion of knowledge. (2) Each individual must investigate and gain knowledge for himself, and must not merely submit himself to external authority. In other words he must to his own thinking. (3) As a ——————————————————————————————————————————————— 1 This Chapter reproduces a lecture given to the Rationalistic Society, Calcutta. THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA 269 result of this it is said that a rationalist must reject any alleged knowledge, the truth of which cannot be rationally demonstrated. Upon such a statement a Vedāntist (I speak through- out of the Advaita-Vedānta) would ask, what is the “know- ledge” here mentioned? If worldly (Laukika) knowledge is meant, then the Rationalist and Vedāntist are at one. Worldly knowledge is apprehended through the senses (lndriya). In its own sphere, reason is the chief source of knowledge and final criterion. So much is this so, that Śam ̣ karācārya says that if even Veda were to contradict what is the subject of worldly proof (Laukika-Pramāṇ a) it would not be Veda. In this sphere it is not a Pramāṇ a, which overrides the testimony of the senses and inferences therefrom. The Yoga-Vāsiṣ ṭ ha (Bk. 2—Ch. 18, vv. 2-3) says: Api pauruṣ am ̣ ādeyam ̣ śāṣ tram ̣ ced yuktibodhakam ̣ Anyat tvārṣ am ̣ api tyājyam ̣ bhāvyam ̣ nyāyyaikasevinā. Yuktiyuktam ̣ upādeya m ̣ vacanam ̣ bālakād api. Anya tṛ ṇ am ̣ iva tyājya m; apyuktam ̣ Padmajanmanā. That is, “Even a Śāstra of purely human author- ship should be accepted if conformable to reason. Any- thing else (which is unreasonable), even though it be the word of a Ṛ ṣ i, should be rejected by one who follows reason. The word of a boy if reasonable should be accept- ed. Anything unreasonable should be rejected as of no more count than a blade of grass, even if it be uttered by the Lotus-born (Brahmā) Himself.” On this subject read the whole of the 14th Chapter of Book II of the Mumukṣ u- Khaṇ da of this work which is a glorification of Vicāra or reasoning. But there is more than what is seen with the eyes. The mind admittedly exists, but it is not seen by the senses THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 270 (Atīndriya). Again as to objects, scientific instruments enable the sense to perceive more than is presented to them in their natural state. These instruments thus effect a material extension of natural faculty. Then there are Psychic Powers (Siddhi), the subject of much study to-day in the West, but matters of long familiar practice in this country. Here the mind may operate independently of the gross bodily organs of sense, as also occurs in some cases of Hypnosis. These psychic powers are again extensions of natural faculty. They are not supernatural, except in the sense that they are supernormal. They may, in any one individual, be natural or produced, but we do not reason ourselves into them. We can reason only upon whether they exist, and what they are and indicate. That is, we reason about them. In themselves they are peculiar mental faculties, by which the mind sees things or imposes itself upon and controls, or affects, others, such as Clair- voyance, Clairaudience, Hypnosis, Thought-reading, Tele- pathy and so forth. There is nothing unreasonable in all this. On the contrary an affirmation of their existence is reasonable and in accordance with the Vedantic theory of Being upon which this paper proceeds. The only question about them is one of fact or proof. Do they exist or not? Nothing is more unscientific than to pronounce a priori against them and without investigation into the facts. Notwithstanding scientific bigotry (for there is a bigotry of science as of religion) psychical research is coming to be recognised as a useful form of enquiry. Lastly there is what is called spiritual or religious experience, which is of varying degrees and kinds, and is a knowledge of the nature (through an actual participation in Its Being) of the excelling and infinite Principle which lies behind and manifests all Phenomena. Professor James’s celebrated work “Varieties of Religious Experience” is one THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA 271 of the first essays in a field, which is only now commencing to be cultivated extensively. The possibility or fact of such experience cannot be said to be unreasonable. Such experience has been affirmed by all the great Religions, and by some of the great Philosophies. If it is unreasonable, then the bulk of Humanity have been lacking in reason in all the past and in the present times. The question again here is one of fact and proof. Have such experiences taken plaoe in fact? Are they real experiences or mere hallucinations? In the latter case why should they occur? The only direct and certain proof is the having of such an experience oneself. Probable proof may be had in various ways, such as the persistence and universality of such experiences, the nature of the truths said to be revealed by them, and, in particular, the extraordinary effect which they have produced on the individuals who have had such experience, and (in the case of the greater experiences) the effect that they have produced on the world at large. To my mind it is a very shallow view which regards the effect produced on millions of past and present Humanity, by the Ṛ ṣ is and Śākya-Muni of India, by Laotze, Jesus and Mahommed, as the outcome of the hallucination of the Mahātmās named and others. Which of these experiences, it may be asked, is true, or which one is truer than the others? This is too vast a question to be answered here. Let me however say this, that those who read these experi- ences with knowledge will find elements common to all together with some elements which seem to vary. As to these last let it be noted that just as in our ordinary life one man sees and knows more than another, so it is with spiritual experience, of which there are many grades. If two men are approaching a mountain, is the experience which one man has of it 50 miles distant untrue, because it differs from the experience of the other man who sees THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 272 it at its foot? Do we not say that both are true, consider- ing the position of each experiencer? In India spiritual experience is called Veda, from the root “Vid” to know. It is experience in the limit, of which all others are gradual and partial reproductions. This may be primary, that is, an individual may himself have the experience, or he may accept the authority of those who have had such experience, for reasons I have slightly indicated but cannot develop here. The Vedānta says that Reason is supreme in worldly (Laukika) matters open to our senses. By reasoning we may establish Laukika truth, but as regards what is not seen, such as the being of one Supreme Cause of which the Universe is an effect, unaided reason can only establish probabilities and not certainty. Thus one may, with reasonableness, argue for or against Monism, Dualism, Pluralism and so forth. In this way mere reasoning may lead to contrary conclusions. And in fact what is more contradictory than the conclusions of Western philo- sophy with Realism (old style and new as propounded by Mr. Bertrand Russell), Idealism (objective and subjective), Monism, Pluralism, Pan-psychism, Humanism, Pragmat- ism and the many other systems which jostle for men’s custom in this Philosophical Fair? It is a matter of doubt whether modern metaphysic is any real advance on that of the greater among the ancients. In my opinion none is better constructed than the Six Darśanas. The advance has been made in Science. But even here there is dispute, both as to the facts observed, and the theories based on them. For me, their greatest importance just lies in the fact, that the latest scientific inferences corro- borate the intuitively derived teaching of the ancient sages. Thus present scientific conceptions of the constitution of matter, and notably the breakdown of the Atomic Theory, THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA 273 support the notions of Māyā, a single material basis of the Universe, and the existence of Ether which, as Ākāśa, was accepted in India when Europe had not passed beyond the so-called “four elements.” Both science and Indian beliefs posit an evolution of beings from the inorganic to the organic, and, in the latter division, from plant to animal and animal to man. In India it has always been held that there are no partitions or gulfs between the various forms of existence, and that, for instance, the difference between man and animal is not a difference of kind but of degree. Again from the new Psychology and Psychical Research, Vedānta gains support, as from theories touching the nature of mind as a material force (as Herbert Spencer teaches) and as a power (the predominant idea in “New Thought” literature), the extension of the field of Con- sciousness, dual personalities and various forms of psychi- cal phenomena. Nevertheless, so far as ultimates are concerned, neither Metaphysics nor Science can establish more than a high degree of probability; they may lead to the door of the shrine, but they do not directly and unaided place the en- quirer within. The Brahman or All-Pervader cannot be established by reason, because it is never an object of knowledge. The Śāstra says, one can only know Brahman by being Brahman and that is by spiritual experience. Its being and nature are taught by revelation. Revelation is not the speaking of any voice, divine or otherwise, from without. It is self-knowledge in its deepest sense and nothing more. The Vedāntist affirms that we can know ourselves, not only in our gross or physical aspect as being fair or dark, short or tall and so on, or in our subtle or mental aspect as perceiving and reasoning beings, but in our innermost essence as that of which both body and mind are manifestations. It may be the facts or it may THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 274 not be the fact, but there is nothing unreasonable in the proposition as such. It is this Self-knowledge, attained by oneself in varying degrees, or accepted as the experience of others (Śruti), whose testimony we may, for reasons satisfying to ourselves, accept, which renders certain that which to reason is only probable. Once Śruti is aocepted, Reason can follow its teaching without violence to its own principles. What was before reasonable and probable is now both reasonable and certain. This must be so, unless we assume what is impossible, namely a divorce between rational and spiritual truth. Truth however is one and what is unreasonable must be rejected, whoever says it, “even if He be the Lotus-born.” It is not India who has denied the rights of Reason. It is Europe who in the past has done so. But Europe has now, after fierce contest against Church tyranny and oppression (aided by the State) with its imprisonment, torture and burning at the stake, largely achieved in the present the right of free thinking. Had India been so opposed She might have been to-day more intellectually active. In the same way the political activity of Europe has been stimulated by the oppressive governance of its peoples. We westerners have had to fight for all the things of worth we have won. Nowhere however has intellectual liberty been so au- thoritatively, and for such a length of time, recognised as in India. The word “Man” is derived from the root Man, which in Sanskrit means “to think.” Man is Manu. Therfore man is “The Thinker.” He is thus distinguished from the rest of the world by his thinking. What greater definition than this of our Aryan fore- fathers can be found? In no country in the whole world has there been more thinking than in India, which has been indeed a very hot-bed of speculation and divergent THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA 275 beliefs and practices: such as the Materialism of Chār- vāka and the Lokāyatas, true atheists, men of the type of Ajitakeśakam ̣ balī, the opponent of Śākya-Munī, who denied that any Brāhmaṇ a, or anyone else, had dis- covered any truth concerning any other life than this, who said that man was made of the four elements and dissolved into the elements at death and had gone for ever; such again as the Sānkhyas, dualists and realists, affirming the existence of Spirit, but holding a God as Governor of the universe unproved (Nirīśvara-Darśana); the Nyāyavaiṣ eśikas, pluralists, realists affirming the existence of the Supreme Lord; Buddhist idealism (Vijnā- navāda) and so called “Nihilists” (Śūnyavādins); Vedāntic Monism, qualified Monism, and Dualism in various theistic forms, Mimam ̣ sakas, Jainas and every shade of thought imaginable. In Vedāntic Sādhana, Reasoning or Manana occupies, with Śravaṇ a and Nididhyāsana, a principal place. All the Darśanas, particularly perhaps the Nyāya, are written to serve Manana or reasoning, and the Brahmasūtras, which the Vedāntic systems expound, are known as Vaiyāsikanyā- yamālā. As regards science, India has had its own great achievements which you will find recorded in part in Professors Brojendranath Seal’s and Binay-kumar Sirkar’s works on the subject. Up to the modern period India was more than the equal in this field of any other country. But undoubtedly, since that period, the palm for scientific thinking and experiment must be given to the West. Those who however imagine, that reasoning and freedom of thought are a distinctive appanage of the West, are very ignorant of the history of their country. If one had to make the comparison, and one did make it over a period, extending from say (to go no further) 2000 B.C., THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 276 the statement must be reversed in favour of India. No country has honoured Reason more, or given it greater freedom than India. The cultural restrictions in this country have been of a different kind, consisting in the social ordering of life, and in later times exclusion from knowledge by reason of artificial distinctions of caste. But those, to whom the book of knowledge was open, have always been able to think freely enough. When Europe was under ecclesiastical domination, the attempt was made to make everyone think the same way in the manner laid down by Church authority. It is against this that European Rationalism protested. I at first found a diffioulty in choosing a subject to address to you out of the many which presented themselves, and I had practically written a paper, with which I was not satisfied, because I could not put before you (as indeed I cannot even now) what I wished to say within the limits available to me, when, by something more than chance, I found amongst my old papers a note sent me some years ago on the Gāyatrī-Mantra, the holiest expression of the thought of India. I therefore restate its argument more summarily in words, and with some further additions of my own. The Mantra opens and ends with the Praṇ ava or Om ̣ . This refers in the first place to the threefold aspect of the World-Cause in manifestation. That there is a cause (Mahā-śakti) which, as the Universal Self, contains the universe within Itself, is dealt with in the meditation which follows. Here both the Cause and Its manifesta- tion are the object of thought. The Nādabindu indicates that causal state of the World-Power, prior to its three- fold differentiation as represented by the letters A, U, M, which coalesce into Om ̣ . These letters stand for its working which is observable by all. For the first and second refer to present activities, as well as those in the THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA 277 past and future, of the Mahāśakti, as the Radical Vital Potential. M or Rudra as so observed is chemical action breaking down the combinations of matter. This is the disintegration of form. A (Brahmā) is the force which creates it anew by its ever rejuvenescent molecular activity, thus rescuing organised vitality from the processes which are ever at work to consume (as “M”) its forms. U (Viṣ ṇ u) is the maintaining power which stabilizes matter, which is only a relatively stable condition of energy, from which, it appears, and into which it, at length, merges. Looking at the sum total of manifested energy, Viṣ ṇ u as Maintainer, through space and time, is a theological statement of the doctrine of the general conservation of energy. The Mahā- śakti, in Herself Perfect Consciousness (Cidrūpiṇ ī), is the threefold Powers of Will, Knowledge and Action, and mani- fests in the building up, maintenance and disintegration of forms. What follows, as all else, is contained in Om ̣ , but some of its implications are developed in the rest of the Gāyatrī-Mantra. Om ̣ considered as a sound (Dhvani) is the approximate natural name of the first undifferentiated movement (Sāmānya-Spanda) of the stressing material cause (Prakṛ ti) of the universe. The primordial “Sound” or Stress is the primordial functioning of the Brahma- Śakti. Then follow the three Vyāhṛ tis—Bhūh, Bhuvah, Svah, which are Lakṣ aṇ a of, that is, stand for, all the fourteen Lokas, though now in the (Vyāvahārika) world we are only concerned with the first three; Bhūh for Bhūh and the seven nether Talas, Bhuvah for itself, and Svah for Svah and the remaining upper regions up to Satya. The Lokas represent states of consciousness. Bhūrloka or earth is the state of normal experience. The Lokas above it are states of supernormal consoiousness, and the Talas be- low are conditions of sub-normal experience. Objectively THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 278 considered matter becomes more and more dense as one descends from the highest to the lowest Loka and thence to the Talas; and as the veil of matter is more or less dense, so the state at consciousness varies. The first five Lokas, from and including Earth, are those of the five forms of sensible matter, the sixth is that of Mind; and the seventh is the causal state of both Mind and Matter. Earth and the nether states are the gross body, the Lokas from Bhuvah to Tapah are the subtle body, and Satya is the causal body of the great Puruṣ a referred to in the Gāyatrī and wor- shipped in the Sun-circle (Āditya-mandala). The Vyāhṛ tis indicate that the Great Self which is indicated in Om ̣ per- vades all the regions of the universe. How then do we get the notion of that Self and then experience it? In our ordinary condition of consciousness, the outer world is completely objective and stable and independent of it. It lies “over there” in the outer space entirely external to us, having apparently its existence in itself and of itself. This state of consciousness is indicated by the first Vyāhṛ ti “Bhūh.” This is our normal state. Our mind is here. It is one thing—Aham ̣ or I. The object, the Idam ̣ or “This,” the Vimarśa-Śakti, is there. It is another. But a little reflection reveals that these seemingly indepen- dent objects are for us bundles of certain qualities, which are so, only because they are sensed by the Senses which are constituted in a particular way. It is obvious that if our senses were not there, or if they were not seizing the object, there would be no sensation and no object. Again if the senses themselves were modified, the sense perceptions would also change. In that case the objects, which at first sight exist independently of our perceptions, would become something different from what they formerly were, as they would exhibit a different set of qualities. Thus the objective world is not really independent as we first thought, and the THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA 279 form it presents to us is due to the action of some objective force acting upon the subjectively sensuous character of the beings who perceive it. With such reflections the notion of objective stability wears off, and the world first assumes a mobile condition, in so far as it is seen that the objects, which at first seem to possess the qualities which charac- terise them, do so not only of themselves but also of our- selves. The condition of mind in which this notion is firmly held is the second of the seven divisions or stages of the Pārthiva consciousness. All materially-minded think- ers, who look upon the objective world as independent of a subjective perceiver, are in the Bhūrloka. The second condition of consciousness in which the subjectivity of the self first asserts itself, and the objective world loses its absolute and independent character and appears as dependent upon, influenced and modified by the subjective factor, is expressed in some forms of idealism. In such cases though the subjective element is recognised, it is not ideal in the sense that it has its root wholly in itself, but it is objectively actual in the sense that it has its existence at least mainly in the external. The seer, seeing, and seen, are localised in the outer space. As we proceed upwards, whilst the seen (Jñeya) remains external to us, the seeing (Jñāna) is localised internally, until at length the seer (Jñātā), seeing (Jñānā), and seen (Jñeya) are all internalised, subjectified and unified. This Jñāna-svarūpa of the Supreme Consciousness is opposed to Jñānavṛ tti or the limited and differentiated consciousness. After the attainment of this second stage we pass to the third. We then ask, what lies behind the senses, where- in to a great extent the appearance of the external world depends? We then perceive that the senses do not apprehend objects unless attention, in the form of Manas is bestowed upon them. The whole world, open at any moment THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 280 to the senses, is impinging on them at every moment, but only that is perceived to which we pay attention. The Bṛ hadāranyaka Upaniṣ ad gives good psychology when it says, “I did not hear. My mind was elsewhere.” But attention must be directed and willed. We learn then that behind the Senses there is some Self which directs its attention to a particular object, and so perceives it by the medium of the senses. There is thus no sense-perception without the co-operation of the attention of the Self. There- fore the world (considered apart from what it may possibly be in itself) is dependent both upon the senses and attentive mind of the self which is behind them. The attainment and habit of this thought is the third ascending stage of the Pārthiva consciousness. We have thus attained a knowledge of the self. We next reflect upon its nature. To the ordinary consciousness of the first two states, the self either did not appear import- ant, or seemed to be limited to the body and restricted within its scope. But reflection has now shown that not only is it unconditioned by the senses, but actually conditions them, giving them effective operation through its power of atten- tion. The self then appears uncontrolled by the physical body, self-luminous and overlapping the bounds of the physical senses. When this notion is reached the fourth stage of consciousness is attained. The next question is—what is the relation of the self, the senses and the objects? Are they each independent in their origin the one of the other, or is one the cause of the other two? They cannot be independent of each other, for this would mean that either they had no relation to each other, or if there is any relation, it is due to some fourth thing external to the others, which is the basis of their relation and apart from which they cannot be in relation. It is obvious that they are in THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA 281 relation to each other, and, as such, the ground of their relation must be either in, or outside, themselves. It is sufficient to say here that no fourth principle capable of holding them together and bringing them into relation is perceived. But logically the same result can be established, for if a fourth principle bringing them into relation were assumed, which was dependent on some one or other of them, the causal element would be still to seek, whereas if it were independent and still in relation to the three, then the ground of this relation would have to be sought for in some fifth element, and so on with a regressio ad infinitum. We must then confine ourselves to the three and examine the nature of this relation. The relation can be grounded only in that element out of the three which is independent of the others, for a dependent entity cannot have the ground of its relation to others within itself. The perceived objects are not inde- pendent. For they require the senses to be perceived as objects of that character according to which we perceive them. The senses are not independent, for sense-percep- tion requires attention of the Self. Objects in order to be objects must be perceived by the senses. Without the senses they are not objects for us. The senses are not operative senses without the attention of the Self behind them. On the other hand the Self does not cease to be the Self, when it is not attentively perceiving objects through the senses, as we see in the case of dream. The Self in dream is cut off from the senses. Indeed it evolves both objects and senses. The Self in dream is cut off from the objective world, having nothing in it but ideas thereto. Yet it transforms for itself those ideas into outer objects and the senses which perceive them. What we see in dream is real while it lasts. Thus the Self is independent of the other two and has within itself the ground of the THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 282 causal relation by which it evolves them. The firm and lasting consciousness which realises this is the fifth step in the ascending consciousness. What then is the nature of the relation between the cause producing the objective world and the effect so, pro- duced? Is it a cause material in its nature, producing an effect external to itself, or an ideal cause working ideally upon itself to produce an effect? The cause cannot produce an effect which is really external to itself. Were this so, the dream-world of which we are creators would be external to the self which produces it. In that case it would not vanish with that state of consciousness which lies at the root of it. The objective world can only be ideally con- nected with its cause. Gradually the notion that the objective world is produced by a cause external to it is rejected, and the notion is accepted that the cause has the effect lying ideally within it, which is projected and externalised in the course of cosmic evolution. For when mind and matter are evolved, each has equal reality and (in the sense of impermanence) unreality. In its highest sense Reality = Persistence = Deathlessness (Amṛ tatva) = Ānanda which is living unimpeded in the fullest measure, which is Ātmā. And so Herbert Spencer on biological principles defines “pleasure” as the index of the unimpeded flow of vitality. What fully persists and is therefore fully “real” is the self. The firm establishment of this experi- ence is the sixth consciousness. Just as the dream-world lies within the consciousness of the dreamer, who projects it into fancied objectivity, so the objective world of common (Vyavahārika) experience lies within, and is projected by, the Consciousness of the so-called World-dreamer, who sums up in Himself all experiences. Is the world or its cause necessarily thus by virtue of the nature of the cause itself, or on account of some external fact? There is no THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA 283 material other than itself outside the cause which it takes within, works upon, and puts forth. It might be thought that there was ideal connection with the objective world on the causal side, but that the root of the objective world upon which it operates was something lying elsewhere than in its inner being. But this is not so, as the effect, the objective world, must necessarily be within the cause, otherwise it is not possible that it should be ideally con- nected with it. If the connection with the cause were something other than the constitution of the cause itself, there must be an indication of what that something is and the nature of its connection with the cause. Moreover if that something lies outside the cause, we must suppose some medium connecting that something with the cause itself. And again the question would arise whether this connection was natural and necessary, or adventitious. If the latter, then what is it which brings about the connec- tion? In this way we have a regressio ad infinitum unless we suppose the connection to be natural and necessary. It is reasonable then to hold that the objective world lies necessarily in its root the cause. Moreover having arrived at the consciousness that the effect is ideally connected with the cause, it is more reasonable to hold that this connection is due to the constitution of the cause itself. When the entire objective world is viewed as necessarily lying within the cause, the seventh, or what we may call the Satya stage of the Pārthiva consciousness, is attained. Up to this we have only dealt with the subdivisions of the Pārthiva or earth consciousness, that is, experience as beings in the Pārthiva state elaborated by reflection to its highest point. By such reflection we reach the stand- point from which the whole universe is viewed as lying in a seed (Bīja) form, ideally and potentially within its cause which is nothing but the Self. @@@ THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 284 Thus one aspect of the grandeur of the Self as the potential cause of the entire universe is revealed. The Sādhaka has thus passed through higher and higher stages of the Pārthiva consciousness to the indwelling Spirit within it. His thus expanded consciousness brings forth the exclamation which is the Gāyatrī-Mantra, in which homage is made to the Supreme Power, which manifests in this and all other forms of experience and its objects in the Universe. Hence the word by which the Sādhaka denotes this indwelling Spirit is Savitā, or the Projector of the Universe from out of Its own thought, without external material or aid. It is however to be remembered that the strength of the force of the externality-notion which com- menced at the stage of Ether (Ākāśa) reached its greatest power in the earth-principle (Pṛ thivī-Tattva) of solid, ponderable, three dimensioned matter and in the Pārthiva consciousness. Therefore it is that Savitā the Producer, though really the Inner Self, is itself, externalised as some- thing placed out in space and hence we find it designated by Tat or That. This “Thatness” will, as we proceed, meet in one unity the Supremeness of the last stage. But it is the characteristic of the Pārthiva consciousness that it always tends to locate both the Seer and the Seen in out- er space. The devotee to whose mental gaze the indwelling Spirit reveals itself, bursts forth into the Mantra: “Let us meditate on the adorable darkness-dispelling Spirit of the self-luminous all-producing Savitā,” with the prayer that It may inspire and illumine our inward Reason. It is through this illumination of the Reason by the source of Reason, that the inner Reason which is our inner being sees and understands the entire universe and its principles. This Savitā produces the universe in accordance with the principles of Reason which are at base His own inner being (Vicāracamatkritih paramātmamayī), and this production THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA 285 of His is revealed to us and realised by us in participation with the Divine Reason of His being. As we are, in our deepest ground, the Spirit which, in its outer aspect, is our limited selves and what is not ourselves; as our reason is an efflorescence of Its own eternal all-knowingness, so our outer reasoning is in conformity with the truth in its own sphere, and is illumined to pass beyond reasoning upon the objective world to an understanding of the rational vesture of the Spirit, and then to the intuitive realisation of the Spirit Itself. This union of ours with the universal is shown by the fact that we, as so many individuals, if we were to remain confined within our individuality, could never perceive the universe as common to us all. This common perception of the universe could not be achieved by us as individuals, but only as being one with the uni- versal. And therefore in so far as we are the common perceivers of the universe, we are not individual but uni- versal. Our individuality consists in our perception of the universe in so far as it differs from that of others. Thus difference of perception, which individualises us, is not based upon any inherent differentiating condition in our essential being, but upon the externalising limitations, the result of particular Karma, which make it impossible for all to perceive everything at the same time to the same extent. This perception of the difference of the many, due to limitation, differentiates eaoh individual from the other, but it does not, and cannot, differentiate him from the Indwelling Universal (here Pārthiva) which is the common ground of all. Thus the Sādhaka says that it is this Savita or Indwelling Universal, which inspires the Reason of us all, both as individual and as universal, and it is through the Self-luminous Consciousness of this Most Glorious Self (known not only in Samādhi, but in and through every act of reasoning, its mental embodiment) that we THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 286 are enabled to learn and understand the Truth (Satyam; ). For it is Satya or the Persistent Self Itself. The relation between the individual and the universal being thus grasp- ed, and it being realised that the individuality of the in- dividual is only through the universal, we should then proceed to see what is the nature of this Universal which makes it project the universe as we see it around us. Here we pass beyond the Gāyatrī Sādhanā into the subtle Ātmā-sadhana. The Vedāntist says that to such as truly see, whether with the eye of reason or intuition, the whole universe is perceived as originating from its source, as the Gangā from the Himālayas, and at length returning thereto. Its source is in the Power of the Per- fect Consciousness which is Śiva, which means the Auspi- cious and Good, the Brahman or all Pervading. All which exists are Its varying forms, existing in happiness so long as they are in Harmony with Him who is Bliss (Ānanda) itself. Power and Harmony—let us repeat these words day by day. Think continuously the Thought of Power and be powerful. Individual Power is a small thing, but when it links itself to, or identifies itself with, the Supreme Power, it shows its mightiness according to the degree of such harmony and union. Power however does not merely mean material force. The latter is only Power translated to the material plane. Power is also mental, moral, spiritual. Love is Power—the greatest of Powers. Everything in fact which exists is Power, which is the Mother (A m; bikā). We may intellectually conceive this. But how to realise it? Here the Vedantic practice (Sādhana) is as profound as its theory. It says that man as body, mind and spirit is one whole. If one would understand and realise the Pure, one must be that, both in body and mind (Śuddhātmā). In the West it is commonly supposed that a man may arrive at, or at any rate is competent to seek THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA 287 for, the truth by reason alone. Mere reason however is insufficient. A man may be deemed a philosopher in the West, and yet lack in character and morals. This is not so in Vedānta which says that its doctrine cannot be per- fectly understood, much less realised, unless the body and mind are made pure enough to approach the Purity which that doctrine teaches. The whole being must be brought in harmony, so far as may be, with it. Thus is it under- stood and at length realised. The pure mind and body naturally think the thoughts which link man’s mind with the Universal Mind and the Universal Self of which it is the subtle form. Sādhanā varies according to the stages of development and therefore competency (Adhikāra) of man. But the highest of Sādhanās is Karunā or compas- sion. I took up recently an English novel, curiously enough called “The Rationalist.” There I found the phrase “this new thing appearing on the horizon—the phenomenon of Compassion which is now beginning to express itself in action.” This “new thing” is as old here as the Vedas and the Buddha Gotama who ceaselessly taught it. Avoid giving pain. Allay it where it is. Yet the application of this prinoiple is not so simple as is sometimes thought. The truly great of our race need no other power nor effort than to be themselves. By the mere fact of their own self- redemption, they redeem others. Others must at least strive to hold in view the ideal in the midst of the struggles into which their nature and circumstances may lead them. Mere apathy however is not Yoga. Yoga is unity with the Lord in the forms of His Power as one’s family, friends, people and the world at large. He is Jagadbandhu, that is, Friend of the World. We can each make effort to follow this Supreme Law and to extricate ourselves from the morass of merely selfish struggle. And as we sucoessfully, according to our varying opportunity and capacity, do so, THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 288 we will find that we make individual advance, and that the power to impose our will on others increases. If each will, according to his capacity, so order his life that he does not cause pain to, and relieves the suffering of this great Body of the Lord which is the Universe, of which each is an in- finitesimal part, then they will commence to really under- stand. The greatest cloud upon understanding is selfish- ness. The mass of men are still mere candidates for Humanity and must raise themselves to it. The meaning of Evolution is the liberation of the Spirit or Inner Self from all which obscures its essential freedom. This libera- tion is taking place in the gradual ascent from inorganic to organic being and the advance of organism culminating, for the present, in man as we know him. The highest humanity is that in which it and Divinity meet. In man the I principle is still being developed in present humanity. The end is the perfection of the present “I,” and then by stages its identification with the Universal “I,” the Pūr- nāham which is the Infinite Self. The Sādhaka thinks of this ascending or return movement repeatedly, for Japa on the Gāyatrī is necessary to correct the natural objective tendencies of thought. This is the true performance of Sandhyā, which literally means perfect Dhyāna or medita- tion, of which the Gāyatrī-Mantra is the soul. Those who have not learnt the goal of evolution do not realise the necessity of Sandhyā. They have before their eyes only the present powers and capacities of man and think that his present possibilities on the lower plane should alone be realised. They think only of the fulfilment of desires, shutting their eyes to the purpose for which man exists in the world, namely, first harmony with the active (Viśvātma-Śakti) and then union with the Un- changing Brahman (Cidrūpiṇ i-Śakti). They fail to realise that the Reality, which underlies all phenomena, must also THE GĀYATRĪ-MANTRA 289 be in the deepest nature of man, and unless that Reality is known the deepest aspirations of Humanity cannot be fulfilled. From the earliest beginnings all earnest minds have sought the solution of the riddle of the universe. All types of thinkers whether materialists, idealists, or spiri- tualists, have supposed that there is some Reality, call it Matter, Mind, Spirit, Brahman, God, Allah, what they will, which, whilst eluding their mental grasp, is all the same there, though it cannot be comprehended by the mind in its fullness. It cannot only be there, but it must be here within the inmost nature of all, as one with the deepest inmost self. If so, man must not only study the objective universe, which he should do to gain knowledge of the external Śakti-aspect of this reality, but he must plunge deep into his own nature, for he can only realise It within and not without the self. Man’s present existence is a mode of consciousness, ordinarily in the spiritual Bhūh Consoiousness, or in the forms of a Tala Consciousness. The search is to find out the universal principle. Beings in the lower order of evolution have not the “I” principle evolved to the level of Vijñāna or Buddhi, and therefore the reason and understanding must be developed. The greater portion of the work of evolution must be done by the individual himself, under the guidance of the divine principle of Reason, and if we do not wish to be left behind in the general progressive movement, we must give up all lethargy and the contentment which the animal (whether as beast or man) has with his present powers and capacities and their external environment. Man must seek to under- stand the meaning of life and its end, and looking beyond by the Eye of Divine Wisdom (Jñāna-cakṣ u) endeavour to first intellectually grasp, and then to realise, that which is the Beginning, the Maintainer and the End of all—the Vācya-śakti of the Gāyatrī-Mantra. CHAPTER XXXI ĀTMA-SĀDHANA (YOGA BY REASONING) I HAVE in the previous article shortly indicated a form of Gāyatrī-Sādhana given to me some years ago. Here follows the Ātma-Sādhana which is taken up at the point at which the Gāyatrī-Sādhana ends. Duality is inherent in the constitution of all mani- fested being. Therefore until man realises the whole (Pūrṇ a- brahman), that is, the Universe as one with its both imma- nent and transcending Root, there is an object whether the same is apparently wholly outside, and different from, and independent of the Self, or whether it is experienced internally as a mode of the latter’s subjective existence. But the experience is of varying grades. For just as matter, objectively considered, becomes more and more gross from its first ethereal (Ākāśa) form to scientific, that is, ponder- able matter, so when in the upward ascent of consciousness Matter has been withdrawn into itself and exists there as a mode of being, that mode becomes a more and more subtle expression of the principle whence all objectivity, whether externally sensed or internally experienced, is derived. At the stage of complete manifestation, that is, ordinary Bhūh experience, the object or “This” (Idam ̣ ) is wholly outside, and independent of, the Self, the two being mutually exclusive the one of the other. Matter is then in the form in which we ordinarily sense it. We may remain at this stage which is that of objective science or go within and to the Boot of all experience. If that Root is within, then introspection can alone discover it. ĀTMA-SĀDHANA 291 How? That which carries us upwards or inwards is the will-to-know of a nature ever more and more purifying itself and thus gaining strength by its approach to the Almighty Savitā of all. This is Prayer in its highest form. At each moment of attainment and advance we naturally render homage to the glory of the All-pervading Being, who gradually reveals His infinite Self, just as Linnaeus the great botanist fell on his knees when he first saw Its objec- tive expression in the form of the golden beauty of the flower of the wild Gorse. But the object, though it persists in experience until the attainment of the perfect Conscious- ness (Brahma-Svarūpa), is yet diversely realised as we pro- ceed innerwards. In the first place it is brought from without to within the Self, and there experienced not as something different from the Self but as a mode of its own existence. Next as such it becomes less and less pointed and more diffused and is brought into closer and closer touch with the subjective being. This is effected by an intense and penetrating meditation at each stage of advance with a view to realise the subjective root of that stage. When the objective tendencies of thought are held in check, Consciousness of Itself more and more purely manifests. In the Pārthiva consciousness, matter is in a fully pointed condition outside the Self until the Satya, stage is reached. Even the Self appears as a concentrated objective point in space. At the Satya stage the notion is gained through reasoning that the entire universe must lie within the Self as its cause. Acting on this suggestion of the Reason, the Parthiva consciousness turns back into itself, and for the first time as Antarmukhī is conscious of some- thing within itself lying there in a pointed form. The pointedness remains, but the world is carried within the Self, where it is grasped as a mode of its own existence. This peculiar consciousness is Rasa, which is the subjective THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 292 root of what objectively appears to the Pārthiva conscious- ness as Ap. The external particularised location disappears. If the point is located outside, there is Gandha—experi- ence of matter in its Pṛ thivī condition. Gandha, Rasa, Rūpa, Sparśa, Śabda are the various kinds of conscious- ness, which in the evolutionary process are the subjective root of sensible matter and which on the full externalisation of such matter are the five different ways in which it affects the senses as smell, taste, sight, touch, and hearing. In Rasa experience the object is brought in closer relation with the Self, both by reason of its being placed therein, and of a lessened intensity of its pointedness to the Self as compared with Gandha or Bhūh experience. With a lessening intensity of the Rasa experience, the latter is shifted from the inner to the outer and seems to be coming from outside less in the form of feeling than of intellection in the shape of general unqualitative snd un- differentiated form. There is then the idea of something there all round the Self, affecting the subjective being by way of a superficially, instead of interiorly, felt experience. This is Rūpa experience, the subjective root of Agni who is the builder of forms. This is the last of the form (Mūrtta) division of Tattvas. The lessened intensity of the pointed- ness of the Rasa-feeling has necessarily the effect of setting consciousness on the surface of subjective being, and as the idea of space or co-existing externality-points is already there, this weakened Rasa experience, being externally localised, spreads itself over the space and becomes the sub- jective root of the Rūpa consciousness. This Rūpa experi- ence, when closely looked into and allowed to come very close to the subjective being, is experienced as Touch or Sparśa, the subjective root as Vāyu. This is not the touch produced by specialised form, for this is a sensation had only after the production of Agni. The experience ĀTMA-SĀDHANA 293 may be compared to the perception in ordinary life of the thermal quaIity of objects. The subjective intensification of Rūpa, with its surface expansion, when concentrated into a point of the inner subjective being, produced the Rasa feeling, which when located outwards was, as Gandha, the subjective root of the externalised objectivity of daily life. Rūpa affects the surface subjective being, whilst Sparśa again shifts experience into the inner, as the whole subjective being then responds to Sparśa as a whole. This Sparśa Consciousness, which is objectively Vāyu, is when closely examined found to consist of externality idea- points spread over the surface of the subjective being, receding away as mere hints of outsideness, as compared with the something which is outside of Rūpa experience. This is Śabda experience, the subjective root of Ākāśa, the seed of all externalised or externally located world- phenomena. It persists as the deathless basis (Amṛ ta) of all manifestation downwards or outwards, into which all phenomena are resolved in their upward or inward course. The realisation of this is the Śabda consciousness. This root of externality-consciousness refers back to its origin the inner mind (which projects the idea of mere outerness and which. is its counterpart), the root from which the notion of externality arises as the tree from its seed. This internal-root which grows into Ākāśa is the Brahma-consciousness as the internal root-will (correspond- ing on the Pārthiva plane to the Manas) which lies at the root of all manifestation. Behind this is the “I am my- self,” which subjectifying itself as the “I am myself I” be- comes the Cosmic Will. The former is Cit as the objecti- fied self-consciousness. And from the fact that it is the starting point and internal correspondence of the objective world it may be called the Bhūh Consciousness of the internal, ideal, the subjective region as distinguished from THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 294 the Bhūh consciousness of the external, actual objective region, the first Vyāhṛ ti in the ascending scale. But this Supreme Bhūh, being the terminating point of objectivity in the form of the Self as Universe cannot stand by itself. It must be the result of some assertion of consciousness which is not that of any other than Self-Being, as all other assertions or Vyāhṛ tis of the external world are here transcended. Thus this assertion as “I am” may be called the Bhuvah of the supreme objective region as distinguished from the Bhuvah of the objective region lower down. And behind this assertion of self-existence as its root is the eternal subjective “I” (Aham ̣ ) of the supreme Svah as distinguished from the external objective “I” or indi- viduality in the Svah lower down. This completes the field of assertion of self-consciousness behind which lies the entire Consciousness (Cit) Itself, that is, Conscious- ness (Cif) per se, which, whilst itself ever unchanged and unconditioned, is the source of All the changing forms of experience mentioned which again merge into it. This is Bliss itself (Ānanda) or Joy, of which the world is an expression in time and space, the Joy by which it is main- tained and the Joy into which the world re-enters, the Universal Mother (like the earthly mother) clasping the child which She has produced to Her breast. The “I” or Aham ̣ here spoken of is not the limited “I” of Aham ̣ kāra which is only a gross and particularised re- flection of the former. In the Kāmakalāvilāsa the Supreme I (Aham ̣ ) is very beautifully explained as the union (Sāma- rasya) of its own infinite Self as Prakāśa with itself as Vimarśa-Śakti, which is a pure mirror (Darpaṇ a) made of a mass of the Prakāśa Śiva’s own rays. These are reflected back and the Pūrnāhambhāva or the experience of the “I” as being all arises. That is the notion of Self had by reference to the Self which is then the Enjoyer of ĀTMA-SĀDHANA 295 Bliss. There is no other but the Self in the fullest purity and unlimitedness of both and is thus the supreme Aham ̣ . From this root “I”, which is Kāma, the will to create and the collectivity (Samaṣ ti) of all the powers which consti- tute all manifested things, there burgeons forth the trunk, the branches, the leaves, and fruit of the great Aśvattha tree which is the universe. It is only when this Supreme Universal “I” is reached that it is possible to realise its eternal inwardness as the Mahāśūnya, which is the Great Void in the sense that it is nothing which thought can conceive or words utter. None of the higher stages can be realised until the next lower one is grasped. Before the universal “I” is reached, it is not possible to realise the “I-less” Cit or conscious- ness, as the veil of matter covers (though with decreasing thickness as we ascend) its Glorious Face. It requires a strong effort of subjective penetration to pass through this covering, dense as ponderable matter at its lowest end, and to reach the Consciousness which lies behind, of which all forms are Its assertions. At the time of meditation, the entire thick veil of material (Pārthiva) existence must be gradually thinned by moving inwards according to the stages described; by reducing the crude and thicker form of consciousness into the subtle and more refined, till by gradual inner progress the subtlest point of the universal “I” which is the Lord (Īśvara) of Vedānta is reached. After this That which is the eternal and changeless ground of even this is realised and then there is Kaivaiya Mokṣ a, the ultimate Basis of all the Forms which have arisen out of Its self-assertion,—the Will to be many of which the Veda speaks. This is the great Self of the Vedānta. This is the Perfect Experience which is called the Supreme Love (Niratiśaya-premā- spadatvam ānandatvam). THE GARLAND OF LETTERS 296 These forms of the Self can be broadly classified into the actual, objective or external which is the waking state (Jāgrat avasthā); the ideal, the subjective or internal, the assertional or the state of dream (Svapna); and the third the state of dreamless slumber (Suṣ upti) which is the bare subjective standing by, itself not yet in active assertion, but having passed the equilibrium point about to assert itself, but for the time being having the assertion latent in it, lying there unperceived, but ready to shoot forth into assertion, at first qualitative, and then into perception, by reason of both qualitative and external manifestation. Herein all ideas become merged and latent and thence project themselves into the Ideal and thence again into the Actual in the course of the involution of the Self into the Māyik covering which is the universe. The Perfect Consciousness, as realising all these three stages with all their differences and similarities, lies beyond them all, though it is one with all, supporting them by Its own essential Being and Power (Śakti). They are Its forms— the forms of that Consciousness which It is. It runs through all (Sūtrātmā) and unifies them all, but remains in Itself unlimited and unconditioned, giving them both their separate existence, yet summing them up into Its own Life and Being, which comprehending all yet trans- cends them from the standpoint of its own Being in itself or Svarūpa. It is beyond all because it is infinite. It comprehends all in its supremely rich experience because It is the whole (Pūrṇ a). It is Love because It is the Love of the Self for the Self. It is Joy because all Love is that; but it is perfect also. It is the Perfect Experience (Jñānasvarūpa,) which thought achieves by a pure mind in a pure body. It is thus the Supreme Siddhi of all Sādhana and Yoga. Om ̣ Tat Sat EDITORIAL NOTE TO THE CELEPHAÏS PRESS EDITION The present e-text was OCR’d and proofed from page images of the 1955 third edition found online at the Digital Library of India. This edition contained a six-page foreword by T. M. P. Mahadevan which is here omitted for copyright reasons. In general layout and style of that edition, including translitera- tion of Sanskrit, have been followed, with a few minor excep- tions, the principal being that ś rather than s′ has been used throughout to render श (s ̣ in Monier-Williams’ dictionary); as in the copy-text, ṣ renders ष (sh in Monier-Williams) Addi- tionally, some transliterations in cap. XXIX have been chaged to conform to those used in the rest of the book. The various diagrams have been redrawn as vector art from the scans. On p. 246 one line of romanised Sanskirt appeared to be out of place when compared with the English translations, and so was moved. When studying this and the author’s other writings on Indian religions and in particular the Śākta Tāntrik cults, it should be kept in mind that he did not write from a compa- rative-religion perspective of an outsider attempting to analyse and critique other peoples’ belief-systems in familiar terms, but rather sought to expound the Śākta doctrines more or less in their own terms, for which purpose it was necessary to adopt their position. This will go some way to explaining the seeming credulity of a number of passages in the present work. Celephaïs Press currently intends to issue electronic texts of a few of Sir John Woodroffe’s other major works, starting with the Introduction to Tantra Śāstra (a slight revision of the introduction from his 1913 translation of the Mahānirvāṇ a Tantra). T.S. Leeds, England OTHER ELECTRONIC BOOKS AVAILABLE FROM CELEPHAÏS PRESS / UNSPEAKABLE PRESS Anonymous—Phallism: A Description of the Worship of Lingam-Yoni &c. &c. &c. Edwin Arnold (trans.)—The Song Celestial (Bhagavadgita) H. P. Blavatsky—The Voice of the Silence Richard Carlile—Manual of Freemasonry A. Fabre d’Olivet—Golden Verses of Pythagoras (English translation by N. L. Redfield). J.G.R. Forlong—Rivers of Life, Short Studies in the Science of Comparative Religions, Faiths of Man: a Cyclopedia of Religions Franz Hartmann—Cosmology or Universal Science &c. &c. &c. (Secret Symbols of the Rosicrucians) C.H. Hinton—The Fourth Dimension, Scientific Romances (1st series only) T. H. Huxley—Humes, with helps to the study of Berkeley. Thomas Inman—Ancient Pagan and Modern Christian Symbolism (2nd edition), Ancient Faiths and Modern Hargrave Jennings—The Rosicrucians, their Rites and Mysteries (4th edition) C.W. King—The Gnostics and their Remains (second edition) Sidney T. Klein—Science and the Infinite Richard Payne Knight, et al.—A Discourse on the Worship of Priapus &c. &c. &c. (Two Essays on the Worship of Priapus) Gerald Massey—The Natural Genesis, Gerald Massey’s Lectures, Ancient Egypt S.L. “MacGregor” Mathers (ed. / trans.)—The Kabbalah Unveiled G.R.S. Mead (trans.)—Pistis Sophia Edward Sellon—Annotations on the Sacred Writings of the Hindus. Herbert Spencer—First Principles. William Stirling—The Canon Prentiss Tucker—The Lost Key: an Explanation of Masonic Symbols N. Montfauçon de Villars—Comte de Gabalis (“Brothers” translation) Swami Vivekananda—Raja Yoga, Bhakti Yoga A. E. Waite—Real History of the Rosicrucians John Yarker (ed. / trans.)—Lectures of the Antient and Primitive Rite of Free- masonry. For further details on any of these titles, contact dancingstar93@gmail.com For the current full list, visit www.geocities.com/celephais.press